SICK Xenon™/Granit™ Operating instructions

Add to my manuals
410 Pages

advertisement

SICK Xenon™/Granit™ Operating instructions | Manualzz
Xenon™/Granit™
Xenon 1900, 1900h, 1910, 1902, 1902h, 1912,
1902g-BF
Granit 1910i, 1911i, 1980i, 1981i
Area-Imaging Scanners
User Guide
Disclaimer
Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in specifications and other information contained in
this document without prior notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether any such changes
have been made. The information in this publication does not represent a commitment on the part of HII.
HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or consequential
damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material. HII disclaims all responsibility for the selection and use of software and/or hardware to achieve intended results.
This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII.
 2010-2017 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved.
Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com
Microsoft® Windows®, Windows NT®, Windows 2000, Windows ME, Windows XP, and the Windows logo are trademarks or
registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
Other product names or marks mentioned in this document may be trademarks or registered trademarks of other companies and are the property of their respective owners.
For patent information, refer to www.hsmpats.com.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Customer Support ..................................................................................................................... xvii
Technical Assistance .......................................................................................................... xvii
Product Service and Repair ............................................................................................. xvii
Limited Warranty ................................................................................................................. xvii
Send Feedback ..................................................................................................................... xvii
Chapter 1 - Get Started .................................................................................... 1
About This Manual......................................................................................................................... 1
Unpack Your Device....................................................................................................................... 1
Connect the Device........................................................................................................................ 1
Connect with USB.................................................................................................................... 1
Connect with Keyboard Wedge .......................................................................................... 4
Connect with RS232 Serial Port ........................................................................................ 6
Connect with RS485............................................................................................................... 8
Mount a CCB01-010BT Charge Base .................................................................................... 9
Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base .................................................................... 9
Reading Techniques................................................................................................................... 11
Xenon 1900/1902/1910/1912 and Granit 1910i/1911i ................................... 11
Granit 1980i/1981i.............................................................................................................. 11
Menu Bar Code Security Settings......................................................................................... 12
Set Custom Defaults .................................................................................................................. 12
Reset the Custom Defaults...................................................................................................... 13
Chapter 2 - Program the Interface ............................................................. 15
Introduction................................................................................................................................... 15
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
i
Program the Interface - Plug and Play ...............................................................................15
Keyboard Wedge ..........................................................................................................................15
Laptop Direct Connect ..............................................................................................................16
RS232 Serial Port.........................................................................................................................16
RS485 ...............................................................................................................................................16
RS485 Packet Mode.............................................................................................................17
USB IBM SurePos ........................................................................................................................18
USB PC or Macintosh Keyboard ............................................................................................18
USB HID...........................................................................................................................................19
USB Serial .......................................................................................................................................19
CTS/RTS Emulation .............................................................................................................19
ACK/NAK Mode......................................................................................................................20
Remote MasterMind™ for USB ...............................................................................................20
Verifone® Ruby Terminal............................................................................................................20
Gilbarco® Terminal .......................................................................................................................21
Honeywell Bioptic Aux Port .....................................................................................................21
Datalogic™ Magellan® Aux Port ..............................................................................................21
NCR Bioptic Aux Port..................................................................................................................22
Wincor Nixdorf Terminal ...........................................................................................................22
Wincor Nixdorf Beetle™ Terminal ..........................................................................................22
Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A...............................................................................................23
Keyboard Country Layout.........................................................................................................23
Keyboard Style ..............................................................................................................................30
Keyboard Conversion .................................................................................................................32
Control Character Output.........................................................................................................32
Keyboard Modifiers.....................................................................................................................33
RS232 Modifiers ..........................................................................................................................34
RS232 Baud Rate ..................................................................................................................34
RS232 Word Length: Data Bits, Stop Bits, and Parity ............................................35
RS232 Receiver Time-Out .................................................................................................36
RS232 Handshake ................................................................................................................37
ii
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
RS232 Timeout.......................................................................................................................37
XON/XOFF ...............................................................................................................................38
ACK/NAK...................................................................................................................................38
Scanner to Bioptic Communication .....................................................................................38
Scanner-Bioptic Packet Mode..........................................................................................39
Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Mode....................................................................................39
Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Timeout ..............................................................................39
Chapter 3 - Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and
Granit 1911i/1981i........................................................................................41
How the Cordless Charge Base/Access Point Works.....................................................41
Link the Scanner to a Charge Base.......................................................................................41
Link the Scanner to an Access Point ....................................................................................42
Replace a Linked Scanner ........................................................................................................43
Communication Between the Cordless System
and the Host...................................................................................................................................43
Program the Scanner and Base or Access Point .............................................................44
RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation...........................................................................44
System Conditions.......................................................................................................................44
Page Button....................................................................................................................................45
Page Button and Presentation Modes ................................................................................46
Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout.............................................................46
About the Battery .........................................................................................................................47
Charge Information ..............................................................................................................47
Battery Recommendations................................................................................................47
Safety Precautions for Lithium Batteries.....................................................................48
Proper Disposal of the Battery .........................................................................................48
Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning ........................................................................48
Scanner LED Sequences and Meaning........................................................................49
Base/Access Point LED Sequences and Meaning ...................................................49
Base Power Communication Indicator .........................................................................50
Reset Scanner................................................................................................................................50
Scan While in Base Cradle........................................................................................................50
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
iii
Base Charge Modes....................................................................................................................51
Page ..................................................................................................................................................51
Page Mode ...............................................................................................................................51
Page Pitch ................................................................................................................................52
Error Indicators.............................................................................................................................52
Beeper Pitch - Base Error...................................................................................................52
Number of Beeps - Base Error .........................................................................................53
Scanner Report.............................................................................................................................53
Scanner Address ..........................................................................................................................53
Base or Access Point Address .................................................................................................54
Scanner Modes.............................................................................................................................54
Charge Only Mode ................................................................................................................54
Charge and Link Mode........................................................................................................54
Linked Modes .........................................................................................................................55
Unlink the Scanner......................................................................................................................55
Override Locked Scanner...................................................................................................56
Out-of-Range Alarm...................................................................................................................56
Alarm Sound Type .................................................................................................................56
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer.............................................................................................57
Flexible Power Management...................................................................................................58
Batch Mode ....................................................................................................................................59
Batch Mode Beep ..................................................................................................................60
Batch Mode Storage ............................................................................................................60
Batch Mode Quantity...........................................................................................................61
Enter Quantities.....................................................................................................................61
Batch Mode Output Order .................................................................................................63
Total Records...........................................................................................................................63
Delete Last Code ...................................................................................................................64
Clear All Codes .......................................................................................................................64
Transmit Records to Host ..................................................................................................64
Batch Mode Transmit Delay..............................................................................................64
Multiple Scanner Operation ....................................................................................................65
Scanner Name ..............................................................................................................................65
iv
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Application Work Groups ..........................................................................................................67
Application Work Group Selection..................................................................................67
Reset the Factory Defaults: All Application Work Groups ............................................68
Reset the Custom Defaults: All Application Work Groups ...........................................69
Use the Scanner with Bluetooth Devices............................................................................69
Bluetooth Secure Simple Pairing (SSP)........................................................................69
Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect...................................................................................70
Virtual Keyboard.....................................................................................................................71
Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect.............................................................................71
Bluetooth Serial Port - PCs/Laptops.............................................................................72
PDAs/Mobility Systems Devices .....................................................................................72
Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code ................................................................72
Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity ............................................................72
Auto Reconnect Mode .........................................................................................................73
Maximum Link Attempts ....................................................................................................73
Relink Time-Out .....................................................................................................................74
Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples.................................................................75
Host Acknowledgment ...............................................................................................................75
Host ACK On/Off ...................................................................................................................77
Host ACK Timeout .................................................................................................................77
Host ACK Responses ............................................................................................................77
Chapter 4 - Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF...................79
How the CCB01-010BT-BF Cordless Charge Base Works ..........................................79
Link the Scanner to a Charge Base.......................................................................................80
Replace a Linked Scanner ........................................................................................................80
Communication Between the Cordless System
and the Host...................................................................................................................................81
Program the Scanner and Base..............................................................................................81
RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation...........................................................................81
System Conditions.......................................................................................................................82
About the Instant Charge Pack...............................................................................................83
Charge Information ..............................................................................................................83
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
v
Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning........................................................................83
Scanner .....................................................................................................................................84
Low Power Alerts..........................................................................................................................84
Low Power Alert Range .......................................................................................................85
Low Power Alert Flash Number .......................................................................................85
Low Power Alert Repeat ......................................................................................................85
Low Power Alert Beep ..........................................................................................................86
Base...................................................................................................................................................86
Base Communication and Scanning ............................................................................86
Base Charge Status ..............................................................................................................87
Base Power Communication Indicator.........................................................................87
Reset Scanner ...............................................................................................................................87
Base Charge Modes....................................................................................................................88
Page Button with Scanner Out of the Base .......................................................................88
Page Button with Scanner in the Base................................................................................89
Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout.............................................................89
Scan While in Base Cradle........................................................................................................90
Paging ..............................................................................................................................................90
Page Mode ...............................................................................................................................90
Page Pitch ................................................................................................................................91
Linking Sound...............................................................................................................................91
Error Indicators.............................................................................................................................91
Beeper Pitch - Base Error...................................................................................................91
Number of Beeps - Base Error .........................................................................................92
Scanner Report.............................................................................................................................92
Scanner Address ..........................................................................................................................92
Base Address .................................................................................................................................93
Scanner Modes.............................................................................................................................93
Charge Only Mode ................................................................................................................93
Charge and Link Mode........................................................................................................93
Linked Modes .........................................................................................................................93
Unlink the Scanner......................................................................................................................94
Override Locked Scanner...................................................................................................95
vi
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Out-of-Range Alarm ...................................................................................................................95
Alarm Sound Type .................................................................................................................95
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer .............................................................................................96
Flexible Power Management ...................................................................................................97
Batch Mode ....................................................................................................................................98
Batch Mode Beep ..................................................................................................................99
Batch Mode Storage.............................................................................................................99
Batch Mode Quantity ........................................................................................................100
Enter Quantities ..................................................................................................................100
Batch Mode Output Order ..............................................................................................102
Total Records........................................................................................................................102
Delete Last Code.................................................................................................................102
Clear All Codes.....................................................................................................................103
Transmit Records to Host................................................................................................103
Batch Mode Transmit Delay ...........................................................................................103
Scanner Name............................................................................................................................104
Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code .............................................................105
Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity .........................................................105
Auto Reconnect Mode ......................................................................................................105
Maximum Link Attempts .................................................................................................106
Relink Time-Out ..................................................................................................................107
Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples..............................................................107
Host Acknowledgment ............................................................................................................108
Host ACK On/Off ................................................................................................................109
Host ACK Timeout ..............................................................................................................109
Host ACK Responses .........................................................................................................110
Chapter 5 - Input/Output Settings ..........................................................111
Power Up Beeper .......................................................................................................................111
Beep on BEL Character ..........................................................................................................112
Trigger Click.................................................................................................................................112
Good Read and Error Indicators..........................................................................................112
Beeper – Good Read ..........................................................................................................112
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
vii
Beeper Volume – Good Read ......................................................................................... 113
Beeper Pitch – Good Read .............................................................................................. 113
Vibrate – Good Read.......................................................................................................... 113
Beeper Pitch – Error .......................................................................................................... 114
Beeper Duration – Good Read....................................................................................... 115
LED – Good Read ............................................................................................................... 115
Number of Beeps – Good Read..................................................................................... 115
Number of Beeps – Error................................................................................................. 115
Beeper Volume Max .......................................................................................................... 116
Good Read Delay ................................................................................................................ 116
User-Specified Good Read Delay................................................................................. 117
Trigger Modes ............................................................................................................................ 117
Manual Trigger .................................................................................................................... 117
Trigger Toggle ...................................................................................................................... 117
Serial Trigger ........................................................................................................................ 119
Read Time-Out .................................................................................................................... 119
Presentation Mode................................................................................................................... 120
Presentation LED Behavior after Decode................................................................. 120
Presentation Sensitivity................................................................................................... 120
Presentation Centering.................................................................................................... 121
In-Stand Sensor Mode............................................................................................................ 122
Poor Quality Codes................................................................................................................... 123
Poor Quality 1D Codes ..................................................................................................... 123
Poor Quality PDF Codes .................................................................................................. 123
CodeGate® .................................................................................................................................... 124
Streaming Presentation™ Mode.......................................................................................... 124
Streaming Presentation In-Stand ............................................................................... 125
Mobile Phone Read Mode ..................................................................................................... 125
Hands Free Time-Out.............................................................................................................. 126
Reread Delay............................................................................................................................... 126
User-Specified Reread Delay......................................................................................... 127
2D Reread Delay ................................................................................................................. 127
Character Activation ................................................................................................................ 127
viii
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Activation Character..........................................................................................................128
End Character Activation After Good Read ..............................................................128
Character Activation Timeout........................................................................................129
Character Deactivation...........................................................................................................129
Deactivation Character ....................................................................................................129
Illumination Lights ...................................................................................................................130
Aimer Delay..................................................................................................................................130
User-Specified Aimer Delay............................................................................................131
Aimer Mode .................................................................................................................................131
Centering......................................................................................................................................131
Single Code Centering......................................................................................................132
Custom Centering ..............................................................................................................132
Preferred Symbology ...............................................................................................................134
High Priority Symbology..................................................................................................135
Low Priority Symbology ...................................................................................................135
Preferred Symbology Time-out.....................................................................................135
Preferred Symbology Default ........................................................................................136
Output Sequence Overview...................................................................................................136
Output Sequence Editor ..................................................................................................136
To Add an Output Sequence...........................................................................................136
Other Programming Selections ....................................................................................137
Output Sequence Example.............................................................................................137
Output Sequence Editor ..................................................................................................138
Partial Sequence.................................................................................................................138
Require Output Sequence...............................................................................................139
Multiple Symbols ......................................................................................................................139
No Read.........................................................................................................................................140
Video Reverse..............................................................................................................................140
Working Orientation.................................................................................................................141
Chapter 6 - Healthcare Settings ...............................................................143
Quiet Operations - Combination Codes...........................................................................143
Silent Mode with Flashing LED ....................................................................................143
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
ix
Silent Mode with Long LED ........................................................................................... 144
Very Low Beeper (Nighttime Mode)............................................................................ 144
Low Beeper (Daytime Mode) ......................................................................................... 145
Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings .............................................................. 145
Linking LED Colors and Sound .................................................................................... 145
Number of LED Flashes .................................................................................................. 146
LED Flash Rate.................................................................................................................... 146
LED Solid (No Flash)......................................................................................................... 147
Page Volume Control ........................................................................................................ 147
Out-of-Range Alarm Volume......................................................................................... 148
Out-of-Range Delay.......................................................................................................... 149
Chapter 7 - Data Edit ...................................................................................151
Prefix/Suffix Overview ............................................................................................................ 151
Points to Keep In Mind ..................................................................................................... 151
Add a Prefix or Suffix:........................................................................................................ 152
Example: Add a Tab Suffix to All Symbologies........................................................ 152
Clear One or All Prefixes or Suffixes ........................................................................... 152
Add a Carriage Return Suffix to All Symbologies .................................................. 153
Prefix Selections........................................................................................................................ 153
Suffix Selections........................................................................................................................ 153
Function Code Transmit......................................................................................................... 154
Intercharacter, Interfunction, and Intermessage Delays.......................................... 154
Intercharacter Delay ......................................................................................................... 154
User Specified Intercharacter Delay........................................................................... 155
Interfunction Delay ........................................................................................................... 155
Intermessage Delay........................................................................................................... 156
Chapter 8 - Data Format .............................................................................157
Data Format Editor Introduction........................................................................................ 157
Add a Data Format.................................................................................................................... 158
Other Programming Selections.................................................................................... 159
Terminal ID Table................................................................................................................ 160
x
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Data Format Editor Commands ..........................................................................................160
Send Commands ................................................................................................................160
Move Commands................................................................................................................165
Search Commands.............................................................................................................167
Miscellaneous Commands .............................................................................................169
Data Formatter...........................................................................................................................173
Data Format Non-Match Error Tone...........................................................................174
Primary/Alternate Data Formats ........................................................................................175
Single Scan Data Format Change................................................................................175
Chapter 9 - Symbologies.............................................................................177
All Symbologies..........................................................................................................................178
Message Length Description ...............................................................................................178
Codabar.........................................................................................................................................179
Code 39 .........................................................................................................................................181
Interleaved 2 of 5.......................................................................................................................185
NEC 2 of 5 ....................................................................................................................................186
NEC 2 of 5 Message Length ..........................................................................................187
Code 93 .........................................................................................................................................187
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial (three-bar start/stop) ...........................................................189
Straight 2 of 5 IATA (two-bar start/stop) .........................................................................190
Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy..................................................................................190
Matrix 2 of 5 ................................................................................................................................191
Code 11 .........................................................................................................................................192
Code 128 ......................................................................................................................................193
ISBT 128 Concatenation..................................................................................................193
Code 128 Redundancy .....................................................................................................193
GS1-128 .......................................................................................................................................195
Telepen ..........................................................................................................................................196
UPC-A ............................................................................................................................................197
UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code ..............................................................199
Coupon GS1 DataBar Output...............................................................................................200
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
xi
UPC-E0 ......................................................................................................................................... 201
UPC-E0 Addenda Required............................................................................................ 201
UPC-E1 ......................................................................................................................................... 203
EAN/JAN-13 ............................................................................................................................... 204
EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Separator ................................................................................ 206
ISBN Translate..................................................................................................................... 206
EAN/JAN-8 .................................................................................................................................. 207
MSI.................................................................................................................................................. 209
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional............................................................................................. 211
GS1 DataBar Limited .............................................................................................................. 211
GS1 DataBar Expanded ......................................................................................................... 212
Trioptic Code............................................................................................................................... 212
Codablock A ................................................................................................................................ 213
Codablock F ................................................................................................................................ 214
Label Code................................................................................................................................... 214
PDF417......................................................................................................................................... 215
MacroPDF417............................................................................................................................ 216
MicroPDF417 ............................................................................................................................. 216
GS1 Composite Codes ............................................................................................................ 217
GS1 Emulation........................................................................................................................... 218
TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39) ............................................................................................. 219
QR Code........................................................................................................................................ 219
Data Matrix.................................................................................................................................. 221
MaxiCode ..................................................................................................................................... 222
Aztec Code ................................................................................................................................... 223
Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code ...................................................................................... 224
Postal Codes - 2D ..................................................................................................................... 225
Planet Code Check Digit.................................................................................................. 229
Postnet Check Digit........................................................................................................... 229
Australian Post Interpretation....................................................................................... 229
Postal Codes - Linear.............................................................................................................. 230
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) ..................................................................................... 230
xii
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Korea Post..............................................................................................................................231
..........................................................................................................................................................232
Chapter 10 - Imaging Commands.............................................................233
Single-Use Basis .......................................................................................................................233
Command Syntax......................................................................................................................233
Image Snap - IMGSNP............................................................................................................234
IMGSNP Modifiers .............................................................................................................234
Image Ship - IMGSHP .............................................................................................................237
IMGSHP Modifiers .............................................................................................................238
Image Size Compatibility.................................................................................................246
Intelligent Signature Capture - IMGBOX.........................................................................247
Signature Capture Optimize ..........................................................................................247
IMGBOX Modifiers .............................................................................................................248
RF Default Imaging Device ...................................................................................................252
Chapter 11 - Utilities ...................................................................................253
To Add a Test Code I.D. Prefix to All Symbologies.........................................................253
Show Decoder Revision ..........................................................................................................253
Show Scan Driver Revision....................................................................................................253
Show Software Revision .........................................................................................................254
Show Data Format ....................................................................................................................254
Test Menu.....................................................................................................................................254
TotalFreedom..............................................................................................................................254
Application Plug-Ins (Apps)..................................................................................................255
EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Introduction....................................................................255
EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Operations ................................................................256
Install EZConfig Cloud for Scanning ..........................................................................256
Reset the Factory Defaults ....................................................................................................257
Chapter 12 - Serial Programming Commands.......................................259
Conventions ................................................................................................................................259
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
xiii
Menu Command Syntax ........................................................................................................ 259
Query Commands..................................................................................................................... 260
Trigger Commands................................................................................................................... 262
Reset the Custom Defaults ................................................................................................... 263
Menu Commands ..................................................................................................................... 264
Chapter 13 - Product Specifications........................................................295
Xenon 1900/1900h/1910 Corded Scanner Product Specifications .................. 295
Xenon 1902/1902h/1912 Cordless Scanner Product Specifications ............... 296
Xenon 1902g-BF Scanner Product Specifications ..................................................... 298
Granit 1910i Industrial Corded Scanner Product Specifications.......................... 299
Granit 1911i Industrial Cordless Scanner Product Specifications....................... 300
Granit 1980i Industrial Full Range Corded Scanner Product Specifications... 301
Granit 1981i Industrial Full Range Cordless Scanner Product Specifications 302
CCB01-010BT Charge Base Product Specifications ................................................. 304
CCB01-010BT-BF Charge Base Product Specifications.......................................... 305
CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Industrial Charge Base Product Specifications305
Depth of Field Charts .............................................................................................................. 306
Xenon B&W Scanner Typical Performance.............................................................. 306
Xenon B&W Scanner Guaranteed Performance .................................................... 307
Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Typical Performance.................................. 308
Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Guaranteed Performance........................ 308
Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Typical Performance.............................................. 309
Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Guaranteed Performance.................................... 309
Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Typical Performance (200 lux) .......................... 310
Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Guaranteed Performance (200 lux) ................ 310
Standard Connector Pinouts ............................................................................................... 311
Keyboard Wedge................................................................................................................. 312
Serial Output ........................................................................................................................ 312
RS485 Output...................................................................................................................... 312
USB .......................................................................................................................................... 313
Required Safety Labels .......................................................................................................... 314
Xenon 1900/1910/1902/1912 Scanner ................................................................. 314
xiv
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base ...................................................................315
Granit 1910i/1911i/1980i/1981i Scanner.............................................................316
CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base...........................................................................317
Chapter 14 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting ..................................319
Repairs...........................................................................................................................................319
Maintenance ...............................................................................................................................319
Cleaning the Scanner .......................................................................................................319
Cleaning the Window ........................................................................................................319
Health Care Housing.........................................................................................................320
Inspecting Cords and Connectors ...............................................................................320
Replacing Cables in Corded Scanners .............................................................................320
Replacing a Xenon Interface Cable.............................................................................321
Replacing a Granit Interface Cable .............................................................................321
Replacing Cables and Batteries in Cordless Systems................................................321
Replacing an Interface Cable in a Base.....................................................................321
Changing a Xenon Scanner Battery............................................................................322
Changing a Granit Scanner Battery ............................................................................323
Troubleshooting a Corded Scanner ...................................................................................323
Troubleshooting a Cordless System ..................................................................................324
Troubleshooting a Base ...................................................................................................324
Troubleshooting a Cordless Scanner..........................................................................325
Chapter A - Reference Charts ....................................................................327
Symbology Charts.....................................................................................................................327
Linear Symbologies ...........................................................................................................327
2D Symbologies ..................................................................................................................328
Postal Symbologies ...........................................................................................................329
ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252) ....................................................................330
Lower ASCII Reference Table................................................................................................331
ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements ................................................................334
Keyboard Key References.......................................................................................................337
Sample Symbols ........................................................................................................................339
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
xv
Programming Chart................................................................................................................. 341
xvi
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Customer Support
Technical Assistance
To search our knowledge base for a solution or to log in to the Technical Support
portal and report a problem, go to www.hsmcontactsupport.com.
Product Service and Repair
Honeywell International Inc. provides service for all of its products through service
centers throughout the world. To obtain warranty or non-warranty service, you
must first obtain a Return Material Authorization number (RMA #) and then return
your product to Honeywell (postage paid) with a copy of the dated purchase record.
To learn more, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and select Service & Repair at the
bottom of the page.
Limited Warranty
For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and click Get Resources >
Product Warranty.
Send Feedback
Your feedback is crucial to the continual improvement of our documentation. To
provide feedback about this manual, contact the Honeywell Technical Communications department at [email protected].
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
xvii
xviii
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
1
GET STARTED
About This Manual
This User’s Guide provides installation and programming instructions for the
Xenon™ 1900 and 1910 corded area-imaging scanners, the Xenon 1902 and 1912
cordless area-imaging scanners, the Granit 1910i and 1980i corded industrial
scanners, and the Granit 1911i and 1981i cordless industrial scanners. Product
specifications, dimensions, warranty, and customer support information are also
included.
Honeywell bar code scanners are factory programmed for the most common terminal and communications settings. If you need to change these settings, programming is accomplished by scanning the bar codes in this guide.
An asterisk (*) next to an option indicates the default setting.
Unpack Your Device
After you open the shipping carton containing the product, take the following
steps:
•
Check for damage during shipment. Report damage immediately to the carrier
who delivered the carton.
•
Make sure the items in the carton match your order.
•
Save the shipping container for later storage or shipping.
Connect the Device
Connect with USB
A scanner or a cordless base can be connected to the USB port of a computer.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
1
1. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the device first, then to the computer.
Corded Xenon Scanner
USB Connection:
Corded Granit Scanner
USB Connection:
2
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
2. If you are connecting a Granit scanner, make sure the cable is pushed tightly
into the scanner. Loosen the locking plate and slide it over the base of the cable
connector to lock the cable in place. Tighten the screw.
CCB01-010BT/
CCB01-010BT-BF Base
USB Connection:
CCB02-100BT/
CCB05-100BT Base
USB Connection:
Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed.
3. If you are connecting a CCB01-010BT or CCB01-010BT-BF Base, make sure
the cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless base and
the base sits flat on a horizontal surface. If you are connecting a CCB02-100BT
or CCB05-100BT Base, see Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base on
page 9.
4. The scanner beeps.
5. Verify the scanner or cordless base operation by scanning a bar code from the
Sample Symbols, beginning on page 339.
The unit defaults to a USB PC Keyboard. Refer to page 18 for other USB terminal
settings.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
3
For additional USB programming and technical information, refer to “USB Application Note,” available at www.honeywellaidc.com.
Connect with Keyboard Wedge
A scanner or cordless base can be connected between the keyboard and PC as a
“keyboard wedge,” where the scanner provides data output that is similar to keyboard entries.
Note: The Granit 1980i does not support the keyboard wedge interface.
The following is an example of a keyboard wedge connection:
1. Turn off power and disconnect the keyboard cable from the back of the terminal/computer.
2. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the device and to the terminal/
computer.
Corded Xenon Scanner
Keyboard Wedge
Connection:
Corded Granit Scanner
Keyboard Wedge
Connection:
4
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
3. If you are connecting a Granit scanner, make sure the cable is pushed tightly
into the scanner. Loosen the locking plate and slide it over the base of the cable
connector to lock the cable in place. Tighten the screw.
CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base
Keyboard Wedge Connection:
CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base
Keyboard Wedge Connection:
Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed.
4. If you are connecting a CCB01-010BT or CCB01-010BT-BF Base, make sure
the cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless base and
the base sits flat on a horizontal surface. If you are connecting a CCB02-100BT
or CCB05-100BT Base, see Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base on
page 9.
5. Turn the terminal/computer power back on. The scanner beeps.
6. Verify the scanner or cordless base operation by scanning a bar code from the
Sample Symbols, beginning on page 339. The scanner beeps once. If using a
Granit scanner, it also vibrates.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
5
The unit defaults to an IBM PC AT and compatibles keyboard wedge interface with
a USA keyboard. A carriage return (CR) suffix is added to bar code data.
Connect with RS232 Serial Port
1. Turn off power to the terminal/computer.
2. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the scanner.
Note: For the scanner or cordless base to work properly, you must have the correct cable for
your type of terminal/computer.
Corded Xenon Scanner
RS232 Serial Port
Connection:
Corded Granit Scanner RS232 Serial
Port Connection:
6
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
3. If you are connecting a Granit scanner, make sure the cable is pushed tightly
into the scanner. Loosen the locking plate and slide it over the base of the cable
connector to lock the cable in place. Tighten the screw.
CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base
RS232 Serial Port Connection:
CCB02-100BT/CCB05/100BT Base
RS232 Serial Port Connection:
Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed.
4. If you are connecting a CCB01-010BTor CCB01-010BT-BF Base, make sure the
cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless base and the
base sits flat on a horizontal surface. If you are connecting a CCB02-100BT or
CCB05-100BT Base, see Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base on page
9.
5. Plug the serial connector into the serial port on your computer. Tighten the two
screws to secure the connector to the port.
6. Once the scanner or cordless base has been fully connected, power up the
computer.
This interface programs 115,200 baud, 8 data bits, no parity, and 1 stop bit.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
7
Connect with RS485
A Xenon scanner or cordless base can be connected for an IBM POS terminal interface. (This interface is not available in the Granit devices.)
1. Connect the appropriate interface cable to the device, then to the computer.
Corded Xenon Scanner
RS485 Connection:
CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base
RS485 Connection:
Note: The power supply must be ordered separately, if needed.
2. Make sure the cables are secured in the wireways in the bottom of the cordless
base and the base sits flat on a horizontal surface.
3. Turn the terminal/computer power back on. The scanner beeps.
4. Verify the scanner or cordless base operation by scanning a bar code from the
Sample Symbols, beginning on page 339. The scanner beeps once. If using a
Granit scanner, it also vibrates.
For further RS485 settings, refer to RS485, page 16.
8
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Mount a CCB01-010BT Charge Base
2.8 in.
72.1mm
3.35 in.
85.09mm
2.36 in.
59.84mm
8x32 thread
x .39 in. (10mm) deep
Mount a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base
The CCB02-100BT or CCB05-100BT Base can be mounted on either a horizontal
or vertical surface. The cables can be routed through either the top or the bottom
of the base.
The cables can be routed down through the bottom of the base, securing the
cables in the wireways.
The cables can also be routed up through the top of the base, crossing them over
and securing the cables in the wireways.
When routing the cables up through the top of the base, be sure to cross the cables
over before placing in the wireways. If not, too much strain is placed on the cable
connectors.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
9
When mounted on a vertical surface, a locking system is used to secure the scanner when it is in the stand. When mounted on a horizontal surface, the locking
mechanism should be set to unlocked (pushed up). When mounted on a vertical
surface, the locking mechanism should be set to locked (pushed down).
Locked position
for vertical mount
Unlocked position
for horizontal mount
Use 30mm screws, appropriate for the mounting surface material, to mount the
base securely.
2.51 in.
63.7mm
5.31 in.
134.92mm
2 in.
51.17mm
2.36 in.
60mm
.84 in.
21.42mm
10
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Reading Techniques
Xenon 1900/1902/1910/1912 and Granit 1910i/1911i
The Xenon 1900/1902 scanners have a view finder that projects a bright red aiming beam that corresponds to the scanner’s horizontal field of view. The Xenon
1910/1912 and Granit 1910i/1911i scanners have an aiming pattern. The aiming
beam or pattern should be centered over the bar code, but it can be positioned in
any direction for a good read.
Linear bar codes with
aiming beam
2D Matrix symbol
with aiming beam
Linear bar codes with
aiming pattern
2D Matrix symbol
with aiming pattern
Granit 1980i/1981i
The Granit 1980i/1981i scanners use a laser aimer (red dot) and a red LED (red
box) to locate bar codes. Use the red LED when scanning at a near distance (less
than 11.8 inches / 30 cm) and center the box over the bar code. The laser aimer
(red dot) appears to the right of the center of the bar code. Use the laser aimer (red
dot) when scanning at a far distance (up to 50 feet / 15.2 meters) and aim at the
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
11
center of the bar code. At far distances the red box may not be apparent. For both
near distance and far distance, the aimers can be positioned in any direction for a
good read.
Near distance scanning
less than 11.8 in/30 cm
Far distance scanning
up to 50 ft/15.2 m
The aiming beam or pattern is smaller when the scanner is closer to the code and
larger when it is farther from the code. Symbologies with smaller bars or elements
(mil size) should be read closer to the unit. Symbologies with larger bars or elements (mil size) should be read farther from the unit. To read single or multiple
symbols (on a page or on an object), hold the scanner at an appropriate distance
from the target, pull the trigger, and center the aiming beam or pattern on the symbol. If the code being scanned is highly reflective (e.g., laminated), it may be necessary to tilt the code up 15° to 18° to prevent unwanted reflection.
Menu Bar Code Security Settings
Honeywell scanners are programmed by scanning menu bar codes or by sending
serial commands to the scanner. If you want to restrict the ability to scan menu
codes, you can use the Menu Bar Code Security settings. Contact the nearest technical support office (see Technical Assistance on page xvii) for further information.
Set Custom Defaults
You have the ability to create a set of menu commands as your own, custom
defaults. To do so, scan the Set Custom Defaults bar code below before scanning
the menu commands for your custom defaults. If a menu command requires scanning numeric codes from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then a
12
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Save code, that entire sequence will be saved to your custom defaults. When you
have entered all the commands you want to save for your custom defaults, scan the
Save Custom Defaults bar code.
Set Custom Defaults
Save Custom Defaults
Note: When using a cordless system, the Custom Defaults settings apply to all workgroups.
Scanning the Save Defaults bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or
Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in
its base to re-establish the link before any setup codes are entered. If using an Access
Point, the linking bar code must be scanned. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon
1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41,or Cordless System
Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for additional information.
You may have a series of custom settings and want to correct a single setting. To do
so, just scan the new setting to overwrite the old one. For example, if you had previously saved the setting for Beeper Volume at Low to your custom defaults, and
decide you want the beeper volume set to High, just scan the Set Custom Defaults
bar code, then scan the Beeper Volume High menu code, and then Save Custom
Defaults. The rest of the custom defaults will remain, but the beeper volume setting will be updated.
Reset the Custom Defaults
If you want the custom default settings restored to your scanner, scan the Activate
Custom Defaults bar code below. This is the recommended default bar code for
most users. It resets the scanner to the custom default settings. If there are no custom defaults, it will reset the scanner to the factory default settings. Any settings
that have not been specified through the custom defaults will be defaulted to the
factory default settings.
Activate Custom Defaults
Note: If using a cordless system, scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and
the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must
be placed in its base to re-establish the link. If using an Access Point, the linking bar
code must be scanned. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and
Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41,or Cordless System Operation: Xenon
1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for additional information.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
13
14
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
2
PROGRAM THE INTERFACE
Introduction
This chapter describes how to program your system for the desired interface.
Program the Interface - Plug and Play
Plug and Play bar codes provide instant scanner set up for commonly used interfaces.
Note: After you scan one of the codes, power cycle the host terminal to have the interface in
effect.
Keyboard Wedge
If you want your system programmed for an IBM PC AT and compatibles keyboard
wedge interface with a USA keyboard, scan the bar code below. Keyboard wedge is
the default interface.
Note: The Granit 1980i does not support the keyboard wedge interface.
Note: The following bar code also programs a carriage return (CR) suffix.
IBM PC AT and Compatibles with
CR suffix
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
15
Laptop Direct Connect
For most laptops, scanning the Laptop Direct Connect bar code allows operation
of the scanner in parallel with the integral keyboard. The following Laptop Direct
Connect bar code also programs a carriage return (CR) suffix and turns on Emulate External Keyboard (page 31).
Note: The Granit 1980i does not support Laptop Direct Connect.
Laptop Direct Connect
with CR suffix
RS232 Serial Port
The RS232 Interface bar code is used when connecting to the serial port of a PC or
terminal. The following RS232 Interface bar code also programs a carriage return
(CR) and a line feed (LF) suffix, baud rate, and data format as indicated below. It
also changes the trigger mode to manual.
Option
Setting
Baud Rate
115,200 bps
Data Format
8 data bits, no parity bit, 1 stop bit
RS232 Interface
RS485
Scan one of the following “Plug and Play” codes to program the scanner for an IBM
POS terminal interface.
Note: This interface is not supported in Granit devices.
After scanning one of these codes, you must power cycle the cash register.
IBM Port 5B Interface
IBM Port 9B
HHBCR-1 Interface
16
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
IBM Port 17 Interface
IBM Port 9B
HHBCR-2 Interface
Each bar code above also programs the following suffixes for each symbology:
Symbolog
y
Suffix
Symbology
Suffix
EAN 8
0C
Code 39
00 0A 0B
EAN 13
16
Interleaved 2 of 5
00 0D 0B
UPC A
0D
Code 128 *
00 0A 0B
UPC E
0A
Code 128 **
00 18 0B
MaxiCode
00 2F 0B
* Suffixes programmed for Code 128 with IBM 4683 Port 5B, IBM 4683 Port 9B HHBCR-1, and IBM 4683
Port 17 Interfaces
**Suffixes programmed for Code 128 with IBM 4683 Port 9 HHBCR-2 Interface
RS485 Packet Mode
The following selection allows you to break up large bar code data into smaller
packets on an IBM POS terminal. To break up large bar codes into small packets,
scan the Packet Mode On bar code below. Scan the Packet Mode Off bar code if
you want large bar code data to be sent to the host in a single chunk. Default =
Packet Mode Off.
* Packet Mode Off
Packet Mode On
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
17
RS485 Packet Length
If you are using Packet mode, you can specify the size of the data “packet” that is
sent to the host. Scan the Packet Length bar code, then the packet size (from 20 256) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default =
40.
Packet Length
USB IBM SurePos
Scan one of the following “Plug and Play” codes to program the scanner for an IBM
SurePos (USB handheld scanner) or IBM SurePos (USB tabletop scanner) interface.
Note: After scanning one of these codes, you must power cycle the cash register.
USB IBM SurePos
(USB Handheld Scanner)
Interface
USB IBM SurePos
(USB Tabletop Scanner)
Interface
Each bar code above also programs the following suffixes for each symbology:
Symbology
Suffix
Symbology
Suffix
EAN 8
0C
Code 39
00 0A 0B
EAN 13
16
Interleaved 2 of 5
00 0D 0B
UPC A
0D
Code 128
00 18 0B
UPC E
0A
Code 39
00 0A 0B
USB PC or Macintosh Keyboard
Scan one of the following codes to program the scanner for USB PC Keyboard or
USB Macintosh Keyboard. Scanning these codes also adds a CR suffix.
USB Keyboard (PC)
18
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
USB Keyboard (Mac)
USB Japanese Keyboard (PC)
USB HID
Scan the following code to program the scanner for USB HID bar code scanners.
USB HID Bar Code Scanner
USB Serial
If you are using a Microsoft® Windows® PC, you will need to download the latest
driver from the Honeywell website (www.honeywellaidc.com) and go to Get
Resources - Downloads - Software. The driver will use the next available COM Port
number. Apple® Macintosh computers recognize the scanner as a USB CDC class
device and automatically use a class driver.
After the driver is downloaded, scan the following code to program the scanner to
emulate a regular RS232-based COM Port.
USB Serial
No extra configuration (e.g., baud rate) is necessary.
Note: If you scan the USB Serial bar code either with an older Honeywell serial driver, or no
driver installed, you may no longer be able to scan bar codes. If this happens, either
uninstall the older driver versions and install the latest driver, or delete the specific
device entry in Device Manager.
CTS/RTS Emulation
CTS/RTS Emulation On
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
19
* CTS/RTS Emulation Off
ACK/NAK Mode
ACK/NAK Mode On
* ACK/NAK Mode Off
Remote MasterMind™ for USB
When using a USB interface, you may wish to configure your scanner to communicate with Remote MasterMind Scanner Management Software (ReM). Scan the
ReM On bar code to communicate with ReM. To disable this capability, scan ReM
Off.
ReM Off
ReM On
Verifone® Ruby Terminal
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Verifone Ruby
terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 1200 bps and the data format to 8
data bits, mark parity bit, 1 stop bit. It also adds a line feed (LF) suffix and programs the following prefixes for each symbology:
20
Symbology
Prefix
UPC-A
A
UPC-E
A
EAN-8
FF
EAN-13
F
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Verifone Ruby Settings
Gilbarco® Terminal
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Gilbarco terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 2400 bps and the data format to 7 data bits,
even parity, 2 stop bits. It also adds a carriage return (CR) suffix and programs the
following prefixes for each symbology:
Symbology
Prefix
UPC-A
A
UPC-E
E0
EAN-8
FF
EAN-13
F
Gilbarco Settings
Honeywell Bioptic Aux Port
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Honeywell
bioptic scanner auxiliary port configuration. This bar code sets the baud rate to
38400 bps and the data format to 8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit.
Honeywell Bioptic Settings
Datalogic™ Magellan® Aux Port
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Datalogic
Magellan auxiliary port configuration. This bar code sets the baud rate to 9600 bps
and the data format to 8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit.
Datalogic Magellan Settings
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
21
NCR Bioptic Aux Port
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for an NCR bioptic
scanner auxiliary port configuration. The following prefixes are programmed for
each symbology:
Symbology
Prefix
Symbology
Prefix
UPC-A
A
Interleaved 2 of 5
b
UPC-E
E0
Code 128
f
Code 32
Pharmaceutical
(PARAF)
a
Code 39
a
EAN-8
FF
EAN-13
F
NCR Bioptic Settings
Wincor Nixdorf Terminal
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Wincor Nixdorf
terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 9600 bps and the data format to 8
data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit.
Wincor Nixdorf Terminal Settings
Wincor Nixdorf Beetle™ Terminal
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Wincor Nixdorf
Beetle terminal. The following prefixes are programmed for each symbology:
22
Symbology
Prefix
Symbology
Prefix
Aztec Code
V
Interleaved 2 of 5
I
Codabar
N
MaxiCode
T
Code 93
L
MicroPDF417
S
Code 128
K
PDF417
Q
Data Matrix
R
QR Code
U
EAN-8
B
Straight 2 of 5 IATA H
EAN-13
A
UPC-A
A0
GS1 DataBar
E
UPC-E
C
GS1-128
P
All other bar codes
M
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Wincor Nixdorf Beetle Settings
Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A
Scan the following Plug and Play code to program the scanner for a Wincor Nixdorf
RS232 Mode A terminal. This bar code sets the baud rate to 9600 bps and the data
format to 8 data bits, odd parity, 1 stop bit. The following prefixes are programmed
for each symbology:
Note: This setting is not supported in Granit devices.
Symbology
Prefix
Symbology
Prefix
Code 128
K
EAN-13
A
Code 93
L
GS1-128
K
Codabar
N
Interleaved 2 of 5
I
UPC-A
A0
Plessey
O
UPC-E
C
Straight 2 of 5 IATA
H
EAN-8
B
GS1 DataBar
E
All other bar codes
M
Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A
Settings
Keyboard Country Layout
If your interface is USB Keyboard or Keyboard Wedge, your keyboard layout default
is a US keyboard. To change this layout, scan the appropriate Keyboard Country
bar code below. By default, national character replacements are used for the following characters: # $ @ [ \ ] ^ ‘ { | } ~. Refer to the "ISO 2022/ISO 646
Character Replacements" on page A-334 to view the character replacements for
each country.
Keyboard Countries
* United States
Albania
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
23
Keyboard Countries (Continued)
Azeri (Cyrillic)
Azeri (Latin)
Belarus
Belgium
Bosnia
Brazil
Brazil (MS)
Bulgaria (Cyrillic)
Bulgaria (Latin)
Canada (French legacy)
Canada (French)
Canada (Multilingual)
24
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Keyboard Countries (Continued)
Croatia
Czech
Czech (Programmers)
Czech (QWERTY)
Czech (QWERTZ)
Denmark
Dutch (Netherlands)
Estonia
Faroese
Finland
France
Gaelic
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
25
Keyboard Countries (Continued)
Germany
Greek
Greek (220 Latin)
Greek (220)
Greek (319 Latin)
Greek (319)
Greek (Latin)
Greek (MS)
Greek (Polytonic)
Hebrew
Hungarian (101 key)
Hungary
26
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Keyboard Countries (Continued)
Iceland
Irish
Italian (142)
Italy
Japan ASCII
Kazakh
Kyrgyz (Cyrillic)
Latin America
Latvia
Latvia (QWERTY)
Lithuania
Lithuania (IBM)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
27
Keyboard Countries (Continued)
Macedonia
Malta
Mongolian (Cyrillic)
Norway
Poland
Polish (214)
Polish (Programmers)
Portugal
Romania
Russia
Russian (MS)
Russian (Typewriter)
28
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Keyboard Countries (Continued)
SCS
Serbia (Cyrillic)
Serbia (Latin)
Slovakia
Slovakia (QWERTY)
Slovakia (QWERTZ)
Slovenia
Spain
Spanish variation
Sweden
Switzerland (French)
Switzerland (German)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
29
Keyboard Countries (Continued)
Tatar
Turkey F
Turkey Q
Ukrainian
United Kingdom
United States (Dvorak)
United States (Dvorak left)
United Stated (Dvorak
United States (International)
Uzbek (Cyrillic)
Keyboard Style
This programs keyboard styles, such as Caps Lock and Shift Lock. If you have used
Keyboard Conversion settings, they will override any of the following Keyboard
Style settings. Default = Regular.
30
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Regular is used when you normally have the Caps Lock key off.
* Regular
Caps Lock is used when you normally have the Caps Lock key on.
Caps Lock
Shift Lock is used when you normally have the Shift Lock key on (not common to
U.S. keyboards).
Shift Lock
Automatic Caps Lock is used if you change the Caps Lock key on and off. The software tracks and reflects if you have Caps Lock on or off . This selection can only be
used with systems that have an LED that notes the Caps Lock status (AT keyboards).
Automatic Caps Lock
Autocaps via NumLock bar code should be scanned in countries (e.g., Germany,
France) where the Caps Lock key cannot be used to toggle Caps Lock. The NumLock option works similarly to the regular Autocaps, but uses the NumLock key to
retrieve the current state of the Caps Lock.
Autocaps via NumLock
Emulate External Keyboard should be scanned if you do not have an external keyboard (IBM AT or equivalent).
Emulate External Keyboard
Note: After scanning the Emulate External Keyboard bar code, you must power cycle your
computer.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
31
Keyboard Conversion
Alphabetic keyboard characters can be forced to be all upper case or all lowercase.
So if you have the following bar code: “abc569GK,” you can make the output
“ABC569GK” by scanning Convert All Characters to Upper Case, or to “abc569gk”
by scanning Convert All Characters to Lower Case.
These settings override Keyboard Style selections.
Note: If your interface is a keyboard wedge, first scan the menu code for Automatic Caps
Lock (page 31). Otherwise, your output may not be as expected.
Default = Keyboard Conversion Off.
* Keyboard Conversion Off
Convert All Characters
to Upper Case
Convert All Characters
to Lower Case
Control Character Output
This selection sends a text string instead of a control character. For example, when
the control character for a carriage return is expected, the output would display
[CR] instead of the ASCII code of 0D. Refer to ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page
1252) on page 330. Only codes 00 through 1F are converted (the first column of
the chart). Default = Off.
Note: Control + X (Control + ASCII) Mode overrides this mode.
Control Character Output On
* Control Character Output Off
32
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Keyboard Modifiers
This modifies special keyboard features, such as CTRL+ ASCII codes and Turbo
Mode.
Control + X (Control + ASCII) Mode On: The scanner sends key combinations for
ASCII control characters for values 00-1F. Windows is the preferred mode. All keyboard country codes are supported. DOS mode is a legacy mode, and it does not
support all keyboard country codes. New users should use the Windows mode.
Refer to ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330 for CTRL+ X Values.
Windows Mode Prefix/Suffix Off: The scanner sends key combinations for ASCII
control characters for values 00-1F, but it does not translate prefix or suffix information.
Default = Control + X Mode Off.
Windows Mode Control + X
Mode On
* Control + X Mode Off
DOS Mode Control + X Mode On
Windows Mode Prefix/Suffix
Turbo Mode: The scanner sends characters to a terminal faster. If the terminal
drops characters, do not use Turbo Mode. Default = Off.
Turbo Mode On
* Turbo Mode Off
Numeric Keypad Mode: Sends numeric characters as if entered from a numeric
keypad. Default = Off.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
33
Numeric Keypad Mode On
* Numeric Keypad Mode Off
Automatic Direct Connect Mode: This selection can be used if you have an IBM AT
style terminal and the system is dropping characters. Default = Off.
Automatic Direct Connect
Mode On
* Automatic Direct Connect
Mode Off
RS232 Modifiers
RS232 Baud Rate
Baud Rate sends the data from the scanner to the terminal at the specified rate.
The host terminal must be set for the same baud rate as the scanner. Default =
115,200.
300
600
1200
2400
34
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
4800
9600
19200
38400
57,600
* 115,200
RS232 Word Length: Data Bits, Stop Bits, and Parity
Data Bits sets the word length at 7 or 8 bits of data per character. If an application
requires only ASCII Hex characters 0 through 7F decimal (text, digits, and punctuation), select 7 data bits. For applications that require use of the full ASCII set, select
8 data bits per character. Default = 8.
Stop Bits sets the stop bits at 1 or 2. Default = 1.
Parity provides a means of checking character bit patterns for validity.
Default = None.
7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even
7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None
7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
35
7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Even
7 Data, 2 Stop Parity None
7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Odd
8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even
* 8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None
8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd
8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Mark
RS232 Receiver Time-Out
The unit stays awake to receive data until the RS232 Receiver Time-Out expires. A
manual or serial trigger resets the time-out. When an RS232 receiver is sleeping, a
character may be sent to wake up the receiver and reset the time-out. A transaction
on the CTS line will also wake up the receiver. The receiver takes 300 milliseconds
to completely come up. Change the RS232 receiver time-out by scanning the bar
code below, then scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page
341, then scanning Save. The range is 0 to 300 seconds. Default = 0 seconds (no
time-out - always on).
RS232 Receiver Time-Out
36
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
RS232 Handshake
RS232 Handshaking allows control of data transmission from the scanner using
software commands from the host device. When RTS/CTS is turned Off, no data
flow control is used.
Flow Control, No Timeout: The scanner asserts RTS when it has data to send, and
will wait indefinitely for CTS to be asserted by the host.
Two-Direction Flow Control: The scanner asserts RTS when it is OK for the host to
transmit. The host asserts CTS when it is OK for the device to transmit.
Flow Control with Timeout: The scanner asserts RTS when it has data to send and
waits for a delay (see RS232 Timeout on page 37) for CTS to be asserted by the
host. If the delay time expires and CTS is not asserted, the device transmit buffer is
cleared and scanning may resume. Default = RTS/CTS Off.
Flow Control, No Timeout
Two-Direction Flow Control
Flow Control with Timeout
* RTS/CTS Off
RS232 Timeout
When using Flow Control with Timeout, you must program the length of the delay
you want to wait for CTS from the host. Set the length (in milliseconds) for a timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 1-5100 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then scanning Save.
RS232 Timeout
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
37
XON/XOFF
Standard ASCII control characters can be used to tell the scanner to start sending
data (XON/XOFF On) or to stop sending data (XON/XOFF Off). When the host
sends the XOFF character (DC3, hex 13) to the scanner, data transmission stops.
To resume transmission, the host sends the XON character (DC1, hex 11). Data
transmission continues where it left off when XOFF was sent. Default = XON/XOFF
Off.
XON/XOFF On
* XON/XOFF Off
ACK/NAK
After transmitting data, the scanner waits for an ACK character (hex 06) or a NAK
character (hex 15) response from the host. If ACK is received, the communications
cycle is completed and the scanner looks for more bar codes. If NAK is received, the
last set of bar code data is retransmitted and the scanner waits for ACK/NAK again.
Turn on the ACK/NAK protocol by scanning the ACK/NAK On bar code below. To
turn off the protocol, scan ACK/NAK Off. Default = ACK/NAK Off.
ACK/NAK On
* ACK/NAK Off
Scanner to Bioptic Communication
The following settings are used to set up communication between Honeywell scanners and bioptic scanners.
Note: The scanner’s baud rate must be set to 38400 and the RS232 timeout must be set to
3000 in order to communicate with a bioptic scanner. See "RS232 Modifiers" on page
34, and RS232 Timeout on page 37 for further information.
38
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Scanner-Bioptic Packet Mode
Packet Mode On must be scanned to set the scanner’s format so it is compatible
with a bioptic scanner. Default = Packet Mode Off.
* Packet Mode Off
Packet Mode On
Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Mode
Bioptic ACK/NAK On must be scanned so the scanner will wait for an ACK or NAK
from a bioptic scanner after each packet is sent. The Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK
Timeout (below) controls how long the scanner will wait for a response. Default =
Bioptic ACK/NAK Off.
* Bioptic ACK/NAK Off
Bioptic ACK/NAK On
Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Timeout
This allows you to set the length (in milliseconds) for a timeout for a bioptic scanner’s ACK/NAK response. Scan the bar code below, then set the timeout (from 130,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning
on page 341, then scanning Save. Default = 5100.
ACK/NAK Timeout
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
39
40
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
3
CORDLESS SYSTEM OPERATION:
XENON 1902G/1912 AND
GRANIT 1911I/1981I
Note: This chapter does not apply to corded or Xenon 1902g-BF scanners. See Cordless
System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for Xenon 1902g-BF
scanning systems.
How the Cordless Charge Base/Access Point Works
A cordless charge base or an Access Point provide the link between the cordless
scanner and the host system. The base/Access Point contains an interface assembly and an RF communication module. The RF communication module performs
the data exchange between the cordless scanner and the interface assembly. The
control assembly coordinates the central interface activities including: transmitting/receiving commands and data to/from the host system, performing software
activities (parameter menuing, visual indicator support, power-on diagnostics),
and data translation required for the host system.
The cordless charge base is also a scanner’s battery charger. Refer to Charge
Information, page 47, for additional information.
Link the Scanner to a Charge Base
Turn off power before connecting a base, then power up the computer once the
base is fully connected. When the base is connected and powered up, put the scanner in the base to establish a link. The green LED on the base flashes to indicate
the scanner’s battery is charging.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
41
If the scanner and base have previously been linked, you do not receive any feedback. If this is the first time that the scanner and base are linked, both devices emit
a short chirp when their radios link. At this point, that one scanner is linked to one
base.
Xenon Scanner
CCB01-010BT Charge Base
Page Button and Base LEDs
Granit Scanner
CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT
Charge Base Page Button and Base
LEDs
To determine if your cordless system is set up correctly, scan one of the sample bar
codes in the back of this manual. If the scanner provides a single good read beep
and the green LED lights, the scanner has successfully linked to the base. If using
a Granit scanner, the scanner also vibrates. If you receive an error tone and the red
LED lights, the scanner has not linked to the base. Refer to page 325 for troubleshooting information.
Link the Scanner to an Access Point
Turn on the computer (laptop/desktop). Plug the interface
cable into the Access Point first and then into the appropriate port on the computer. The Page button lights up when
the connection to the host is made.
Page
Button
Scan the linking bar code on the top of the Access Point to
establish a connection between the Access Point and the
scanner. The scanner emits a short beep and flashes the
green LED to confirm a connection with the Access Point.
The Access Point’s Page button remains blue.
42
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Replace a Linked Scanner
If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base or an Access
Point, scan the Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and
place that scanner in the base, or scan the Access Point linking bar code. The
locked link will be overridden; the broken or lost scanner’s link with the base or
Access Point will be removed, and the new scanner will be linked.
Override Locked Scanner
(Single Scanner)
Communication Between the Cordless System
and the Host
The cordless scanner provides immediate feedback in the form of a “good read”
indication with a green LED on the scanner and an audible beep. If using a Granit
scanner, the scanner also vibrates. This indicates that the bar code has been
scanned correctly and the base or Access Point has acknowledged receiving the
data. This is possible since the cordless system provides two-way communication
between the scanner and the base or Access Point.
When data is scanned, the data is sent to the host system via the base or Access
Point. The cordless scanner recognizes data acknowledgment (ACK) from the base
or Access Point. If it cannot be determined that the data has been properly sent to
the base or Access Point, the scanner issues an error indication. You must then
check to see if the scanned data was received by the host system.
2
1
2
1
2
1. Scanner reads code and gets ACK from base or Access Point
2. Base or Access Point sends data to host
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
43
Program the Scanner and Base or Access Point
When using the scanner and charge base or Access Point together as a system,
menu parameters and configuration settings are stored in the charge base or
Access Point. Therefore, when programming any menu configuration settings, the
scanner must be linked to the intended charge base or Access Point.
Note: This only applies when the scanner is linked to a charge base or Access Point. If the
scanner is in a non-base mode, configuration settings are stored in the scanner.
RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation
The cordless system uses a two-way Bluetooth® radio to transmit and receive data
between the scanner and the base or Access Point. Designed for point-to-point
and multi-point-to-single point applications, the radio operates using a license
free ISM band, which sends relatively small data packets at a fast data rate over a
radio signal with randomly changing frequencies, makes the cordless system
highly responsive to a wide variety of data collection applications and resistant to
noisy RF environments. The CCB01-010BT (Bluetooth Class 2) provides a communication range of 33 feet (10m) between the scanner and base or Access Point,
depending on the environment. The CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT (Bluetooth
Class 1) provides a communication range of 330 feet (100m) between the scanner
and base or Access Point, depending on the environment. See Flexible Power
Management, page 58, for information about controlling this range.
System Conditions
The components of the cordless system interact in specific ways as you associate a
scanner to a base or Access Point, as you move a scanner out of range, bring a
scanner back in range, or swap scanners between two cordless systems. The following information explains the cordless system operating conditions.
Link Process
Once a scanner is placed into a cordless charge base, the scanner’s battery charge
status is checked, and software automatically detects the scanner and links it to
the base depending on the selected link mode.
Refer to Link the Scanner to an Access Point, page 42, for information about linking to an Access Point.
Scanner Is Out of Range
The cordless scanner is in communication with its base or Access Point, even when
it is not transmitting bar code data. Whenever the scanner can’t communicate with
the base or Access Point for a few seconds, it is out of range. If the scanner is out of
44
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
range and you scan a bar code, the scanner issues an error tone indicating no communication with the base or Access Point. A cordless charge base can also sound
an alarm. Refer to Out-of-Range Alarm, page 56.
Scanner Is Moved Back Into Range
The scanner relinks if the scanner or the base or Access Point have been reset, or
the scanner comes back into range. If the scanner relinks, you will hear a single
chirp when the relinking process (uploading of the parameter table) is complete.
Refer to Out-of-Range Alarm on page 56 for further information.
Out of Range and Back into Range with Batch Mode On
The scanner may store a number of symbols (approximately 500 U.P.C. symbols;
others may vary) when it is out of range and then send them to the base or Access
Point when back in range (see Batch Mode on page 59).
You will not hear a communication error tone in this mode, but you will hear a short
buzz when you pull the trigger if the radio communication is not working. Once the
radio connection is made, the scanner produces a series of beeps while the data is
being transferred to the base or Access Point.
Page Button
When you press the Page button on the base or Access Point, the scanners associated with that base or Access Point will begin beeping (3 short and 1 long beep). If
you pull the trigger on a scanner that is beeping in response, or press the Page button on the base or Access Point a second time, all associated scanners will stop
beeping. See Page on page 51 for further information about Page Button settings.
Note: If you are using a Xenon 1902h model, refer to Quiet Operations - LED and Volume
Settings on page 145 for additional Page Button settings.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
45
Page Button and Presentation Modes
When in Streaming Presentation Mode, the scanner’s aimer goes out after a short
time, but the scan illumination remains on all the time to continuously search for
bar codes (see Streaming Presentation™ Mode on page 124). When in Temporary
Streaming Presentation Mode, pressing the page button on the base puts the
scanner into Streaming Presentation Mode until the timeout occurs. If a bar code is
scanned before the timeout is reached, the timer starts over.
When the scanner is in the base, press the page button once to put the scanner
into Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode. When the scanner is in the base and
the base has external power (plugged into an outlet), press the page button twice
to put the scanner into Streaming Presentation Mode. Press it twice again to end
Streaming Presentation Mode. When the base does not have external power, pressing the page button twice does not trigger Streaming Presentation Mode.
When the scanner is out of the base, the page button works normally. Default =
Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode On.
* Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode
On
To remove Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode, scan the bar code for * Page
Mode On on page 52.
Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout
Set a timeout for the length of time the illumination remains on and searching for
bar codes when using Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode. Set the length for
the timeout by scanning one of the bar codes below. Default = 10,000 ms (10 seconds).
*10 Second Timeout
46
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
60 Second Timeout
About the Battery
Warning: There is a danger of explosion if the batteries are incorrectly
replaced. Replace the batteries with only the same or equivalent
type recommended by the manufacturer. Dispose of used
batteries according to the recycle program for batteries as
directed by the governing agency for the country where the
batteries are to be discarded.
Power is supplied to the cordless scanner by a rechargeable battery that is integrated in the scanner handle. Batteries are shipped only partially charged. The battery should be charged for a minimum of 4 hours before initial use to ensure
optimal performance.
Charge Information
The battery is designed to charge while the scanner is positioned in the cordless
base unit. Refer to Base/Access Point LED Sequences and Meaning, page 49, for
an interpretation of the Charge Status indicators. Refer to Charge Only Mode (page
54) if you need to charge a scanner without linking it to the base.
Place the scanner in the base that is connected to an appropriate power supply.
Use only a Listed Limited Power Source (LPS) or Class 2 type power supply with
output rated 5 to 5.2Vdc, 1A.
Note: If you are powering the base through the interface cable (for example, a USB cable)
and not using an external power supply plugged into the aux port, the current
available for charging is reduced and charge times are increased.
Battery Recommendations
•
The battery is a lithium ion cell and can be used without a full charge, and can
also be charged without fully discharging, without impacting the battery life.
There is no need to perform any charge/discharge conditioning on this type of
battery.
•
Keep the base connected to power when the host is not in use.
•
Replace a defective battery immediately since it could damage the scanner.
•
Although your battery can be recharged many times, it will eventually be
depleted. Replace it after the battery is unable to hold an adequate charge.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
47
•
If you are not sure if the battery or charger is working properly, send it to
Honeywell International Inc. or an authorized service center for inspection.
Refer to Customer Support on page xvii for additional information.
Caution: Use only Honeywell Li-ion battery packs, model number BATSCN01, rated 3.7 Vdc, 7.4Whr in this device. Use of any nonHoneywell battery may result in damage not covered by the
warranty.
Safety Precautions for Lithium Batteries
•
Do not place batteries in fire or heat the batteries.
•
Do not store batteries near fire or other high temperature locations.
•
Do not store or carry batteries together with metal objects.
•
Do not expose batteries to water or allow the batteries to get wet.
•
Do not connect (short) the positive and negative terminals, of the batteries, to
each other with any metal object.
•
Do not pierce, strike or step on batteries or subject batteries to strong impacts or
shocks.
•
Do not disassemble or modify batteries.
Caution: Danger of explosion if batteries are incorrectly replaced.
Dispose of used batteries according to the recycle program for
batteries as directed by the governing agency for the country
where the batteries are to be discarded.
Proper Disposal of the Battery
When the battery has reached the end of its useful life, the battery
should be disposed of by a qualified recycler or hazardous materials
handler. Do not incinerate the battery or dispose of the battery with
general waste materials. You may send the scanner’s battery to us.
(postage paid). The shipper is responsible for complying with all federal, state, and local laws and regulations related to the packing,
labeling, manifesting, and shipping of spent batteries. Contact the Product Service
Department (page xvii) for recycling or disposal information. Since you may find
that your cost of returning the batteries significant, it may be more cost effective to
locate a local recycle/disposal company.
Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning
The scanner contains LEDs on the rear of the unit that indicate linking status,
decoding state, and battery condition. The base has LEDs on the top of the unit
that indicate its power up, communication, and battery charge condition. The red
48
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
LED = error; green LED = success of any type. Scanners and the CCB01-010BT
base have audible indicators as well: 1 razz or error tone = error; 2 beeps = menu
change; 1 beep = all other successes.
The table below lists the indication and cause of the LED indication, beeps, and
vibrations for the scanner.
Scanner LED Sequences and Meaning
Beeper
Indication
Vibrate
Indication
Cause
Red Flash
None
None
Battery low
Green Flash
1 beep
None
Successful communication or
linking
Red, blinking
Razz or error tone
None
Failed communication
Green Flash
2 beeps
2 vibrations
Successful menu change
Red, blinking
Razz or error tone
1 long vibration
Unsuccessful menu change
LED Indication
Normal
Operation
Menu Operation
Base/Access Point LED Sequences and Meaning
The base contains a red LED and the Access Point has a blue LED that indicate the
status of the unit and verifies its communication with the host system. The base
also has a green LED that indicates scanner battery charge condition.
Red or Blue LED - Host Communication
Red or Blue LED
Communication Condition
Off
USB suspend
On continuously
Power on, system idle
Short blinks in multiple pulses. Occurs while transferring data to/
from the RF module or the Host port.
Receiving data
Green LED - Scanner Battery
(base only, does not apply to Access Point)
Green LED
Charge Condition
Off
Battery not detected or charge
suspended
Slow flash, 1 second on, 1 second off
Pre-charge and charging
On continuously
Charge complete
Fast flash, 300 mSec on, 300 mSec off
Charge Error
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
49
Base Power Communication Indicator
To display the power indicator on a base or an Access Point, scan the Base Power
Communication Indicator On bar code. To turn off the power indicator, scan the
Off bar code. Default = On.
* Base Power Communication
Indicator On
Base Power Communication
Indicator Off
Reset Scanner
Scanning this bar code reboots the scanner and causes it to relink with the base or
Access Point.
Reset Scanner
Scan While in Base Cradle
Note: This feature only applies to the CCB01-010BT base.
If you want to be able to scan bar codes while the scanner is in the base cradle,
scan the Scan in Cradle On bar code below. If you want to only allow scanning
when the scanner is out of the base cradle, scan Scan in Cradle Off. If you want the
scanner to shut down when in the base cradle, scan Shut Down Scanner in Cradle.
Default = Scan in Cradle On (for CCB01-010BT).
Scan in Cradle Off
* Scan in Cradle On
Shut Down Scanner in Cradle
50
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Base Charge Modes
When the base has both an external power supply (plugged into the auxiliary power
port) and a host interface cable, it will draw its power from the external power supply. When the base does not have an external power supply, it draws its power from
the interface cable. However, the scanner battery charges more slowly from a host
interface cable than if auxiliary power were available. Using the following selections, you can specify whether the scanner battery is charged from power supplied
via the host interface cable.
When Base Charge Off is selected, the scanner battery does not charge when the
scanner is in the base cradle.
When External or Interface Cable Power is selected, the scanner battery charges
from the base’s external power supply, if there is one. If there is no external power
supply to the base, the scanner battery charges from the interface cable.
When External Power Only is selected, the scanner battery only charges from the
base’s external power supply. If there is no external power supply, the scanner battery does not charge.
Note: If you are using a cordless charge base in Presentation Mode, External Power Only
is the only setting available.
Default = External or Interface Cable Power.
Base Charge Off
External or Interface Cable
Power
External Power Only
Page
Page Mode
By default, the paging button on the base or Access Point pages the scanners
associated with that base or Access Point. If you want the paging button on your
base or Access Point to be disabled, scan the Page Mode Off bar code, below.
When Page Mode is off, the base or Access Point will no longer page scanners when
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
51
the button is pressed. The red LED on the base or blue LED on the Access Point will
remain lit to indicate that Page Mode is off. (This light will go out when the button
is pressed, then back on when it’s released.) Default = Page Mode On.
Note: If you are using a Xenon 1902h model, refer to Quiet Operations - LED and Volume
Settings on page 145 for additional Page Button settings.
* Page Mode On
Page Mode Off
Page Pitch
When you press the Page button on the base or Access Point, the scanners associated with that base or Access Point will begin beeping (see Page Button on page
45). You can set the pitch of the paging beep for each scanner by scanning one of
the following bar codes. Default = Low.
* Low (1000 Hz)
Medium (3250 Hz)
High (4200 Hz)
Error Indicators
Beeper Pitch - Base Error
Note: This feature only applies to the CCB01-010BT base.
The CCB01-010BT base can be configured to beep at a particular pitch when an
error occurs, such as transmission problems to a host system. The beeper pitch
codes modify the pitch (frequency) of the error tone the base emits when there is
an error. Default = Low.
52
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
* Razz (250 Hz)
Medium (3250 Hz)
High (4200 Hz)
Number of Beeps - Base Error
Note: This feature only applies to the CCB01-010BT base.
The number of beeps and LED flashes emitted by the CCB01-010BT base for an
error condition can be programmed from 1 - 9. For example, if you program this
option to have five error beeps, there will be five error beeps and five LED flashes in
response to an error. To change the number of error beeps, scan the bar code below
and then scan a digit (1-9) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 1.
Number of Base Error Beeps/LED Flashes
Scanner Report
Scan the bar code below to generate a report for the connected scanners. The
report indicates the port, work group, scanner name, and address. To assign a
name to your scanner, refer to Menu Command Syntax, page 259.
Scanner Report
Scanner Address
Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the scanner you are using.
Scanner Address
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
53
Base or Access Point Address
Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the base or Access Point you
are using.
Base Address
Scanner Modes
Your scanner is capable of working in single scanner mode, multiple scanner
mode, or with Bluetooth devices other than the charge base or Access Point.
Charge Only Mode
There may be times when you want to charge your scanner, but not link to the base.
For example, if a scanner is linked to an Access Point or other Bluetooth device and
you need to charge the scanner, but want to retain your existing link.
In order to program the base for Charge Only Mode, you must link a scanner to it.
Once the scanner is linked to the base, scan the Charge Only Mode bar code. Any
subsequent scanners placed in that base will charge without linking to it. The
scanner used to program the base remains linked to the base. To unlink this scanner, scan Unlink Scanner on page 55.
Charge Only Mode
Note: When in Charge Only Mode, the scanner periodically wakes up and beeps. See "Power
Up Beeper" on page 5-111 to change this setting.
Charge and Link Mode
If you want to charge a scanner and link to the base, use Charge and Link Mode. If
the base is programmed for Charge Only Mode, you must link a scanner to it first in
order to program it for Charge and Link Mode. Scan the linking bar code on the
base to link the scanner, then scan Charge and Link Mode. Default = Charge and
Link Mode.
* Charge and Link Mode
54
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Linked Modes
Locked Link Mode and Open Link Mode are the link modes that accommodate different applications. Scan the appropriate bar codes included in the Open Link and
Locked Link Mode explanations that follow to switch from one mode to another.
Default = Open Link Mode.
Locked Link Mode - Single Scanner
If you link a scanner to a base or an Access Point using the Locked Link Mode,
other scanners are blocked from being linked if they are inadvertently placed into
the base, or if the Access Point linking bar code is scanned. If you do place a different scanner into a base, it will charge the scanner, but the scanner will not be
linked.
Locked Link Mode
(Single Scanner)
To use a different scanner, you need to unlink the original scanner by scanning the
Unlink Scanner bar code. (See Scanner Modes, page 54.)
Open Link Mode - Single Scanner
When newly shipped or defaulted to factory settings, a scanner is not linked to a
base or an Access Point. A link is established when the scanner is placed into a
base, or an Access Point linking bar code is scanned. When in Open Link Mode, a
new link is established when a new scanner is placed in the base, or you scan an
Access Point linking bar code. Each time a scanner is placed into a base or scans
an Access Point linking bar code, the scanner becomes linked to the base or Access
point and the old scanner is unlinked.
* Open Link Mode
(Single Scanner)
Unlink the Scanner
If a base or an Access Point has a scanner linked to it, that scanner must be
unlinked before a new scanner can be linked. Once the previous scanner is
unlinked, it will no longer communicate with the base or Access Point. To unlink the
scanner from a base or an Access Point, scan the Unlink Scanner bar code below.
Unlink Scanner
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
55
Override Locked Scanner
If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base or an Access
Point, scan the Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and
place that scanner in the base, or scan the Access Point linking bar code. The
locked link will be overridden; the broken or lost scanner’s link with the base or
Access Point will be removed, and the new scanner will be linked.
Override Locked Scanner
(Single Scanner)
Out-of-Range Alarm
If your scanner is out range of the base, an alarm sounds from both your base and
scanner. If your scanner is out range of an Access Point, an alarm sounds from just
the scanner. The alarm stops when the scanner is moved closer to the base or
Access Point, when the base or Access Point connects to another scanner, or when
the alarm duration expires. To activate the alarm options for the scanner or the
base and to set the alarm duration, scan the appropriate bar code below and then
set the time-out duration (from 0-3000 seconds) by scanning digits on the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 0 sec (no alarm).
Base Alarm Duration
Note: The Access Point does not have a base alarm.
Scanner Alarm Duration
Note: If you are out of range when you scan a bar code, you will receive an error tone even if
you do not have the alarm set. You receive the error tone since the data could not be
communicated to the base or Access Point or the host.
Alarm Sound Type
You may change the alarm type for the scanner or a CCB01-010BT base by scanning the appropriate bar code below and then scanning a digit (0-7) bar code from
the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 0.
The sounds are as follows:
56
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Setting
Sound
0
3 long beeps, medium pitch
1
3 long beeps, high pitch
2
4 short beeps, medium pitch
3
4 short beeps, high pitch
4
single chirps, medium pitch
5
2 chirps, then 1 chirp, medium pitch
6
single chirps, high pitch
7
2 chirps, then 1 chirp, high pitch
Base Alarm Type
Note: Only the CCB01-010BT base has an alarm.
Scanner Alarm Type
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer
When there is no activity within a specified time period, the scanner enters low
power mode. Scan the appropriate scanner power time-out bar code to change the
time-out duration (in seconds).
Note: Scanning zero (0) is the equivalent of setting no time-out.
If there are no trigger pulls during the timer interval, the scanner goes into power
down mode. Whenever the trigger is enabled, the timer is reset. If the scanner is
placed in the charge base cradle and the battery is in the process of being charged,
the scanner will not go into power down mode. Default = 3600 seconds.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
57
0 seconds
200 seconds
400 seconds
900 seconds
* 3600 seconds
7200 seconds
Note: When the scanner is in power down mode, pull the trigger to power the unit back up.
There will be a set of power up beeps and a delay of up to a few seconds for the radio
to join. The scanner will then be ready to use.
Flexible Power Management
If you are experiencing network performance issues, and suspect the scanner is
interfering with other devices, you can turn down the power output of the scanner.
This reduces the range between the scanner and a base or an Access Point as
shown in the following illustration:
802.11
LAN
Scanner
Red
r
uced Powe
Full Power
58
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Scan one of the bar codes below to set the scanner’s power output to Full Power
(100%), Medium Power (35%), Medium Low Power (5%), or Low Power (1%).
Default = Full Power.
Note: Setting a Granit scanner to anything lower than Full Power changes it to Class II
Bluetooth.
* Full Power
Medium Power
Medium Low Power
Low Power
Batch Mode
Batch mode is used to store bar code data when a scanner is out of range of its
base or Access Point, or when performing inventory. The data is transmitted to the
base or Access Point once the scanner is back in range or when the records are
manually transmitted.
Note: Batch Mode is only supported by the Honeywell Charge and Communication Base
(CCB) and Honeywell Access Point (AP). Batch mode has limitations when using
multiple scanners to one base or Access Point. If a cordless system is being used in
“multiple link mode,” where up to 7 scanners are to be connected to one base or
Access Point, some accumulated or batched scans could be lost if scanners are
constantly being moved in and out of range.
Automatic Batch Mode stores bar code data when the scanner is out of range of
the base or Access Point. The data is automatically transmitted to the base or
Access Point once the scanner is back in range. When the scanner’s buffer space is
full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In order to scan bar codes
again, the scanner must be moved back into range of the base or Access Point so
data can be transmitted.
Inventory Batch Mode stores bar code data, whether or not you are in range of the
base or Access Point. To transmit the stored data to the base or Access Point, either
place the scanner in the base, or scan Transmit Inventory Records (page 64). When
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
59
the scanner’s buffer space is full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In
order to scan bar codes again, the data must be transmitted to the base or Access
Point. Once the data is transmitted, it is cleared in the scanner.
Persistent Batch Mode is the same as Inventory Batch Mode, except that once the
data is transmitted to the base or Access Point, it is retained in the scanner. If you
want to transmit more than once, you can do so using this mode. In order to clear
the scanner’s buffer, you must scan Clear All Codes (see page 64).
Default = Batch Mode Off.
* Batch Mode Off
Automatic Batch Mode
Inventory Batch Mode
Persistent Batch Mode
Batch Mode Beep
When scanning in Inventory Batch Mode (page 60), the scanner beeps every time a
bar code is scanned. If using a Granit scanner, it also vibrates. When Batch Mode
Beep is On, you will also hear a click when each bar code is sent to the host. If you
do not want to hear these clicks, scan Batch Mode Beep Off. Default = Batch Mode
Beep On.
Batch Mode Beep Off
* Batch Mode Beep On
Batch Mode Storage
When a scanner is storing data during a Batch Mode process, you can select
whether the data is stored in Flash memory or in RAM.
60
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Flash Storage: The scanner writes any untransmitted data to flash memory prior to
powering down. The data will still be there when the scanner powers back up. However, the scanner will power down, even with untransmitted data, if it reaches a
power down timeout or if the battery power is very low.
RAM Storage: The scanner will not power down while it contains data that has not
been transmitted to the base or Access Point, even if it reaches a power down timeout. However, if the scanner runs out of battery power, it will power down and the
data will be lost.
Default = Flash Storage.
* Flash Storage
RAM Storage
Batch Mode Quantity
When in Batch Mode, you may wish to transmit the number of multiple bar codes
scanned, rather than a single bar code multiple times. For example, if you scan
three bar codes called XYZ with Batch Mode Quantity Off, when you transmit your
data it will appear as XYZ three times. Using Batch Mode Quantity On and the
Quantity Codes (page 63), you could output your data as “XYZ, 00003” instead.
Note: If you wish to format your output, for example, place a CR or tab between the bar code
data and the quantity, refer to Data Format beginning on page 157.
Default = Batch Mode Quantity Off.
* Batch Mode Quantity Off
Batch Mode Quantity On
Enter Quantities
Quantity Codes (page 63) allow you to enter a quantity for the last item scanned,
up to 9999 (default = 1). Quantity digits are shifted from right to left, so if a 5th digit
is scanned, the 1st digit scanned is discarded and the 2nd, 3rd and 4th digits are
moved to the left to accommodate the new digit.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
61
For example, if the Quantity 5 bar code is scanned after the quantity has been set
to 1234, then the 1 is dropped, the quantity will be 2345.
Example: Add a quantity of 5 for the last item scanned.
1. Scan the item's bar code.
2. Scan the quantity 5 bar code.
Example: Add a quantity of 1,500 for the last item scanned.
1. Scan the item's bar code.
2. Scan the quantity 1 bar code.
3. Scan the quantity 5 bar code.
4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code.
5. Scan the quantity 0 bar code.
Example: Change a quantity of 103 to 10.
To correct an incorrect quantity, scan the quantity 0 bar code to replace the incorrect digits, then scan the correct quantity bar codes.
1. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 1030.
2. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0300.
3. Scan the quantity 1 bar code to change the quantity to 3001.
4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0010.
Default = 1.
Quantity Codes
0
1
2
3
62
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Quantity Codes (Continued)
4
5
6
7
8
9
Batch Mode Output Order
When batch data is transmitted, select whether you want that data sent as FIFO
(first-in first-out), or LIFO (last-in first-out). Default = Batch Mode FIFO.
* Batch Mode FIFO
Batch Mode LIFO
Total Records
If you wish to output the total number of bar codes scanned when in Batch Mode,
scan Total Records.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
63
Total Records
Delete Last Code
If you want to delete the last bar code scanned when in Batch Mode, scan Delete
Last Code.
Delete Last Code
Clear All Codes
If you want to clear the scanner’s buffer of all data accumulated in Batch Mode,
scan Clear All Codes.
Clear All Codes
Transmit Records to Host
If you are operating in Inventory Batch Mode (see Inventory Batch Mode on page
60), you must scan the following bar code to transmit all the stored data to the host
system.
Transmit Inventory Records
Batch Mode Transmit Delay
Sometimes when accumulated scans are sent to the host system, the transmission
of those scans is too fast for the application to process. To program a transmit
delay between accumulated scans, scan one of the following delays. Default = Off.
Note: In most cases, a short (250 ms (milliseconds)) delay is ideal, however, longer delays
may be programmed. Contact Technical Support (page xvii) for additional
information.
64
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
* Batch Mode Transmit Delay Off
(No Delay)
Batch Mode Transmit Delay Short
(250 ms)
Batch Mode Transmit Delay Medium
(500 ms)
Batch Mode Transmit Delay Long
(1000 ms)
Multiple Scanner Operation
Note: Multiple Scanner Operation Mode allows you to link up to 7 scanners to one base or
Access Point. You cannot join an 8th scanner until you unlink one of the 7 scanners
or take a scanner out of range.
To put the scanner in multiple scanner mode, scan the bar code below. Once you
scan this bar code, the scanner is unlinked from the base or Access Point and must
either be placed into the base, or you must scan the Access Point linking bar code
in order to relink.
Multiple Scanner Operation
Scanner Name
You may assign a name to each scanner you are using for identification purposes.
For example, you may want to have a unique identifier for a scanner that is receiving imaging commands sent from the base or Access Point.
The default name is in the format “ScannerName_Model_SN_XXXXXXXXXX” If you
have more than one scanner linked to a base, and they all have the same name, the
first scanner linked to the base receives commands. When renaming a series of
scanners with identical names, unlink all except one of the scanners from the base.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
65
Perform the rename operation using either the bar codes on page 67, or by sending the serial command :ScannerName:BT_NAMNewName. where ScannerName
is the current name of the scanner, and NewName is the new name for the scanner.
If you wish to change the names of additional scanners, link them one at a time and
repeat the :ScannerName:BT_NAMNewName. command for each scanner.
To rename scanners with sequential, numeric names, scan the bar codes below.
Scan the Reset code after each name change and wait for the scanner to relink to
the base or Access Point before scanning a bar code to rename the next scanner.
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
Reset
66
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
You may also scan the Scanner Name bar code below and scan a number for the
scanner name. For example, if you wanted to name the linked scanner “312,” you
would scan the bar code below, scan the 3, 1, and 2 bar codes on the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Scan the Reset bar code and wait for the
scanner to relink to the base.
Scanner Name
Application Work Groups
Your cordless system can have up to 7 scanners linked to one base or Access Point.
You can also have up to 7 work groups. If you want to have all of the scanners’ settings programmed alike, you don’t need to use more than 1 work group. If you want
each scanner to have unique settings (e.g., beeper volume, prefix/suffix, data formatter), then you may program each scanner to its own unique work group and
may program each scanner independently. For example, you might want to have
multiple work groups in a retail/warehouse application where you need to have different data appended to bar codes used in the warehouse area versus the retail
area. You could assign all the scanners in the retail area to one work group and
those in the warehouse to another. Consequently, any desired changes to either the
retail or warehouse area would apply to all scanners in that particular work group.
Honeywell’s online configuration tool, EZConfig-Scanning (page 254), makes it
easy for you to program your system for use with multiple scanners and multiple
work groups.
The scanner keeps a copy of the menu settings it is using. Whenever the scanner is
connected or reconnected to a base or an Access Point, the scanner is updated
with the latest settings from the base or Access Point for its work group. The scanner also receives menu setting changes processed by the base or Access Point. If a
scanner is removed from a base or an Access Point and placed into another base or
linked to another Access Point, it will be updated with the new base/Access Point
settings for whatever work group to which that the scanner was previously
assigned. For example, if the scanner was in work group 1 linked to the first base, it
will be placed in work group 1 in the second base with the associated settings.
Application Work Group Selection
This programming selection allows you to assign a scanner to a work group by
scanning the bar code below. You may then program the settings (e.g., beeper volume, prefix/suffix, data formatter) that your application requires. Default = Group 0.
* Group 0
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
67
Group 1
Group 2
Group 3
Group 4
Group 5
Group 6
Reset the Factory Defaults: All Application Work Groups
The following bar code defaults all of the work groups to the factory default settings.
PAPDFT&
Factory Default Settings:
All Work Groups
To see what the factory default settings are, refer to the table of Menu Commands,
beginning on page 264. The standard product default settings for each of the commands are indicated by an asterisk (*).
Note: Scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to
perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in the base, or the
Access Point linking bar code must be scanned to re-establish the link. Refer to
Scanner Modes, page 54 for additional information.
If your scanner is in multiple scanner mode, you will hear up to 30 seconds of beeping
while all scanners are relinked to the base or Access Point and the settings are
changed.
68
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Reset the Custom Defaults: All Application Work Groups
If you want the custom default settings restored to all of the work groups, scan the
Custom Product Default Settings bar code below. (If there are no custom defaults,
it will reset the work groups to the factory defaults.) See Set Custom Defaults on
page 12 for further information about custom defaults.
Custom Default Settings:
All Work Groups
Note: Scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and the base or Access Point to
perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must be placed in its base, or the
Access Point linking bar code must be scanned to re-establish the link. Refer to
Scanner Modes, page 54 for additional information.
If your scanner is in multiple scanner mode, you will hear up to 30 seconds of beeping
while all scanners are relinked to the base or Access Point and the settings are
changed.
Use the Scanner with Bluetooth Devices
The scanner can be used either with the charge base, an Access Point, or with other
Bluetooth devices. Those devices include personal computers, laptops, PDAs, and
Honeywell mobility systems devices.
Bluetooth Secure Simple Pairing (SSP)
Secure Simple Pairing (SSP) allows you to connect simply and securely to other
Bluetooth devices without having to enter a PIN code (as described in Bluetooth
HID Keyboard Connect procedure). SSP is only available when using Bluetooth version 2.1 or higher. When SSP is on, no PIN is required for pairing. Turn SSP off if
you are connecting to a Bluetooth device that is not using a compatible Bluetooth
version. Default = Bluetooth SSP On.
Note: SSP is only available with Granit 1981i scanner.
* Bluetooth SSP On
Bluetooth SSP Off
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
69
Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect
Your scanner can be paired with Bluetooth-capable devices, such as personal computers, laptops, and tablets, so that scanned data appears on your device screen as
though it was entered on the keyboard. In order to pair with the Bluetooth device:
1. Scan the appropriate Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect bar code below.
Bluetooth HID Keyboard
Connect
Bluetooth HID Japanese
Keyboard Connect
2. Set your personal computer, laptop or tablet so it searches for other Bluetooth
devices. (Refer to your device’s User’s Guide for pairing instructions.)
3. Select the scanner name on your device. Some devices will automatically pair
with the scanner. If your device pairs automatically with the scanner, it displays
a successful pairing message and you do not need to continue to the next step.
4. If your device does not automatically pair with the scanner, a PIN is displayed.
This PIN must be scanned within 60 seconds. Quickly scan Bluetooth PIN
Code below, then scan the numeric bar code(s) for the PIN code from the chart
below, then scan Save.
Bluetooth PIN Code
0
1
2
3
70
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
4
5
6
7
8
9
Save
Virtual Keyboard
Once your scanner has been connected directly to an iPad, smart phone, or laptop,
you can toggle the virtual keyboard on your device with a quick double pull of the
scanner trigger.
Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect
If your scanner has been connected directly to an iPad, smart phone, or laptop
using Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect (page 70), you must disconnect it in order
to once again communicate with the base or Access Point. Scan the Bluetooth HID
Keyboard Disconnect bar code to unlink the scanner from the currently linked
host. Scan the linking bar code on the base or Access Point to relink the scanner.
Bluetooth HID Keyboard Disconnect
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
71
Bluetooth Serial Port - PCs/Laptops
Scanning the Non-Base BT Connection bar code below unlinks your scanner and
puts it into a discoverable state. Once the scanner searches for and connects with
a Bluetooth host, the scanner stores the connection to the host device address and
switches virtual COM ports. This allows the scanner to automatically relink to the
host if the connection is lost.
Non-Base BT Connection
PDAs/Mobility Systems Devices
You may also use the scanner with a PDA or a Honeywell Mobility Systems device.
Scan the bar code below and follow the instructions supplied with your Bluetooth
device to locate the scanner, and connect with it.
BT Connection - PDA/Mobility Systems Device
Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code
Some devices require a PIN code as part of the Bluetooth security features. Your
scanner’s default PIN is 1234, which you may need to enter the first time you connect to your PDA or PC. The PIN code must be between 1 and 16 characters. To
change the PIN, scan the bar code below and then scan the appropriate numeric
bar codes from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
Bluetooth PIN
Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity
The settings described below can help you customize the relinking behavior of the
cordless area-imaging system to obtain the best compromise between convenience and low interference.
Note: ISM band refers to the 2.4 to 2.48 GHz frequency band used by wireless networks,
cordless phones, and Bluetooth.
72
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Auto Reconnect Mode
Auto Reconnect controls whether or not the scanner automatically begins the
relink process when a loss of connection is detected. When the Auto Reconnect On
bar code is scanned, the scanner begins the relink process immediately, without
user intervention. Default = Auto Reconnect On.
* Auto Reconnect On
Auto Reconnect Off
Note: If you are connecting to a Bluetooth Interface Module, set Auto Reconnect to Off.
The table below shows the results of the Auto Reconnect On and Off settings:
Event
Auto Reconnect On
Auto Reconnect Off
Scanner out of range
Relink occurs automatically. If
maximum number of link attempts
is unsuccessful, then the scanner
must be relinked by either pulling
the trigger, placing the scanner in
the base, or scanning the Access
Point linking bar code. (See
Maximum Link Attempts on page
73.)
The scanner is relinked by
pulling the trigger, or scanning
the Access Point linking bar
code.
Base or Access point reset
(firmware upgrade or power
cycle)
Scanner behaves as if out of range.
No attempt to relink made
while base or Access Point is
powered off. Trigger must be
pulled to initiate relinking.
Scanner power down due to
Power Time-Out Timer
setting
Trigger must be pulled, Access Point linking bar code must be
scanned, or the scanner must be placed in the base unit to relink.
(Note: scanner relinks on power up, but powers on due to one of the
above actions.)
Scanner reset due to
firmware upgrade
Relink occurs automatically.
Scanner reset due to battery
change
Relink occurs automatically.
Scanner placed in different
base unit
Relink to new base occurs automatically.
Maximum Link Attempts
The Maximum Link Attempts setting controls the number of times the scanner
tries to form a connection with a base or an Access Point. During the connection
setup process, the scanner transmits in order to search for and connect to a base
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
73
or an Access Point. In order to prevent continuous transmissions that could interfere with other users of the ISM band, the number of attempts to connect is limited
by this setting. After the maximum number of attempts is reached, the scanner will
not attempt to reconnect to a base or an Access Point. Pressing the trigger, scanning an Access Point linking bar code, or placing the scanner in the cradle resets
the attempt count and the scanner will again try to link.
Scan the Maximum Link Attempts bar code, then scan the number of attempts for
the setting (from 0-100) from theProgramming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 0.
Maximum Link Attempts
Note: When Auto Reconnect Mode is On, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause
the scanner to try to link until the Power Time-Out Timer setting expires. When Auto
Reconnect Mode is Off, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause the
scanner to only attempt linking one time after a trigger pull.
Relink Time-Out
Relink Time-Out controls the idle time between relink attempts. An attempt to link
a scanner to a base or an Access Point typically lasts up to 5 seconds. This is the
time when the scanner is actually attempting a contact . Relink Time-Out controls
the amount of time, in seconds, that elapses between the end of one connection
attempt and the start of the next.
Note: The length of time for an attempt depends on the number of scanners connected to
a base unit or Access Point. An extra 7 seconds may be required when a connection is
successful.
Scan the Relink Time-Out bar code, then scan the number of seconds for the setting (from 1-100) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then
Save. Default = 3 seconds.
Relink Time-Out
74
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples
Default values
When the scanner goes out of range, the scanner repeatedly attempts to connect
to the base unit or Access Point. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds
of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost.
Example: Maximum Link Attempts set to 15
Other values at default setting
When the scanner goes out of range, 15 attempts are made to link to the base unit
or Access Point. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time
followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After 15 cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes,
the scanner stops trying to connect to the base or Access Point, but retains any bar
codes that may have been saved in batch mode. After one hour, the scanner powers
off and batch mode data is lost.
Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 0
Maximum Link Attempts set to 15
Other values at default setting
When the scanner goes out of range, no action is taken to relink. When the trigger
is pulled, 15 attempts are made to link to the base or Access Point. Each attempt
consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle
time. After 15 cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes, the scanner stops trying to
connect to the base or Access Point, but retains any bar codes that may have been
saved in batch mode. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data
is lost. Refer to Auto Reconnect Mode, page 73, to review other events that can
start the relink process.
Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 1
Maximum Link Attempts set to 0
Relink Time-Out set to 10
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer set to 1800
Note: See Scanner Power Time-Out Timer on page 57.
The scanner attempts to connect to the base or Access Point every 15 seconds,
measured from one attempt start to the next attempt start. After one half hour, the
scanner powers off.
Host Acknowledgment
Some applications require that the host terminal (or server) validate incoming bar
code data (database look-up) and provide acknowledgment to the scanner
whether or not to proceed. In Host ACK Mode, the scanner waits for this acknowledgment after each scan. Visual and audible acknowledgments provide valuable
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
75
feedback to the scan operator. The Host ACK functionality is controlled via a number of pre-defined escape commands that are sent to the scanner to make it
behave in different ways.
Note: System performance degrades when using Host ACK at rates lower than 9600 baud.
The following criteria must be met for the Host ACK to work correctly:
•
The cordless system must be configured for Host Port RS232 (terminal ID = 000)
or USB COM Emulation (terminal ID = 130).
•
RTS/CTS is defaulted off. You must enable it if the host system requires it.
•
Host ACK must be set to On (page 77).
•
A comma must be used as a terminator.
•
The host terminal software must be capable of interpreting the bar code data,
make decisions based on the data content, and send out appropriate escape
commands to the scanner.
Escape commands are addressed to the scanner via “Application Work Groups.”
Once a command is sent, all scanners in a group respond to that command.
Because of this, it is recommended that each scanner is assigned to its own
group in Host ACK mode.
The commands to which the scanner responds are listed on page 77. The [ESC] is a
1B in hex. A typical command string is y [ESC] x, where “y” is the application work
group number, “[ESC] x” is the escape command, and the comma is the terminator,
which is required. (When “y” is not specified, the command is sent to the default
Application Work Group 0.)
Example: Commands may be strung together to create custom response sequences. An
example of a command string is listed below.
[ESC]4,[ESC]5,[ESC]6,
The above example will make a scanner that is in application work group zero beep
low, then medium, then high.
Example: A good read beep is required for any item on file, but a razz or error tone is required
if the item is not on file. In this case,
[ESC]7, is sent from the host to the scanner for an on-file product
[ESC]8,[ESC]8, is sent from the host to the scanner for a not-on-file product
When a bar code is scanned, the scanner enters a timeout period until either the
host ACK sequence is received, or the timeout expires (in 10 seconds, by default).
Once Host ACK is enabled, the system works as follows when a bar code is
scanned:
•
76
The scanner reads the code and sends data to the base or Access Point to
transmit to the host system. No audible or visual indication is emitted until the
scanner receives an escape command. The scanner read illumination goes out
when there’s a successful read.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
•
Scanner operation is suspended until 1) a valid escape string is received from
the host system or 2) the scanner times out.
•
Once condition 1 or 2 above has been met, the scanner is ready to scan again,
and the process repeats.
A time-out occurs if the scanner does not receive a valid escape command within
10 seconds. A time-out is indicated by an error tone. If a time-out occurs, the operator should check the host system to understand why a response to the scanner
was not received.
Host ACK On/Off
Host ACK On
* Host ACK Off
Host ACK Timeout
You can set a timeout for the length of time the scanner waits for a valid escape
command when using Host Acknowledgment Mode. Set the length (in seconds) for
a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting the timeout (from 1-90
seconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 10.
Host ACK Timeout
Host ACK Responses
Command
Action
[ESC] a,
Double beeps to indicate a successful menu change was made.
[ESC] b,
Razz or error tone to indicate a menu change was unsuccessful.
[ESC] 1,
The green LED illuminates for 135 milliseconds followed by a pause.
[ESC] 2,
The green LED illuminates for 2 seconds followed by a pause.
[ESC] 3,
The green LED illuminates for 5 seconds followed by a pause.
[ESC] 4,
Emits a beep at a low pitch.
[ESC] 5,
Emits a beep at a medium pitch.
[ESC] 6,
Emits a beep at a high pitch.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
77
78
Command
Action
[ESC] 7,
Beeps to indicate a successful decode and communication to host.
[ESC] 8,[ESC] 8,
Razz or error tone to indicate a decode/communication to host was
unsuccessful.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
4
CORDLESS SYSTEM OPERATION:
XENON 1902G-BF
Note: This chapter applies only to Xenon 1902g-BF cordless scanning systems. It does not
apply to corded scanners, Xenon 1902g/1912, or Granit 1911i/1981i scanners. See
Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning
on page 41 for other Xenon and Granit cordless scanning systems.
How the CCB01-010BT-BF Cordless Charge Base Works
A cordless charge base provides the link between the cordless scanner and the
host system. The base contains an interface assembly and an RF communication
module. The RF communication module performs the data exchange between the
cordless scanner and the interface assembly. The control assembly coordinates
the central interface activities including: transmitting/receiving commands and
data to/from the host system, performing software activities (parameter menuing,
visual indicator support, power-on diagnostics), and data translation required for
the host system.
The cordless charge base is also a scanner’s instant charge pack charger. Refer to
Charge Information, page 83, for additional information.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
79
Link the Scanner to a Charge Base
Xenon Scanner
CCB01-010BT-BF Charge Base
Page Button and Base LEDs
When the base is connected and powered up, put the scanner in the base to establish a link. The green LED on the base flashes to indicate the scanner’s instant
charge pack is charging.
Note: The scanner’s instant charge pack must be charged to establish a link with the base.
If the scanner and base have previously been linked, you do not receive any feedback. If this is the first time that the scanner and base are linked, both devices emit
a short chirp when their radios link. At this point, that one scanner is linked to one
base.
The linking sound can be turned on or off. See Linking Sound on page 91.
To determine if your scanner has linked to the base correctly, scan one of the sample bar codes beginning on page 339. If the scanner provides a single good read
beep and the green LED lights, the scanner has successfully linked to the base. If
you receive an error tone and the red LED lights, the scanner has not linked to the
base. Refer to page 325 for troubleshooting information.
Replace a Linked Scanner
If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base, scan the
Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and place that scanner in the base. The locked link will be overridden, the broken or lost scanner’s link
with the base will be removed, and the new scanner will be linked.
Override Locked Scanner
(Single Scanner)
80
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Communication Between the Cordless System
and the Host
The cordless scanner provides immediate feedback in the form of a “good read”
indication with a green LED on the scanner and an audible beep. This indicates
that the bar code has been scanned correctly and the base has acknowledged
receiving the data. This is possible since the cordless system provides two-way
communication between the scanner and the base.
When data is scanned, the data is sent to the host system via the base. The cordless
scanner recognizes data acknowledgment (ACK) from the base. If it cannot be
determined that the data has been properly sent to the base, the scanner issues an
error indication. You must then check to see if the scanned data was received by
the host system.
1
2
1. Scanner reads code and gets ACK from base.
2. Base sends data to host.
Program the Scanner and Base
When using the scanner and charge base together as a system, menu parameters
and configuration settings are stored in the charge base. Therefore, when programming any menu configuration settings, the scanner must be linked to the
charge base.
Note: This only applies when the scanner is linked to a charge base. If the scanner is in a
non-base mode, configuration settings are stored in the scanner.
RF (Radio Frequency) Module Operation
The cordless system uses a two-way, low energy, Bluetooth® radio to transmit and
receive data between the scanner and the base. It provides single-point to singlepoint communication. The radio operates using a license free ISM band, which
sends relatively small data packets at a fast data rate over a radio signal with randomly changing frequencies, makes the cordless system highly responsive to a
wide variety of data collection applications and resistant to noisy RF environments.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
81
The CCB01-010BT-BF (Bluetooth Class 2) provides a communication range of 33
feet (10m) between the scanner and base, depending on the environment. See
Flexible Power Management, page 97, for information about controlling this range.
System Conditions
The components of the cordless system interact in specific ways as you associate a
scanner to a base, as you move a scanner out of range and bring a scanner back in
range. The following information explains the cordless system operating conditions.
Link Process
Once a scanner is placed into a cordless charge base, the scanner’s instant charge
pack status is checked, and software automatically detects the scanner and links it
to the base depending on the selected link mode.
Scanner Is Out of Range
The cordless scanner is in communication with its base, even when it is not transmitting bar code data. Whenever the scanner can’t communicate with the base for
a few seconds, it is out of range. If the scanner is out of range and you scan a bar
code, the scanner issues an error tone indicating no communication with the base.
A cordless charge base can also sound an alarm. Refer to Out-of-Range
Alarm, page 95.
Scanner Is Moved Back Into Range
The scanner relinks if the scanner or the base have been reset, or the scanner
comes back into range. If the scanner relinks, you will hear a single chirp when the
relinking process (uploading of the parameter table) is complete. Refer to Out-ofRange Alarm on page 95 for further information.
Out of Range and Back into Range with Batch Mode On
The scanner may store a number of symbols (approximately 500 U.P.C. symbols;
others may vary) when it is out of range and then send them to the base when back
in range (see Batch Mode on page 98).
You will not hear a communication error tone in this mode, but you will hear a short
buzz when you pull the trigger if the radio communication is not working. Once the
radio connection is made, the scanner produces a series of beeps while the data is
being transferred to the base.
82
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
About the Instant Charge Pack
Power is supplied to the cordless scanner by a rechargeable instant charge pack
that is integrated in the scanner handle. The instant charge pack must be charged
before initial use. When the scanner is not in use, return it to the base. The model
CCB01-010BT-BF base is designed for use with the Honeywell model Xenon
1902g-BF scanner.
Charge Information
The instant charge pack is designed to charge while the scanner is positioned in
the cordless base unit. Refer to Base, page 86, for an interpretation of the Charge
Status indicators. Refer to Charge Only Mode (page 93) if you need to charge a
scanner without linking it to the base.
Place the scanner in the base that is connected to an appropriate power supply.
Use only a Listed Limited Power Source (LPS) or Class 2 type power supply with
output rated 5 to 5.2Vdc, 1A.
Caution: The Xenon 1902g-BF scanner can only be charged by CCB01010BT-BF base. Use of any non-Honeywell power supply may
result in damage not covered by the warranty.
Note: If you are powering the base through the interface cable (for example, a USB cable)
and not using an external power supply plugged into the aux port, the current
available for charging is reduced and charge times are increased. Charge times can
be improved by connecting the interface cable to a BC 1.2 compliant USB charge
port. Charging via the power supply is fastest.
The AC adapter should be plugged into the connector in the bottom of the base.
Using the interface cable power link is not recommended and will significantly
increase charge times.
Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning
The scanner contains LEDs on the rear of the unit that indicate linking status,
decoding state, and instant charge pack condition. The base has LEDs on the top
of the unit that indicate its power up, communication, and instant charge pack
condition.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
83
Scanner
Scanner Communication and Scanning
The following feedback is provided by the scanner and indicates communication
and scanning status.
LED Indication
Beeper Indication
Cause
Red Flash
None
Charge pack low
Green Flash
1 beep
Successful communication or linking
Red, blinking
Razz or error tone
Failed communication
Green Flash
2 beeps
Successful menu change
Red, blinking
Razz or error tone
Unsuccessful menu change
Normal Operation
Menu Operation
Scanner Charge Pack Status
The following charge status feedback is provided by the scanner when the scanner
is out of the base and has been idle for 5 seconds.
Scanner LED
Scanner Beep
Charge
Level
Approximate
Expected Scans*
Yellow
3 sets of flashes
2 short beeps per flash
30%
100
Red
3 sets of flashes
2 short beeps per flash
10%
50
* The number of scans was measured with a clearly printed UPC code in good light.
The approximate number of scans varies with changes in label quality, symbology,
and environmental factors.
Low Power Alerts
Low power alerts allow you to customize the scanner LEDs to flash in different patterns when the scanner charge level is low. Use the bar codes that follow to customize the settings for the power range being configured, the number of flashes
per alert, the interval between flashes, the number of alerts, and the interval
between alerts. The beeper can also be set to silent, or to sound with the flash patterns.
84
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Low Power Alert Range
Set the power range that will trigger a low power alert. Default = 10-30%.
*Low Power Alert 10-30%
Low Power Alert 10-50%
Low Power Alert Flash Number
You can program the scanner’s LEDs to flash up to 9 times for the low power alert.
If the Low Power Alert Beep (page 86) is on, a double beep will sound with each
flash. To set the number of low power flashes, scan the bar code below and then
scan a digit (1-9) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 3 flashes.
Low Power Alert Flash Number
Interval Between Flashes
Set the length of time, in seconds, between the LED flashes for a low power alert. To
set the interval, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-9) bar code from
the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 2 seconds
between flashes.
Interval Between Flashes
Low Power Alert Repeat
Set how many times you want the low power flash pattern (flashes and intervals) to
repeat. To set the number, scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (1-5) bar
code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 1.
Low Power Alert Repeat
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
85
Interval Between Alerts
If you have set the Low Power Alert Repeat (page 85) to more than 1, you can set
the length of time, in seconds, between the low power alerts. To set this interval,
scan the bar code below and then scan a digit (10-120) bar code from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 10 seconds
between alerts.
Interval Between Alerts
Low Power Alert Beep
If you do not want the beeper to sound for a low power alert, scan the Low Power
Alert Beep Off bar code. Any low power alert settings will still flash the scanner
LEDs, whether or not the beeper sounds. Default = Low Power Alert Beep On.
Low Power Alert Beep Off
*Low Power Alert Beep On
Base
The base contains colored LEDs that indicate the status of the unit, verifies its
communication with the host system, and indicates scanner instant charge pack
condition.
Base Communication and Scanning
The following feedback is provided by the base and indicates communication and
scanning status.
Red LED - Host Communication
86
Red LED
Communication
Condition
Off
USB suspend
On continuously
Host communication
available
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Red LED - Host Communication
Communication
Condition
Red LED
Short blinks in multiple pulses. Occurs while transferring
data to/from the RF module or the host port.
Receiving/sending data
Base Charge Status
When charging, the base indicates the progress while the scanner resides in the
base.
Base Button/LED
Charge Level
Approximate Expected
Scans*
Green on
100%
450
Green slow blink
50-99%
200
Green fast blink
30-50%
100
Yellow fast blink
0-30%
Charging - do not scan
* The number of scans was measured with a clearly printed UPC code in good light.
The approximate number of scans varies with changes in label quality, symbology,
and environmental factors.
Base Power Communication Indicator
To display the power indicator on a base, scan the Base Power Communication
Indicator On bar code. To turn off the power indicator, scan the Off bar code.
Default = On.
* Base Power Communication
Indicator On
Base Power Communication
Indicator Off
Reset Scanner
Scanning this bar code reboots the scanner and causes it to relink with the base.
Reset Scanner
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
87
Base Charge Modes
When the base has both an external power supply (plugged into the auxiliary power
port) and a host interface cable, it will draw its power from the external power supply. When the base does not have an external power supply, it draws its power from
the interface cable. However, the scanner instant charge pack charges more slowly
from a host interface cable than if auxiliary power were available. Using the following selections, you can specify whether the scanner instant charge pack is charged
from power supplied via the host interface cable.
When Base Charge Off is selected, the scanner instant charge pack does not
charge when the scanner is in the base cradle.
When External or Interface Cable Power is selected, the scanner instant charge
pack charges from the base’s external power supply, if there is one. If there is no
external power supply to the base, the scanner instant charge pack charges from
the interface cable.
When External Power Only is selected, the scanner instant charge pack only
charges from the base’s external power supply. If there is no external power supply,
the scanner instant charge pack does not charge.
Default = External or Interface Cable Power.
Base Charge Off
External or Interface Cable
Power
External Power Only
Page Button with Scanner Out of the Base
88
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
When the scanner is out of the base, press the page button on the base to make the
associated scanner start beeping (3 short and 1 long beep). If you pull the trigger
on a scanner that is beeping in response, or press the Page button on the base a
second time, the scanner stops beeping. See Paging on page 90 for further information about Page Button settings.
Page Button with Scanner in the Base
When the scanner is in the base, press the page button on the base to begin
Streaming Presentation Mode. The scanner acts as a presentation scanner for 10
seconds. If a bar code is scanned before the 10 second timeout is reached, the
timer starts over. Lift the scanner from the base to return to manual triggering. To
change the timeout from 10 seconds see Temporary Streaming Presentation
Timeout on page 89.
Temporary Streaming Presentation Timeout
Set a timeout for the length of time the illumination remains on and searching for
bar codes when using Temporary Streaming Presentation Mode. Set the length for
the timeout by scanning one of the bar codes below. Default = 10,000 ms (10 seconds).
*10 Second Timeout
30 Second Timeout
1 Minute Timeout
2 Minute Timeout
3 Minute Timeout
See Paging, below, for further information about Page Button settings.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
89
Scan While in Base Cradle
If you want to be able to scan bar codes while the scanner is in the base cradle,
scan the Scan in Cradle On bar code below. If you want to only allow scanning
when the scanner is out of the base cradle, scan Scan in Cradle Off. If you want the
scanner to shut down when in the base cradle, scan Shut Down Scanner in Cradle.
Default = Scan in Cradle On.
Scan in Cradle Off
* Scan in Cradle On
Shut Down Scanner in Cradle
Paging
Page Mode
When the scanner is out of the base, the paging button on the base pages the
scanner associated with that base. If you want to disable the paging button, scan
the Page Mode Off bar code, below. When Page Mode is off, the base will no longer
page the scanner when the button is pressed and no scanner is in the base. The red
LED on the base remains lit to indicate that Page Mode is off. (This light will go out
when the button is pressed, then back on when it’s released.) Default = Page Mode
On.
* Page Mode On
Page Mode Off
90
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Page Pitch
When the scanner is out of the base and you press the Page button, the scanner
associated with that base begins beeping. You can set the pitch of the paging beep
for the scanner by scanning one of the following bar codes. Default = Low.
* Low (1000 Hz)
Medium (3250 Hz)
High (4200 Hz)
Linking Sound
Under normal operations, the scanner clicks when linking to a base. If you want to
silence this sound, scan the Silent Linking bar code below. To return to the default
clicking sound, scan Linking Sound. Default = Linking Sound.
* Linking Sound
Silent Linking
Error Indicators
Beeper Pitch - Base Error
The base can be configured to beep at a particular pitch when an error occurs,
such as transmission problems to a host system. The beeper pitch codes modify
the pitch (frequency) of the error tone the base emits when there is an error. Default
= Low.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
91
* Razz (250 Hz)
Medium (3250 Hz)
High (4200 Hz)
Number of Beeps - Base Error
The number of beeps and LED flashes emitted by the base for an error condition
can be programmed from 1 - 9. For example, if you program this option to have five
error beeps, there will be five error beeps and five LED flashes in response to an
error. To change the number of error beeps, scan the bar code below and then scan
a digit (1-9) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
Default = 1.
Number of Base Error Beeps/LED Flashes
Scanner Report
Scan the bar code below to generate a report for the connected scanner. The report
indicates the port, scanner name, and address. To assign a name to your scanner,
refer to Menu Command Syntax, page 259.
Scanner Report
Scanner Address
Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the scanner you are using.
Scanner Address
92
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Base Address
Scan the bar code below to determine the address of the base you are using.
Base Address
Scanner Modes
Charge Only Mode
There may be times when you want to charge your scanner, but not link to the base.
In order to program the base for Charge Only Mode, you must link the scanner to it.
Once the scanner is linked to the base, scan the Charge Only Mode bar code. Any
subsequent scanners placed in that base will charge without linking to it. The
scanner used to program the base remains linked to the base. To unlink this scanner, scan Unlink Scanner on page 94.
Charge Only Mode
Note: When in Charge Only Mode, the scanner periodically wakes up and beeps. See Power
Up Beeper on page 111 to change this setting.
Charge and Link Mode
If you want to charge a scanner and link to the base, use Charge and Link Mode. If
the base is programmed for Charge Only Mode, you must link a scanner to it first in
order to program it for Charge and Link Mode. Scan the linking bar code on the
base to link the scanner, then scan Charge and Link Mode. Default = Charge and
Link Mode.
* Charge and Link Mode
Linked Modes
Locked Link Mode and Open Link Mode are the link modes that accommodate different applications. Scan the appropriate bar codes included in the Open Link and
Locked Link Mode explanations that follow to switch from one mode to another.
Default = Open Link Mode.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
93
Locked Link Mode - Single Scanner
If you link a scanner to a base using the Locked Link Mode, other scanners are
blocked from being linked if they are inadvertently placed into the base. If you do
place a different scanner into a base, it will charge the scanner, but the scanner will
not be linked.
Locked Link Mode
(Single Scanner)
To use a different scanner, you need to unlink the original scanner by scanning the
Unlink Scanner bar code. (See Scanner Modes, page 93.)
Open Link Mode - Single Scanner
When newly shipped or defaulted to factory settings, a scanner is not linked to a
base. A link is established when the scanner is placed into a base. When in Open
Link Mode, a new link is established when a new scanner is placed in the base.
Each time a scanner is placed into a base, the scanner becomes linked to the base
and the old scanner is unlinked.
* Open Link Mode
(Single Scanner)
Unlink the Scanner
If a base has a scanner linked to it, that scanner must be unlinked before a new
scanner can be linked. Once the previous scanner is unlinked, it will no longer communicate with the base. To unlink the scanner from a base, scan the Unlink Scanner bar code below.
Unlink Scanner
94
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Override Locked Scanner
If you need to replace a broken or lost scanner that is linked to a base, scan the
Override Locked Scanner bar code below with a new scanner and place that scanner in the base. The locked link is overridden, the broken or lost scanner’s link with
the base is removed, and the new scanner is linked to the base.
Override Locked Scanner
(Single Scanner)
Out-of-Range Alarm
If your scanner is out range of the base, an alarm sounds from both your base and
scanner. The alarm stops when the scanner is moved closer to the base, when the
base connects to another scanner, or when the alarm duration expires. To activate
the alarm options for the scanner or the base and to set the alarm duration, scan
the appropriate bar code below and then set the time-out duration (from 0-3000
seconds) by scanning digits on the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save.
Base Alarm Duration
Scanner Alarm Duration
Note: If you are out of range when you scan a bar code, you will receive an error tone even if
you do not have the alarm set. You receive the error tone since the data could not be
communicated to the base or the host.
Alarm Sound Type
You may change the alarm type for the scanner or a base by scanning the appropriate bar code below and then scanning a digit (0-7) bar code from the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 0.
The sounds are as follows:
Setting
Sound
0
3 long beeps, medium pitch
1
3 long beeps, high pitch
2
4 short beeps, medium pitch
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
95
Setting
Sound
3
4 short beeps, high pitch
4
single chirps, medium pitch
5
2 chirps, then 1 chirp, medium pitch
6
single chirps, high pitch
7
2 chirps, then 1 chirp, high pitch
Base Alarm Type
Scanner Alarm Type
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer
When there is no activity within a specified time period, the scanner enters low
power mode. Scan the appropriate scanner power time-out bar code to change the
time-out duration (in seconds).
Note: Scanning zero (0) is the equivalent of setting no time-out.
If there are no trigger pulls during the timer interval, the scanner goes into power
down mode. Whenever the trigger is enabled, the timer is reset. If the scanner is
placed in the base and the instant charge pack is in the process of being charged,
the scanner will not go into power down mode. Default = 400 seconds.
96
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
0 seconds
200 seconds
* 400 seconds
900 seconds
3600 seconds
7200 seconds
Note: When the scanner is in power down mode, pull the trigger to power the unit back up.
There will be a set of power up beeps and a delay of up to a few seconds for the radio
to join. The scanner will then be ready to use.
Flexible Power Management
If you are experiencing network performance issues, and suspect the scanner is
interfering with other devices, you can turn down the power output of the scanner.
This reduces the range between the scanner and a base as shown in the following
illustration:
802.11
LAN
Scanner
Red
r
uced Powe
Full Power
Scan one of the bar codes below to set the scanner’s power output to Full Power
(100%), Medium High Power (88%), Medium Power (50%), or Low Power (1%).
Default = High Power.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
97
Full Power
* Medium High Power
Medium Power
Low Power
Batch Mode
Batch mode is used to store bar code data when a scanner is out of range of its
base, or when performing inventory. The data is transmitted to the base once the
scanner is back in range or when the records are manually transmitted.
Automatic Batch Mode stores bar code data when the scanner is out of range of
the base. The data is automatically transmitted to the base once the scanner is
back in range. When the scanner’s buffer space is full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In order to scan bar codes again, the scanner must be moved
back into range of the base so data can be transmitted.
Inventory Batch Mode stores bar code data, whether or not you are in range of the
base. To transmit the stored data to the base, either place the scanner in the base,
or scan Transmit Inventory Records (page 103). When the scanner’s buffer space is
full, any bar codes scanned generate an error tone. In order to scan bar codes
again, the data must be transmitted to the base. Once the data is transmitted, it is
cleared in the scanner.
Persistent Batch Mode is the same as Inventory Batch Mode, except that once the
data is transmitted to the base, it is retained in the scanner. If you want to transmit
more than once, you can do so using this mode. In order to clear the scanner’s buffer, you must scan Clear All Codes (see page 103).
Default = Batch Mode Off.
* Batch Mode Off
98
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Automatic Batch Mode
Inventory Batch Mode
Persistent Batch Mode
Batch Mode Beep
When scanning in Inventory Batch Mode (page 99), the scanner beeps every time a
bar code is scanned. When Batch Mode Beep is On, you will also hear a click when
each bar code is sent to the host. If you do not want to hear these clicks, scan Batch
Mode Beep Off. Default = Batch Mode Beep On.
Batch Mode Beep Off
* Batch Mode Beep On
Batch Mode Storage
When a scanner is storing data during a Batch Mode process, you can select
whether the data is stored in Flash memory or in RAM.
Flash Storage: The scanner writes any untransmitted data to flash memory prior to
powering down. The data will still be there when the scanner powers back up. However, the scanner will power down, even with untransmitted data, if it reaches a
power down timeout or if the instant charge pack power is very low.
RAM Storage: The scanner will not power down while it contains data that has not
been transmitted to the base, even if it reaches a power down timeout. However, if
the scanner charge pack runs out of power, it will power down and the data will be
lost.
Default = Flash Storage.
* Flash Storage
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
99
RAM Storage
Batch Mode Quantity
When in Batch Mode, you may wish to transmit the number of multiple bar codes
scanned, rather than a single bar code multiple times. For example, if you scan
three bar codes called XYZ with Batch Mode Quantity Off, when you transmit your
data it will appear as XYZ three times. Using Batch Mode Quantity On and the
Quantity Codes (page 101), you could output your data as “XYZ, 00003” instead.
Note: If you wish to format your output, for example, place a CR or tab between the bar code
data and the quantity, refer to Data Format beginning on page 157.
Default = Batch Mode Quantity Off.
* Batch Mode Quantity Off
Batch Mode Quantity On
Enter Quantities
Quantity Codes (page 101) allow you to enter a quantity for the last item scanned,
up to 9999 (default = 1). Quantity digits are shifted from right to left, so if a 5th digit
is scanned, the 1st digit scanned is discarded and the 2nd, 3rd and 4th digits are
moved to the left to accommodate the new digit.
For example, if the Quantity 5 bar code is scanned after the quantity has been set
to 1234, then the 1 is dropped, the quantity will be 2345.
Example: Add a quantity of 5 for the last item scanned.
1. Scan the item's bar code.
2. Scan the quantity 5 bar code.
Example: Add a quantity of 1,500 for the last item scanned.
1. Scan the item's bar code.
2. Scan the quantity 1 bar code.
3. Scan the quantity 5 bar code.
4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code.
100
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
5. Scan the quantity 0 bar code.
Example: Change a quantity of 103 to 10.
To correct an incorrect quantity, scan the quantity 0 bar code to replace the incorrect digits, then scan the correct quantity bar codes.
1. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 1030.
2. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0300.
3. Scan the quantity 1 bar code to change the quantity to 3001.
4. Scan the quantity 0 bar code to change the quantity to 0010.
Default = 1.
Quantity Codes
0
*1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
101
Quantity Codes (Continued)
8
9
Batch Mode Output Order
When batch data is transmitted, select whether you want that data sent as FIFO
(first-in first-out), or LIFO (last-in first-out). Default = Batch Mode FIFO.
* Batch Mode FIFO
Batch Mode LIFO
Total Records
If you wish to output the total number of bar codes scanned when in Batch Mode,
scan Total Records.
Total Records
Delete Last Code
If you want to delete the last bar code scanned when in Batch Mode, scan Delete
Last Code.
Delete Last Code
102
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Clear All Codes
If you want to clear the scanner’s buffer of all data accumulated in Batch Mode,
scan Clear All Codes.
Clear All Codes
Transmit Records to Host
If you are operating in Inventory Batch Mode (see Inventory Batch Mode on page
99), you must scan the following bar code to transmit all the stored data to the host
system.
Transmit Inventory Records
Batch Mode Transmit Delay
Sometimes when accumulated scans are sent to the host system, the transmission
of those scans is too fast for the application to process. To program a transmit
delay between accumulated scans, scan one of the following delays. Default = Off.
Note: In most cases, a short (250 ms (milliseconds)) delay is ideal, however, longer delays
may be programmed. Contact Technical Support (page xvii) for additional
information.
* Batch Mode Transmit Delay Off
(No Delay)
Batch Mode Transmit Delay Short
(250 ms)
Batch Mode Transmit Delay Medium
(500 ms)
Batch Mode Transmit Delay Long
(1000 ms)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
103
Scanner Name
You may assign a name to each scanner you are using for identification purposes.
The default name is in the format “ScannerName_Model_SN_XXXXXXXXXX” Perform the rename operation using either the bar codes on page 105, or by sending
the serial command :ScannerName:BT_NAMNewName. where ScannerName is
the current name of the scanner, and NewName is the new name for the scanner.
To rename scanners with sequential, numeric names, scan the bar codes below.
Scan the Reset code after each name change and wait for the scanner to relink to
the base before scanning a bar code to rename the next scanner.
0001
0002
0003
0004
0005
0006
0007
Reset
104
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
You may also scan the Scanner Name bar code below and scan a number for the
scanner name. For example, if you wanted to name the linked scanner “312,” you
would scan the bar code below, scan the 3, 1, and 2 bar codes on the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Scan the Reset bar code and wait for the
scanner to relink to the base.
Scanner Name
Change the Scanner’s Bluetooth PIN Code
Some devices require a PIN code as part of the Bluetooth security features. Your
scanner’s default PIN is 1234, which you may need to enter the first time you connect to your PC. The PIN code must be between 1 and 16 characters. To change the
PIN, scan the bar code below and then scan the appropriate numeric bar codes
from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
Bluetooth PIN
Minimize Bluetooth/ISM Band Network Activity
The settings described below can help you customize the relinking behavior of the
cordless area-imaging system to obtain the best compromise between convenience and low interference.
Note: ISM band refers to the 2.4 to 2.48 GHz frequency band used by wireless networks,
cordless phones, and Bluetooth.
Auto Reconnect Mode
Auto Reconnect controls whether or not the scanner automatically begins the
relink process when a loss of connection is detected. When the Auto Reconnect On
bar code is scanned, the scanner begins the relink process immediately, without
user intervention. Default = Auto Reconnect On.
* Auto Reconnect On
Auto Reconnect Off
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
105
The table below shows the results of the Auto Reconnect On and Off settings:
Event
Auto Reconnect On
Auto Reconnect Off
Scanner out of range
Relink occurs automatically. If
maximum number of link attempts
is unsuccessful, then the scanner
must be relinked by either pulling
the trigger or placing the scanner
in the base. (See Maximum Link
Attempts on page 106.)
The scanner is relinked by
pulling the trigger.
Base reset (firmware
upgrade or power cycle)
Scanner behaves as if out of range.
No attempt to relink made
while base is powered off.
Trigger must be pulled to
initiate relinking.
Scanner power down due to
Power Time-Out Timer
setting
Trigger must be pulled or the scanner must be placed in the base unit
to relink.
(Note: scanner relinks on power up, but powers on due to one of the
above actions.)
Scanner reset due to
firmware upgrade
Relink occurs automatically.
Scanner reset due to instant
charge pack change
Relink occurs automatically.
Scanner placed in different
base unit
Relink to new base occurs automatically.
Maximum Link Attempts
The Maximum Link Attempts setting controls the number of times the scanner
tries to form a connection with a base. During the connection setup process, the
scanner transmits in order to search for and connect to a base. In order to prevent
continuous transmissions that could interfere with other users of the ISM band,
the number of attempts to connect is limited by this setting. After the maximum
number of attempts is reached, the scanner will not attempt to reconnect to a base.
Pressing the trigger or placing the scanner in the base resets the counter and the
scanner will again try to link.
Scan the Maximum Link Attempts bar code, then scan the number of attempts for
the setting (from 0-100) from theProgramming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 4.
Maximum Link Attempts
Note: When Auto Reconnect Mode is On, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause
the scanner to try to link until the Power Time-Out Timer setting expires. When Auto
Reconnect Mode is Off, setting Maximum Link Attempts to zero will cause the
scanner to only attempt linking one time after a trigger pull.
106
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Relink Time-Out
Relink Time-Out controls the idle time between relink attempts. An attempt to link
a scanner to a base typically lasts up to 5 seconds. This is the time when the scanner is actually attempting a contact. Relink Time-Out controls the amount of time,
in seconds, that elapses between the end of one connection attempt and the start
of the next.
Scan the Relink Time-Out bar code, then scan the number of seconds for the setting (from 1-100) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then
Save. Default = 2 seconds.
Relink Time-Out
Bluetooth/ISM Network Activity Examples
Default values
When the scanner goes out of range, the scanner repeatedly attempts to connect
to the base. Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch
mode data is lost.
Example: Maximum Link Attempts set to 15
Other values at default setting
When the scanner goes out of range, 15 attempts are made to link to the base.
Each attempt consists of approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After 15 cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes, the scanner
stops trying to connect to the base, but retains any bar codes that may have been
saved in batch mode. After one hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data
is lost.
Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 0
Maximum Link Attempts set to 15
Other values at default setting
When the scanner goes out of range, no action is taken to relink. When the trigger
is pulled, 15 attempts are made to link to the base. Each attempt consists of
approximately 5 seconds of active time followed by 3 seconds of idle time. After 15
cycles (8*15 =120), or about 2 minutes, the scanner stops trying to connect to the
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
107
base, but retains any bar codes that may have been saved in batch mode. After one
hour, the scanner powers off and batch mode data is lost. Refer to Auto Reconnect
Mode, page 105, to review other events that can start the relink process.
Example: Auto Reconnect Mode set to 1
Maximum Link Attempts set to 0
Relink Time-Out set to 10
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer set to 1800
Note: See Scanner Power Time-Out Timer on page 96.
The scanner attempts to connect to the base every 15 seconds, measured from one
attempt start to the next attempt start. After one half hour, the scanner powers off.
Host Acknowledgment
Some applications require that the host terminal (or server) validate incoming bar
code data (database look-up) and provide acknowledgment to the scanner
whether or not to proceed. In Host ACK Mode, the scanner waits for this acknowledgment after each scan. Visual and audible acknowledgments provide valuable
feedback to the scan operator. The Host ACK functionality is controlled via a number of pre-defined escape commands that are sent to the scanner to make it
behave in different ways.
Note: System performance degrades when using Host ACK at rates lower than 9600 baud.
The following criteria must be met for the Host ACK to work correctly:
•
The cordless system must be configured for Host Port RS232 (terminal ID = 000)
or USB COM Emulation (terminal ID = 130).
•
RTS/CTS is defaulted off. You must enable it if the host system requires it.
•
Host ACK must be set to On (page 109).
•
A comma must be used as a terminator.
•
The host terminal software must be capable of interpreting the bar code data,
make decisions based on the data content, and send out appropriate escape
commands to the scanner.
The commands to which the scanner responds are listed on page 110. The [ESC] is
a 1B in hex. A typical command string is [ESC] x,. [ESC] x is the escape command,
and the comma is the terminator, which is required.
Example: Commands may be strung together to create custom response sequences. An
example of a command string is listed below.
[ESC]4,[ESC]5,[ESC]6,
The above example will make a scanner beep low, then medium, then high.
Example: A good read beep is required for any item on file, but a razz or error tone is required
if the item is not on file. In this case,
108
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
[ESC]7, is sent from the host to the scanner for an on-file product
[ESC]8,[ESC]8, is sent from the host to the scanner for a not-on-file product
When a bar code is scanned, the scanner enters a timeout period until either the
host ACK sequence is received, or the timeout expires (in 10 seconds, by default).
Once Host ACK is enabled, the system works as follows when a bar code is
scanned:
•
The scanner reads the code and sends data to the base to transmit to the host
system. No audible or visual indication is emitted until the scanner receives an
escape command. The scanner read illumination goes out when there’s a
successful read.
•
Scanner operation is suspended until 1) a valid escape string is received from
the host system or 2) the scanner times out.
•
Once condition 1 or 2 above has been met, the scanner is ready to scan again,
and the process repeats.
A time-out occurs if the scanner does not receive a valid escape command within
10 seconds. A time-out is indicated by an error tone. If a time-out occurs, the operator should check the host system to understand why a response to the scanner
was not received.
Host ACK On/Off
Host ACK On
* Host ACK Off
Host ACK Timeout
You can set a timeout for the length of time the scanner waits for a valid escape
command when using Host Acknowledgment Mode. Set the length (in seconds) for
a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting the timeout (from 1-90
seconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 10.
Host ACK Timeout
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
109
Host ACK Responses
110
Command
Action
[ESC] a,
Double beeps to indicate a successful menu change was made.
[ESC] b,
Razz or error tone to indicate a menu change was unsuccessful.
[ESC] 1,
The green LED illuminates for 135 milliseconds followed by a pause.
[ESC] 2,
The green LED illuminates for 2 seconds followed by a pause.
[ESC] 3,
The green LED illuminates for 5 seconds followed by a pause.
[ESC] 4,
Emits a beep at a low pitch.
[ESC] 5,
Emits a beep at a medium pitch.
[ESC] 6,
Emits a beep at a high pitch.
[ESC] 7,
Beeps to indicate a successful decode and communication to host.
[ESC] 8,[ESC] 8,
Razz or error tone to indicate a decode/communication to host was
unsuccessful.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
5
INPUT/OUTPUT SETTINGS
Power Up Beeper
Note: This feature does not apply to the CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT base.
The scanner can be programmed to beep when it’s powered up. If you are using a
cordless system, the base can also be programmed to beep when it is powered up.
Scan the Off bar code(s) if you don’t want a power up beep. Default = Power Up
Beeper On - Scanner.
Power Up Beeper Off Scanner
* Power Up Beeper On Scanner
Power Up Beeper Off Cordless Base
Power Up Beeper On Cordless Base
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
111
Beep on BEL Character
You may wish to force the scanner to beep upon a command sent from the host. If
you scan the Beep on BEL On bar code below, the scanner will beep every time a
BEL character is received from the host. Default = Beep on BEL Off.
*Beep on BEL Off
Beep on BEL On
Trigger Click
To hear an audible click every time the scanner trigger is pressed, scan the Trigger
Click On bar code below. Scan the Trigger Click Off code if you don’t wish to hear
the click. (This feature has no effect on serial or automatic triggering.) Default =
Trigger Click Off.
*Trigger Click Off
Trigger Click On
Good Read and Error Indicators
Beeper – Good Read
The beeper may be programmed On or Off in response to a good read. Turning this
option off only turns off the beeper response to a good read indication. All error and
menu beeps are still audible. Default = Beeper - Good Read On.
Beeper - Good Read Off
* Beeper - Good Read On
112
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Beeper Volume – Good Read
The beeper volume codes modify the volume of the beep the scanner emits on a
good read. Default = High for Granit/Xenon, Low for Xenon HC.
* Low
Medium
* High
Off
Beeper Pitch – Good Read
The beeper pitch codes modify the pitch (frequency) of the beep the scanner emits
on a good read. The Medium pitch differs for the Xenon and Granit scanners.
Default = Medium.
Low (1600 Hz)
* Medium - Xenon
(2700 Hz)
* Medium - Granit
(3200 Hz)
High (4200 Hz)
Vibrate – Good Read
Note: Vibration settings apply only to Granit Devices.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
113
The scanner vibrates once when a bar code is successfully read, and twice when a
programming bar code is successfully read. When a programming bar code is
unsuccessful, the scanner emits one long vibration (2 times the Vibrate Duration
length). Scan Vibrate - Good Read Off to keep the scanner from vibrating. Default
= Vibrate - Good Read On.
Vibrate- Good Read Off
* Vibrate- Good Read On
Vibrate Duration
If you want to set the length for the good read vibration, scan the bar code below,
then set the duration (from 100 - 2,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 300 ms.
Vibrate Duration
Beeper Pitch – Error
The beeper pitch codes modify the pitch (frequency) of the sound the scanner
emits when there is a bad read or error. Default = Razz.
* Razz (250 Hz)
Medium (3250 Hz)
High (4200 Hz)
114
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Beeper Duration – Good Read
The beeper duration codes modify the length of the beep the scanner emits on a
good read. Default = Normal.
* Normal Beep
Short Beep
LED – Good Read
The LED indicator can be programmed On or Off in response to a good read.
Default = On.
* LED - Good Read On
LED - Good Read Off
Number of Beeps – Good Read
The number of beeps of a good read can be programmed from 1 - 9. The same
number of beeps will be applied to the beeper and LED in response to a good read.
For example, if you program this option to have five beeps, there will be five beeps
and five LED flashes in response to a good read. The beeps and LED flashes are in
sync with one another. To change the number of beeps, scan the bar code below
and then scan a digit (1-9) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on
page 341, then Save. Default = 1.
Number of Good Read Beeps/LED Flashes
Number of Beeps – Error
The number of beeps and LED flashes emitted by the scanner for a bad read or
error can be programmed from 1 - 9. For example, if you program this option to
have five error beeps, there will be five error beeps and five LED flashes in response
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
115
to an error. To change the number of error beeps, scan the bar code below and then
scan a digit (1-9) bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 1.
Number of Error Beeps/LED Flashes
Beeper Volume Max
Note: The Beeper Volume Max feature only applies to Granit products.
Scan the following bar code to set all error and good read beeps to the maximum
volume. This feature also sets the Beeper Pitch – Good Read to the highest level.
Beeper Volume Max
Good Read Delay
This sets the minimum amount of time before the scanner can read another bar
code. Default = 0 ms (No Delay).
* No Delay
Short Delay (500 ms)
Medium Delay (1,000 ms)
Long Delay (1,500 ms)
116
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
User-Specified Good Read Delay
If you want to set your own length for the good read delay, scan the bar code below,
then set the delay (from 0 - 30,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
User-Specified Good Read Delay
Trigger Modes
Manual Trigger
When in manual trigger mode, the scanner scans until a bar code is read, or until
the trigger is released. Two modes are available, Normal and Enhanced. Normal
mode offers good scan speed and the longest working ranges (depth of field).
Enhanced mode will give you the highest possible scan speed but slightly less
range than Normal mode. Enhanced mode is best used when you require a very
fast scan speed and don’t require a long working range. Default = Manual TriggerNormal.
Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support Enhanced Manual Trigger Mode.
* Manual Trigger - Normal
Manual Trigger Enhanced
Trigger Toggle
Note: Only the Xenon 1900 and 1902 support Trigger Toggle mode.
Trigger Toggle mode lets you quickly hit the trigger 2 or 3 times to put the scanner
into either imaging mode, cell phone read mode, or centering mode, then toggle
back to scanning. So, like a double-click with a mouse, you can control what the
next scanner’s action will be. For example, you could double-press the trigger to go
into imaging mode, then the next trigger press takes the image. The scanner then
reverts to scanning mode. Or you could triple-press the trigger to go into cell
phone read mode, the customer presents the phone and it’s read, then the scanner
reverts to scanning mode. Use the following codes to configure what action you
would like the scanner to take when in Trigger Toggle mode.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
117
*Trigger Toggle Off
Trigger Toggle - Image Capture
Trigger Toggle - Cell Phone Read
Trigger Toggle - Centering
Trigger Number
This sets the number of trigger preses required to activate the Trigger Toggle Mode.
2 Quick Triggers
3 Quick Triggers
4 Quick Triggers
Trigger Timing
This sets the timing of the trigger presses in order to qualify as a trigger toggle,
rather than a regular trigger press. After scanning the Trigger Timing bar code, set
the time-out duration (from 50-2,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 400ms.
Trigger Timing
118
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Trigger Toggle Timeout
This sets the length of time the scanner stays in trigger toggle mode before reverting to scan mode. After scanning the Trigger Toggle Timeout bar code, set the
time-out duration (from 0 to 65 seconds) by scanning digits from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 5 seconds.
Note: If this is set to 0, you must repeat the toggle sequence to return to the default
scanning mode. For example, if 2 quick trigger presses puts the scanner into cell
phone read mode and the Trigger Timing is 0, you would have to do 2 quick presses
again to go back to the default scanning mode.
Trigger Toggle Timeout
Serial Trigger
You can activate the scanner either by pressing the trigger, or using a serial trigger
command (see Trigger Commands on page 262). You must be in a serial interface
mode in order to use serial triggering. Refer to RS232 Serial Port (page 16) or USB
Serial (page 19) for further information. When in serial mode, the scanner scans
until a bar code has been read or until the deactivate command is sent. The scanner can also be set to turn itself off after a specified time has elapsed (see Read
Time-Out, which follows).
Read Time-Out
Use this selection to set a time-out (in milliseconds) of the scanner’s trigger when
using serial commands to trigger the scanner. Once the scanner has timed out, you
can activate the scanner either by pressing the trigger or using a serial trigger
command. After scanning the Read Time-Out bar code, set the time-out duration
(from 0-300,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart,
beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 30,000 ms.
Read Time-Out
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
119
Presentation Mode
Presentation Mode uses ambient light and scanner illumination to detect bar
codes. When in Presentation Mode, the LEDs remain dim until a bar code is presented to the scanner, then the aimer turns on and the LEDs turn up to read the
code. If the light level in the room is not high enough, Presentation Mode may not
work properly
Note: If you are using a cordless charge base in Presentation Mode, the battery will not
charge unless the power supply is plugged into the base’s auxiliary power port.
Scan the following bar code to program your scanner for Presentation Mode.
Presentation Mode
Presentation LED Behavior after Decode
When a scanner is in presentation mode, the LED aimer dims 30 seconds after a
bar code is decoded. If you wish to dim the LED aimer immediately after a bar code
is decoded, scan the LEDs Off bar code, below. Default = LEDs On.
* LEDs On
LEDs Off
Presentation Sensitivity
Presentation Sensitivity is a numeric range that increases or decreases the scanner's reaction time to bar code presentation. To set the sensitivity, scan the Sensitivity bar code, then scan the degree of sensitivity (from 0-20) from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. 0 is the most sensitive
setting, and 20 is the least sensitive. Default = 1.
Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support this setting.
Sensitivity
120
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Presentation Centering
Use Presentation Centering to narrow the scanner’s field of view when it is in the
stand to make sure the scanner reads only those bar codes intended by the user.
For instance, if multiple codes are placed closely together, Presentation Centering
will insure that only the desired codes are read.
Note: To adjust centering when the scanner is hand-held, see Centering (page 5-131).
If a bar code is not touched by a predefined window, it will not be decoded or output
by the scanner. If Presentation Centering is turned on by scanning Presentation
Centering On, the scanner only reads codes that pass through the centering window you specify using the Top of Presentation Centering Window, Bottom of
Presentation Centering Window, Left, and Right of Presentation Centering Window bar codes.
In the example below, the white box is the centering window. The centering window
has been set to 20% left, 30% right, 8% top, and 25% bottom. Since Bar Code 1
passes through the centering window, it will be read. Bar Code 2 does not pass
through the centering window, so it will not be read.
0%
Bar Code 1
10
Bar Code 2
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100%
Note: A bar code needs only to be touched by the centering window in order to be read. ?It
does not need to pass completely through the centering window.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
121
Scan Presentation Centering On, then scan one of the following bar codes to
change the top, bottom, left, or right of the centering window. Then scan the percent you want to shift the centering window from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default Presentation Centering = 40% for Top and
Left, 60% for Bottom and Right.
Presentation Centering On
* Presentation Centering Off
Top of Presentation
Centering Window
Bottom of Presentation
Centering Window
Left of
Presentation Centering
Window
Right of Presentation
Centering Window
In-Stand Sensor Mode
Note: The In-Stand Sensor feature only applies to Xenon 1900, 1900h, 1910, 1902, 1902h,
and 1912products. It does not apply to the Xenon 1902g-BF or Granit products.
122
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
This feature senses when the scanner is removed from the stand and tells it to
begin manual triggering. When Sensor On is enabled, the scanner defaults to
Streaming Presentation Mode when it is in the stand, and to Manual Trigger Mode
when it is removed from the stand. Default = Sensor On.
* Sensor On
Sensor Off
Note: If you are taking images (see Imaging Commands beginning on page 233), you must
set the In-Stand Sensor to Off.
You may program a Streaming Presentation Mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile
Phone) you wish to use for in-stand scanning, and a Manual Trigger mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile Phone) you wish to use for out-of-stand scanning. To do
this, you must first scan the preferred Streaming Presentation mode (see below),
then scan the Manual Trigger mode (see page 117 and page 125) you want to use.
Poor Quality Codes
Poor Quality 1D Codes
This setting improves the scanner’s ability to read damaged or badly printed linear
bar codes. When Poor Quality 1D Reading On is scanned, poor quality linear bar
code reading is improved, but the scanner’s snappiness is decreased, making it
less aggressive when reading good quality bar codes. This setting does not affect
2D bar code reading. Default = Poor Quality 1D Reading Off.
Poor Quality 1D Reading On
* Poor Quality 1D Reading Off
Poor Quality PDF Codes
This setting improves the scanner’s ability to read damaged or badly printed PDF
codes by combining information from multiple images. When Poor Quality PDF
On is scanned, poor quality PDF code reading is improved, but the scanner’s snap-
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
123
piness is decreased, making it less aggressive when reading good quality bar
codes. This setting does not affect 1D bar code reading. Default = Poor Quality PDF
Reading Off.
Poor Quality PDF Reading On
* Poor Quality PDF Reading
Off
CodeGate®
When CodeGate is On, the trigger is used to allow decoded data to be transmitted
to the host system. The scanner remains on, scanning and decoding bar codes, but
the bar code data is not transmitted until the trigger is pressed. When CodeGate is
Off, bar code data is transmitted when it is decoded. Default = CodeGate Off Out-ofStand.
* CodeGate Off
Out-of-Stand
CodeGate On
Out-of-Stand
Streaming Presentation™ Mode
When in Streaming Presentation mode, the scanner’s aimer goes out after a short
time, but the scan illumination remains on all the time to continuously search for
bar codes. Two modes are available, Normal and Enhanced. Normal mode offers
good scan speed and the longest working ranges (depth of field). Enhanced mode
will give you the highest possible scan speed but slightly less range than Normal
mode. Enhanced mode is best used when you require a very fast scan speed and
don’t require a long working range.
Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support Enhanced Streaming Presentation Mode.
124
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Streaming Presentation
Mode - Normal
Streaming Presentation
Mode - Enhanced
When using Preferred Symbology (page 5-134), a lower priority symbol must be
centered on the aiming pattern to be read in Streaming Presentation Mode.
Note: If you are using a cordless charge base, it must have an external power supply
plugged into the aux port for Streaming Presentation to work properly.
Streaming Presentation In-Stand
This option is available when using In-Stand Sensor Mode, page 122. You may program a specific Streaming Presentation Mode for in-stand scanning, and a Manual
Trigger mode for out-of-stand scanning. To do this, you must first scan the preferred Streaming Presentation mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile Phone), then
scan the Manual Trigger mode (Normal, Enhanced, or Mobile Phone) you want to
use.
Mobile Phone Read Mode
When this mode is selected, your scanner is optimized to read bar codes from
mobile phone or other LED displays. However, the speed of scanning printed bar
codes may be slightly lower when this mode is enabled. You can enable Mobile
Phone Reading for either a hand held device, or for a hands-free (presentation)
application.
Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support these settings.
Hand Held Scanning - Mobile
Phone
Streaming Presentation Mobile Phone
Note: To turn off Mobil Phone Read Mode, scan a Manual or Serial Trigger Mode bar code
(see page 117).
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
125
Hands Free Time-Out
The Scan Stand and Presentation Modes are referred to as “hands free” modes. If
the scanner’s trigger is pulled when using a hands free mode, the scanner changes
to manual trigger mode. You can set the time the scanner should remain in manual
trigger mode by setting the Hands Free Time-Out. Once the time-out value is
reached, (if there have been no further trigger pulls) the scanner reverts to the
original hands free mode.
Scan the Hands Free Time-Out bar code, then scan the time-out duration (from 0300,000 milliseconds) from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then
Save. Default = 5,000 ms.
Hands Free Time-Out
Reread Delay
This sets the time period before the scanner can read the same bar code a second
time. Setting a reread delay protects against accidental rereads of the same bar
code. Longer delays are effective in minimizing accidental rereads. Use shorter
delays in applications where repetitive bar code scanning is required. Reread Delay
only works when in a Presentation Mode (see page 120). Default = Medium.
Short (500 ms)
* Medium (750 ms)
Long (1000 ms)
Extra Long (2000 ms)
126
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
User-Specified Reread Delay
If you want to set your own length for the reread delay, scan the bar code below,
then set the delay (from 0-30,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
User-Specified Reread Delay
2D Reread Delay
Sometimes 2D bar codes can take longer to read than other bar codes. If you wish
to set a separate Reread Delay for 2D bar codes, scan one of the programming
codes that follows. 2D Reread Delay Off indicates that the time set for Reread
Delay is used for both 1D and 2D bar codes. Default = 2D Reread Delay Off.
* 2D Reread Delay Off
Short (1000ms)
Medium (2000ms)
Long (3000ms)
Extra Long (4000ms)
Character Activation
You may use a character sent from the host to trigger the scanner to begin scanning. When the activation character is received, the scanner continues scanning
until either the Character Activation Timeout (page 5-129), the deactivation character is received (see Deactivation Character on page 129), or a bar code is trans-
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
127
mitted. Scan the following On bar code to use character activation, then use
Activation Character (page 128) to select the character you will send from the host
to start scanning. Default = Off.
* Off
On
Activation Character
This sets the character used to trigger scanning when using Character Activation
Mode. On the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330, find the hex
value that represents the character you want to use to trigger scanning. Scan the
following bar code, then use the Programming Chart to read the alphanumeric
combination that represents that ASCII character. Scan Save to finish. Default = 12
[DC2].
Activation Character
End Character Activation After Good Read
After a bar code is successfully detected and read from the scanner, the illumination can be programmed either to remain on and scanning, or to turn off. When
End Character Activation After Good Read is enabled, the illumination turns off
and stops scanning after a good read. If you scan Do Not End Character Activation After Good Read, the illumination remains on after a good read.
Do Not End Character
Activation After Good Read
End Character Activation After
Good Read
128
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Character Activation Timeout
You can set a timeout for the length of time the illumination remains on and
attempting to decode bar codes when using Character Activation Mode. Set the
length (in milliseconds) for a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting the timeout (from 1-300,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = 30,000 ms.
Character Activation Timeout
Character Deactivation
If you have sent a character from the host to trigger the scanner to begin scanning,
you can also send a deactivation character to stop scanning. Scan the following On
bar code to use character deactivation, then use Deactivation Character (following) to select the character you will send from the host to terminate scanning.
Default = Off.
* Off
On
Deactivation Character
This sets the character used to terminate scanning when using Character Deactivation Mode. On the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330, find the
hex value that represents the character you want to use to terminate scanning.
Scan the following bar code, then use the Programming Chart, beginning on page
341 to read the alphanumeric combination that represents that ASCII character.
Scan Save to finish. Default = 14 [DC4].
Deactivation Character
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
129
Illumination Lights
If you want the illumination lights on while reading a bar code, scan the Lights On
bar code, below. However, if you want to turn just the lights off, scan the Lights Off
bar code. Default = Lights On.
Note: This setting does not affect the aimer light. The aiming light can be set using Aimer
Mode (page 131).
* Lights On
Lights Off
Aimer Delay
The aimer delay allows a delay time for the operator to aim the scanner before the
picture is taken. Use these codes to set the time between when the trigger is pulled
and when the picture is taken. During the delay time, the aiming light will appear,
but the LEDs won’t turn on until the delay time is over. Default = Off.
1 millisecond
250 milliseconds
500 milliseconds
* Off (no
130
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
User-Specified Aimer Delay
If you want to set your own length for the duration of the delay, scan the bar code
below, then set the time-out by scanning digits (0 - 4,000 ms) from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
Delay Duration
Aimer Mode
This feature allows you to turn the aimer on and off. When the Interlaced bar code
is scanned, the aimer is interlaced with the illumination LEDs. Default = Interlaced
Note: Granit 1980i and 1981i do not support Aimer Mode.
Off
* Interlaced
Centering
Use Centering to narrow the scanner’s field of view to make sure that when the
scanner is hand-held, it reads only those bar codes intended by the user. For
instance, if multiple codes are placed closely together, centering will insure that
only the desired codes are read. (Centering can be used in conjunction with Aimer
Delay, page 130, for the most error-free operation in applications where multiple
codes are spaced closely together. Using the Aimer Delay and Centering features,
the scanner can emulate the operation of older systems, such as linear laser bar
code scanners.)
Note: To adjust centering when the scanner is in the stand, see Presentation
Centering (page 5-121).
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
131
Single Code Centering
Scan Single Code Centering to target the bar code closest to the center of the
image. Singling out a bar code in this manner increases scanning accuracy when
there are multiple bar codes close together.
Single Code Centering
Custom Centering
Use the following settings to customize your centering window. If a bar code is not
touched by a predefined window, it will not be decoded or output by the scanner. If
centering is turned on by scanning Centering On, the scanner only reads codes
132
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
that pass through the centering window you specify using the Top of Centering
Window, Bottom of Centering Window, Left, and Right of Centering Window bar
codes.
Example: In the example below, the white box is the centering window. The centering window
has been set to 20% left, 30% right, 8% top, and 25% bottom. Since Bar Code 1
passes through the centering window, it will be read. Bar Code 2 does not pass
through the centering window, so it will not be read.
0%
Bar Code 1
10
Bar Code 2
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100%
Note: A bar code needs only to be touched by the centering window in order to be read. It
does not need to pass completely through the centering window.
Scan Centering On, then scan one of the following bar codes to change the top,
bottom, left, or right of the centering window. Then scan the percent you want to
shift the centering window using digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on
page 341, then Save. Default Centering = 40% for Top and Left, 60% for Bottom
and Right.
Centering On
* Centering Off
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
133
Top of Centering Window
Bottom of Centering Window
Left of Centering Window
Right of Centering Window
Preferred Symbology
The scanner can be programmed to specify one symbology as a higher priority over
other symbologies in situations where both bar code symbologies appear on the
same label, but the lower priority symbology cannot be disabled.
For example, you may be using the scanner in a retail setting to read U.P.C. symbols, but have occasional need to read a code on a drivers license. Since some
licenses have a Code 39 symbol as well as the PDF417 symbol, you can use Preferred Symbology to specify that the PDF417 symbol be read instead of the Code
39.
Preferred Symbology classifies each symbology as high priority, low priority, or as
an unspecified type. When a low priority symbology is presented, the scanner
ignores it for a set period of time (see Preferred Symbology Time-out on page 135)
while it searches for the high priority symbology. If a high priority symbology is
located during this period, then that data is read immediately.
If the time-out period expires before a high priority symbology is read, the scanner
will read any bar code in its view (low priority or unspecified). If there is no bar code
in the scanner’s view after the time-out period expires, then no data is reported.
Note: A low priority symbol must be centered on the aiming pattern to be read.
Scan a bar code below to enable or disable Preferred Symbology. Default = Preferred Symbology Off.
Preferred Symbology On
134
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
* Preferred Symbology Off
High Priority Symbology
To specify the high priority symbology, scan the High Priority Symbology bar code
below. On the Symbology Charts on page 327, find the symbology you want to set
as high priority. Locate the Hex value for that symbology and scan the 2 digit hex
value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default =
None.
High Priority Symbology
Low Priority Symbology
To specify the low priority symbology, scan the Low Priority Symbology bar code
below. On the Symbology Charts on page 327, find the symbology you want to set
as low priority. Locate the Hex value for that symbology and scan the 2 digit hex
value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341.
If you want to set additional low priority symbologies, scan FF, then scan the 2 digit
hex value from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, for the next symbology. You can program up to 5 low priority symbologies. Scan Save to save your
selection. Default = None.
Low Priority Symbology
Preferred Symbology Time-out
Once you have enabled Preferred Symbology and entered the high and low priority
symbologies, you must set the time-out period. This is the period of time the scanner will search for a high priority bar code after a low priority bar code has been
encountered. Scan the bar code below, then set the delay (from 1-3,000 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341,
then Save. Default = 500 ms.
Preferred Symbology Time-out
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
135
Preferred Symbology Default
Scan the bar code below to set all Preferred Symbology entries to their default values.
Preferred Symbology Default
Output Sequence Overview
Output Sequence Editor
This programming selection allows you to program the scanner to output data
(when scanning more than one symbol) in whatever order your application
requires, regardless of the order in which the bar codes are scanned. Reading the
Default Sequence symbol programs the scanner to the Universal values, shown
below. These are the defaults. Be certain you want to delete or clear all formats
before you read the Default Sequence symbol.
Note: To make Output Sequence Editor selections, you’ll need to know the code I.D., code
length, and character match(es) your application requires. Use the Alphanumeric
symbols from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. You must hold the
trigger while reading each bar code in the sequence.
To Add an Output Sequence
1. Scan the Enter Sequence symbol (see Require Output Sequence, page 139).
2. Code I.D.
On the Symbology Charts on page 327, find the symbology to which you want
to apply the output sequence format. Locate the Hex value for that symbology
and scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart (inside back cover).
3. Length
Specify what length (up to 9999 characters) of data output will be acceptable
for this symbology. Scan the four digit data length Programming Chart,
beginning on page 341. (Note: 50 characters is entered as 0050. 9999 is a
universal number, indicating all lengths.) When calculating the length, you
must count any programmed prefixes, suffixes, or formatted characters as part
of the length (unless using 9999).
4. Character Match Sequences
On the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), page 330, find the Hex value
that represents the character(s) you want to match. Use the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341, to read the alphanumeric combination that
represents the ASCII characters. (99 is the Universal number, indicating all
characters.)
136
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
5. End Output Sequence Editor
Scan F F to enter an Output Sequence for an additional symbology, or Save to
save your entries.
Other Programming Selections
Discard exits without saving any Output Sequence changes.
Output Sequence Example
In this example, you are scanning Code 93, Code 128, and Code 39 bar codes, but
you want the scanner to output Code 39 1st, Code 128 2nd, and Code 93 3rd, as
shown below.
Note: Code 93 must be enabled to use this example.
A - Code 39
B - Code 128
C - Code 93
You would set up the sequence editor with the following command line:
SEQBLK62999941FF6A999942FF69999943FF
The breakdown of the command line is shown below:
SEQBLK
sequence editor start command
62
code identifier for Code 39
9999
code length that must match for Code 39, 9999 = all lengths
41
start character match for Code 39, 41h = “A”
FF
termination string for first code
6A
code identifier for Code 128
9999
code length that must match for Code 128, 9999 = all lengths
42
start character match for Code 128, 42h = “B”
FF
termination string for second code
69
code identifier for Code 93
9999
code length that must match for Code 93, 9999 = all lengths
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
137
43
start character match for Code 93, 43h = “C”
FF
termination string for third code
To program the previous example using specific lengths, you would have to count
any programmed prefixes, suffixes, or formatted characters as part of the length. If
you use the example on page 137, but assume a <CR> suffix and specific code
lengths, you would use the following command line:
SEQBLK62001241FF6A001342FF69001243FF
The breakdown of the command line is shown below:
SEQBLK
sequence editor start command
62
code identifier for Code 39
0012
A - Code 39 sample length (11) plus CR suffix (1) = 12
41
start character match for Code 39, 41h = “A”
FF
termination string for first code
6A
code identifier for Code 128
0013
B - Code 128 sample length (12) plus CR suffix (1) = 13
42
start character match for Code 128, 42h = “B”
FF
termination string for second code
69
code identifier for Code 93
0012
C - Code 93 sample length (11) plus CR suffix (1) = 12
43
start character match for Code 93, 43h = “C”
FFtermination string for third code
Output Sequence Editor
Enter Sequence
Default Sequence
Partial Sequence
If an output sequence operation is terminated before all your output sequence criteria are met, the bar code data acquired to that point is a “partial sequence.”
138
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Scan Discard Partial Sequence to discard partial sequences when the output
sequence operation is terminated before completion. Scan Transmit Partial
Sequence to transmit partial sequences. (Any fields in the sequence where no data
match occurred are skipped in the output.)
Transmit Partial Sequence
* Discard Partial Sequence
Require Output Sequence
When an output sequence is Required, all output data must conform to an edited
sequence or the scanner will not transmit the output data to the host device. When
it’s On/Not Required, the scanner will attempt to get the output data to conform to
an edited sequence but, if it cannot, the scanner transmits all output data to the
host device as is.
When the output sequence is Off, the bar code data is output to the host as the
scanner decodes it. Default = Off.
Note: This selection is unavailable when the Multiple Symbols Selection is turned on.
Required
On/Not Required
*Off
Multiple Symbols
When this programming selection is turned On, it allows you to read multiple symbols with a single pull of the scanner’s trigger. If you press and hold the trigger,
aiming the scanner at a series of symbols, it reads unique symbols once, beeping
(if turned on) for each read. If using a Granit scanner, the scanner also vibrates. The
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
139
scanner attempts to find and decode new symbols as long as the trigger is pulled.
When this programming selection is turned Off, the scanner will only read the symbol closest to the aiming beam. Default = Off.
On
* Off
No Read
With No Read turned On, the scanner notifies you if a code cannot be read. If using
an EZConfig-Scanning Tool Scan Data Window (see page 255), an “NR” appears
when a code cannot be read. If No Read is turned Off, the “NR” will not appear.
Default = Off.
On
* Off
If you want a different notation than “NR,” for example, “Error,” or “Bad Code,” you
can edit the output message (see Data Format beginning on page 157). The hex
code for the No Read symbol is 9C.
Video Reverse
Video Reverse is used to allow the scanner to read bar codes that are inverted. The
Video Reverse Off bar code below is an example of this type of bar code. Scan
Video Reverse Only to read only inverted bar codes. Scan Video Reverse and
Standard Bar Codes to read both types of codes.
Note: After scanning Video Reverse Only, menu bar codes cannot be read. You must scan
Video Reverse Off or Video Reverse and Standard Bar Codes in order to read menu
bar codes.
Note: Images downloaded from the unit are not reversed. This is a setting for decoding only.
140
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Video Reverse Only
Video Reverse and Standard
Bar Codes
* Video Reverse Off
Working Orientation
Some bar codes are direction-sensitive. For example, KIX codes and OCR can misread when scanned sideways or upside down. Use the working orientation settings
if your direction-sensitive codes will not usually be presented upright to the scanner. Default = Upright.
Upright:
Vertical, Top to Bottom:
(Rotate CW 90°)
Upside Down:
Vertical, Bottom to Top:
(Rotate CCW 90°)
* Upright
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
141
Vertical, Bottom to Top
Upside Down
Vertical, Top to Bottom
142
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
6
HEALTHCARE SETTINGS
The following settings have been developed to enhance scanning in a healthcare
environment. These settings are only supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner and
Xenon 1902h scanner and base. They allow you to set quickly configure streaming
presentation, and to set the scanner and base to quiet modes for scanning that do
not disturb resting patients.
Quiet Operations - Combination Codes
The following combination codes program your Xenon healthcare scanner and
base for silent or quiet settings using a single programming code. If you wish to
program some of these quiet settings individually, refer to Quiet Operations - LED
and Volume Settings, beginning on page 145.
Silent Mode with Flashing LED
Scan the following bar code to completely silence the Xenon 1900h scanner or
Xenon 1902h scanner and base. The scanner beep, base beep, base and scanner
power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are all silenced. When a bar code is
scanned, the LED and aimer flash 5 times. Green indicates a good scan, red indicates a bad scan.
Silent Mode with Flashing LED Cordless Scanner and Base
Silent Mode with Flashing LED Corded Scanner
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
143
Silent Mode with Long LED
Scan the following bar code to completely silence the Xenon 1900h scanner or
Xenon 1902h scanner and base. The scanner beep, base beep, base and scanner
power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are all silenced. When a bar code is
scanned, the LED and aimer remain solidly lit for 1 second. Green indicates a good
scan, red indicates a bad scan.
Silent Mode with Long LED Cordless Scanner and Base
Silent Mode with Long LED Corded Scanner
Very Low Beeper (Nighttime Mode)
The following bar code silences the base, and sets the scanner for a very low beep
when reading bar codes. After scanning this code, the base beep, base and scanner
power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are all silenced. When a bar code is
scanned, the scanner emits a very soft beep.
Nighttime Mode Cordless Scanner and Base
Nighttime Mode Corded Scanner
144
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Low Beeper (Daytime Mode)
The following bar code sets all sounds to on, but at a low volume. The scanner
beep, base beep, base and scanner power up beep, and scanner linking sounds are
all set to low volume.
Daytime Mode Cordless Scanner and Base
Daytime Mode Corded Scanner
To reset your scanner and base to default sounds, refer to Reset the Custom
Defaults (page 263).
Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings
If you have silenced or muted the scanner and base sounds, you may wish to adjust
the visual (LED) indicators for Bluetooth linking sounds, scanning sounds, paging
sounds, and out of range alarm sounds.
Linking LED Colors and Sound
Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner.
Under normal operations, the scanner chirps when linking to a base or an access
point, and the LED on both the base and scanner flash green. If you want to silence
all sounds and set both devices to flash red LEDs to indicate the linking status,
scan the Red LED Flashes/Silent bar code below. The LEDS flash red while linking, then green to indicate the base and scanner are linked. To return to the default
LED colors and sound, scan Green LED Flashes/Sound. Default = Green LED
Flashes/Sound.
* Green LED Flashes/Sound
Red LED Flashes/Silent
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
145
Number of LED Flashes
If you have silenced the scanner’s beeper, you may set the number of times the
LED flashes when reading bar codes. Default = 1 LED Flash.
Note: If you have set LED Solid (No Flash) (page 147), to anything but Off, that setting will
override the LED Flash settings. In that case, scan the LED Solid Off bar code to turn
off this feature, then scan the LED Flash code you wish to use.
* 1 LED Flash
5 LED Flashes
10 LED Flashes
25 LED Flashes
LED Flash Rate
If you have silenced the scanner’s beeper, you may set the how quickly the LED
flashes when reading bar codes. Default = Fast Flash.
* Fast Flash
Medium Flash
Slow Flash
146
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
LED Solid (No Flash)
Under normal operations, the scanner’s LED flashes once for a good read. You may
set the LED to remain on for a length of time after a good read instead of flashing.
Default = LED Solid Off (Resume Flash).
* LED Solid Off
(Resume Flash)
LED Solid 1 Second
LED Solid 3 Seconds
LED Solid 5 Seconds
If you have scanned a bar code and don’t want to wait for the LED to turn off, press
the trigger a 2nd time and the LED turns off. You can then scan the next bar code.
Page Volume Control
Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner.
When you press the Page button on the base or Access Point, the scanners associated with that base or Access Point will begin beeping in response. If you pull the
trigger on a scanner that is beeping in response, or press the Page button on the
base or Access Point a second time, all associated scanners will stop beeping. The
following settings set the paging volume, independent of the volume used when
scanning bar codes. Default = Low.
Page Volume Off
* Page Volume Low
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
147
Page Volume Medium
Page Volume High
Out-of-Range Alarm Volume
Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner.
If your scanner is out range of the base, an alarm sounds from both your base and
scanner. If your scanner is out range of an Access Point, an alarm sounds from just
the scanner. The alarm stops when the scanner is moved closer to the base or
Access Point, when the base or Access Point connects to another scanner, or when
the alarm duration expires (see Out-of-Range Delay on page 149). The following
settings set the Out-of-Range Alarm for the base and the scanner, independent of
the volume used when scanning bar codes. Default = Base Alarm Volume Low,
Scanner Alarm Volume Low.
Base Alarm Volume
Off
Scanner Alarm Volume
Off
* Base Alarm Volume
Low
* Scanner Alarm Volume
Low
Base Alarm Volume
Medium
148
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Scanner Alarm Volume
Medium
Base Alarm Volume
High
Scanner Alarm Volume
High
Out-of-Range Delay
Note: This setting is not supported by the Xenon 1900h scanner.
When using the Out-of-Range Alarm settings, the length of the delay for the alarm
is set with an Out-of-Range Delay. When the scanner is out of range of the base or
Access Point, the alarm will delay for a set length of time before going off. Set the
length (in seconds) for a timeout by scanning the following bar code, then setting
the timeout (from 0-3,000 seconds) by scanning digits from the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save. Default = No Delay.
Out-of-Range Delay
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
149
150
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
7
DATA EDIT
Prefix/Suffix Overview
When a bar code is scanned, additional information is sent to the host computer
along with the bar code data. This group of bar code data and additional,
user-defined data is called a “message string.” The selections in this section are
used to build the user-defined data into the message string.
Prefix and Suffix characters are data characters that can be sent before and after
scanned data. You can specify if they should be sent with all symbologies, or only
with specific symbologies. The following illustration shows the breakdown of a
message string:
Prefix
Scanned Data
1-11
variable length
alpha numeric &
control characters
Suffix
1-11
alpha numeric &
control characters
Points to Keep In Mind
•
It is not necessary to build a message string. The selections in this chapter are
only used if you wish to alter the default settings. Default prefix = None. Default
suffix = None.
•
A prefix or suffix may be added or cleared from one symbology or all
symbologies.
•
You can add any prefix or suffix from the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page
1252), beginning on page 330, plus Code I.D. and AIM I.D.
•
You can string together several entries for several symbologies at one time.
•
Enter prefixes and suffixes in the order in which you want them to appear on the
output.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
151
•
When setting up for specific symbologies (as opposed to all symbologies), the
specific symbology ID value counts as an added prefix or suffix character.
•
The maximum size of a prefix or suffix configuration is 200 characters, which
includes header information.
Add a Prefix or Suffix:
Step 1.
Scan the Add Prefix or Add Suffix symbol (page 153).
Step 2.
Determine the 2 digit hex value from the Symbology Charts (beginning
on page A-327) for the symbology to which you want to apply the prefix
or suffix. For example, for Code 128, Code ID is “j” and Hex ID is “6A”.
Step 3.
Scan the 2 hex digits from the Programming Chart, beginning on page
341, or scan 9, 9 for all symbologies.
To add the Code I.D., scan 5, C, 8, 0.
To add the AIM I.D., scan 5, C, 8, 1.
To add the serial number, scan 5, C, 8, 8.
To add a backslash (\), scan 5, C, 5, C.
Note: When adding a backslash (\), you must scan 5C twice – once to create the leading
backslash and then to create the backslash itself.
Step 4.
Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for every prefix or suffix character.
Step 5.
Scan Save to exit and save, or scan Discard to exit without saving.
Repeat the steps above to add a prefix or suffix for another symbology.
Example: Add a Tab Suffix to All Symbologies
Step 1.
Scan Add Suffix.
Step 2.
Scan 9, 9 from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 to apply
this suffix to all symbologies.
Step 3.
Scan 0, 9 from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. This
corresponds with the hex value for a horizontal tab, shown in the ASCII
Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330.
Step 4.
Scan Save, or scan Discard to exit without saving.
Clear One or All Prefixes or Suffixes
You can clear a single prefix or suffix, or clear all prefixes/suffixes for a symbology.
If you have been entering prefixes and suffixes for single symbologies, you can use
Clear One Prefix (Suffix) to delete a specific character from a symbology. When
you Clear All Prefixes (Suffixes), all the prefixes or suffixes for a symbology are
deleted.
152
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Step 1.
Scan the Clear One Prefix or Clear One Suffix symbol.
Step 2.
Determine the 2 digit Hex value from the Symbology Chart (included in
the Symbology Charts, beginning on page 327) for the symbology from
which you want to clear the prefix or suffix.
Step 3.
Scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart, beginning on
page 341 or scan 9, 9 for all symbologies.
Your change is automatically saved.
Add a Carriage Return Suffix to All Symbologies
Scan the following bar code if you wish to add a carriage return suffix to all symbologies at once. This action first clears all current suffixes, then programs a carriage
return suffix for all symbologies.
Add CR Suffix
All Symbologies
Prefix Selections
Add Prefix
Clear One Prefix
Clear All Prefixes
Suffix Selections
Add Suffix
Clear One Suffix
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
153
Clear All Suffixes
Function Code Transmit
When this selection is enabled and function codes are contained within the
scanned data, the scanner transmits the function code to the terminal. Charts of
these function codes are provided in ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252),
beginning on page 330. When the scanner is in keyboard wedge mode, the scan
code is converted to a key code before it is transmitted. Default = Enable.
* Enable
Disable
Intercharacter, Interfunction, and Intermessage Delays
Some terminals drop information (characters) if data comes through too quickly.
Intercharacter, interfunction, and intermessage delays slow the transmission of
data, increasing data integrity.
Intercharacter Delay
An intercharacter delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be
placed between the transmission of each character of scanned data. Scan the
Intercharacter Delay bar code below, then scan the number of 5ms delays from
the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
Prefix
Scanned Data
1
2
3
4
Suffix
5
Intercharacter Delay
Intercharacter Delay
154
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
To remove this delay, scan the Intercharacter Delay bar code, then set the number
of delays to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on
page 341.
Note: Intercharacter delays are not supported in USB serial emulation.
User Specified Intercharacter Delay
An intercharacter delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be
placed after the transmission of a particular character of scanned data. Scan the
Delay Length bar code below, then scan the number of 5ms delays from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341, then Save.
Next, scan the Character to Trigger Delay bar code, then the 2-digit hex value for a
printable character to trigger the delay (see Lower ASCII Reference Table, page
331.)
Delay Length
Character to Trigger Delay
To remove this delay, scan the Delay Length bar code, and set the number of delays
to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341.
Interfunction Delay
An interfunction delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be
placed between the transmission of each control character in the message string.
Scan the Interfunction Delay bar code below, then scan the number of 5ms
delays, and the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on page
341.
Prefix
STX
1
Scanned Data
HT
2 3 4 5
Suffix
CR
LF
Interfunction Delays
Interfunction Delay
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
155
To remove this delay, scan the Interfunction Delay bar code, then set the number
of delays to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on
page 341.
Intermessage Delay
An intermessage delay of up to 5000 milliseconds (in 5ms increments) may be
placed between each scan transmission. Scan the Intermessage Delay bar code
below, then scan the number of 5ms delays, and the Save bar code from the
Programming Chart, beginning on page 341.
1st Scan Transmission
2nd Scan Transmission
Intermessage Delay
Intermessage Delay
To remove this delay, scan the Intermessage Delay bar code, then set the number
of delays to 0. Scan the Save bar code from the Programming Chart, beginning on
page 341.
156
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
8
DATA FORMAT
Data Format Editor Introduction
You may use the Data Format Editor to change the scanner’s output. For example,
you can use the Data Format Editor to insert characters at certain points in bar
code data as it is scanned. The selections in the following pages are used only if
you wish to alter the output. Default Data Format setting = None.
Normally, when you scan a bar code, it is output automatically. However, when you
create a format, you must use a “send” command (see Send Commands on page
160) within the format program to output data.
Multiple formats may be programmed into the scanner. They are stacked in the
order in which they are entered. However, the following list presents the order in
which formats are applied:
1. Specific Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Actual Length
2. Specific Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Universal Length
3. Specific Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Actual Length
4. Specific Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Universal Length
5. Universal Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Actual Length
6. Universal Terminal ID, Actual Code ID, Universal Length
7. Universal Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Actual Length
8. Universal Terminal ID, Universal Code ID, Universal Length
The maximum size of a data format configuration is 2000 bytes, which includes
header information.
If a bar code is read that fails the first data format, the next data format, if there is
one, will be used on the bar code data. If there is no other data format, the raw data
is output.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
157
If you have changed data format settings, and wish to clear all formats and return
to the factory defaults, scan the Default Data Format code below.
* Default Data Format
Add a Data Format
Step 1.
Scan the Enter Data Format symbol (page 159).
Step 2.
Select Primary/Alternate Format
Determine if this will be your primary data format, or one of 3 alternate
formats. This allows you to save a total of 4 different data formats. To
program your primary format, scan 0 from the Programming Chart,
beginning on page 341. If you are programming an alternate format,
scan 1, 2, or 3, depending on which alternate format you are
programming. (See Primary/Alternate Data Formats on page 175 for
further information.)
Step 3.
Terminal Type
Refer to Terminal ID Table (page 160) and locate the Terminal ID number
for your PC. Scan three numeric bar codes from the Programming Chart,
beginning on page 341, to program the scanner for your terminal ID (you
must enter 3 digits). For example, scan 0 0 3 for an AT wedge.
Note: 099 indicates all terminal types.
Step 4.
Code I.D.
In the Symbology Charts, beginning on page 327, find the symbology to
which you want to apply the data format. Locate the Hex value for that
symbology and scan the 2 digit hex value from the Programming Chart,
beginning on page 341.
If you wish to create a data format for all symbologies, with the exception
of some specific symbologies, refer to B8 (page 173).
If you are creating a data format for Batch Mode Quantity, use 35 for the
Code I.D.
Note: 99 indicates all symbologies.
Step 5.
Length
Specify what length (up to 9999 characters) of data will be acceptable for
this symbology. Scan the four digit data length from the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341. For example, 50 characters is entered as
0050.
Note: 9999 indicates all lengths.
Step 6.
158
Editor Commands
Refer to Data Format Editor Commands (page 160). Scan the symbols
that represent the command you want to enter.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Step 7.
Scan Save to save your data format, or Discard to exit without saving your
changes.
Enter Data Format
Save
Discard
Other Programming Selections
•
Clear One Data Format
This deletes one data format for one symbology. If you are clearing the primary
format, scan 0 from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. If you are
clearing an alternate format, scan 1, 2, or 3, depending on the format you are
clearing. Scan the Terminal Type and Code I.D. (see Symbology Charts on page
327), and the bar code data length for the specific data format that you want to
delete. All other formats remain unaffected.
•
Clear all Data Formats
This clears all data formats.
•
Save
Exit and save your data format changes.
•
Discard
Exit without saving any data format changes.
Clear One Data Format
Clear All Data Formats
Save
Discard
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
159
Terminal ID Table
Terminal
Model(s)
Terminal ID
USB
PC keyboard (HID)
124
Mac Keyboard
125
PC Keyboard (Japanese)
134
Serial (COM driver required)
130
HID POS
131
Serial
Keyboard
USB SurePOS Handheld
128
USB SurePOS Tabletop
129
RS232 TTL
000
RS232 True
000
RS485 (IBM-HHBCR 1+2, 46xx)
051
PS2 compatibles
003
AT compatibles
002
Data Format Editor Commands
When working with the Data Format Editor, a virtual cursor is moved along your
input data string. The following commands are used to both move this cursor to
different positions, and to select, replace, and insert data into the final output.
Send Commands
Send all characters
F1 Include in the output message all of the characters from the input message, starting
from current cursor position, followed by an insert character. Syntax = F1xx where xx
stands for the insert character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the ASCII
Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and
character codes.
Send a number of characters
F2 Include in the output message a number of characters followed by an insert
character. Start from the current cursor position and continue for “nn” characters or
through the last character in the input message, followed by character “xx.” Syntax
= F2nnxx where nn stands for the numeric value (00-99) for the number of
characters, and xx stands for the insert character’s hex value for its ASCII code.
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
160
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
F2 Example: Send a number of characters
Send the first 10 characters from the bar code above, followed by a carriage return.
Command string: F2100D
F2 is the “Send a number of characters” command
10 is the number of characters to send
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as: 1234567890
F2 and F1 Example: Split characters into 2 lines
Send the first 10 characters from the bar code above, followed by a carriage return,
followed by the rest of the characters.
Command string: F2100DF10D
F2 is the “Send a number of characters” command
10 is the number of characters to send for the first line
0D is the hex value for a CR
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
1234567890
ABCDEFGHIJ
<CR>
Send all characters up to a particular character
F3 Include in the output message all characters from the input message, starting with
the character at the current cursor position and continuing to, but not including, the
search character “ss,” followed by an insert character. The cursor is moved forward
to the “ss” character. Syntax = F3ssxx where ss stands for the search character’s hex
value for its ASCII code, and xx stands for the insert character’s hex value for its
ASCII code.
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
F3 Example: Send all characters up to a particular character
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
161
Using the bar code above, send all characters up to but not including “D,” followed
by a carriage return.
Command string: F3440D
F3 is the “Send all characters up to a particular character” command
44 is the hex value for a 'D”
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
1234567890ABC
<CR>
Send all characters up to a string
B9 Include in the output message all characters from the input message, starting with
the character at the current cursor position and continuing to, but not including, the
search string “s...s.” The cursor is moved forward to the beginning of the “s...s”
string. Syntax = B9nnnns...s where nnnn stands for the length of the string, and s...s
stands for the string to be matched. The string is made up of hex values for the
characters in the string. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252),
beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes.
B9 Example: Send all characters up to a defined string
Using the bar code above, send all characters up to but not including “AB.”
Command string: B900024142
B9 is the “Send all characters up to a string” command
0002 is the length of the string (2 characters)
41 is the hex value for A
42 is the hex value for B
The data is output as: 1234567890
Send all but the last characters
E9 Include in the output message all but the last “nn” characters, starting from the
current cursor position. The cursor is moved forward to one position past the last
input message character included. Syntax = E9nn where nn stands for the numeric
value (00-99) for the number of characters that will not be sent at the end of the
message.
162
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Insert a character multiple times
F4 Send “xx” character “nn” times in the output message, leaving the cursor in the
current position. Syntax = F4xxnn where xx stands for the insert character’s hex
value for its ASCII code, and nn is the numeric value (00-99) for the number of times
it should be sent. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning
on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes.
E9 and F4 Example: Send all but the last characters, followed by 2 tabs
Send all characters except for the last 8 from the bar code above, followed by 2
tabs.
Command string: E908F40902
E9 is the “Send all but the last characters” command
08 is the number of characters at the end to ignore
F4 is the “Insert a character multiple times” command
09 is the hex value for a horizontal tab
02 is the number of times the tab character is sent
The data is output as: 1234567890AB <tab><tab>
Insert a string
BA Send “ss” string of “nn” length in the output message, leaving the cursor in the
current position. Syntax = BAnnnns...s where nnnn stands for the length of the
string, and s...s stands for the string. The string is made up of hex values for the
characters in the string. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252),
beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes.
B9 and BA Example: Look for the string “AB” and insert 2 asterisks (**)
Using the bar code above, send all characters up to but not including “AB.” Insert 2
asterisks at that point, and send the rest of the data with a carriage return after.
Command string: B900024142BA00022A2AF10D
B9 is the “Send all characters up to a string” command
0002 is the length of the string (2 characters)
41 is the hex value for A
42 is the hex value for B
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
163
BA is the “Insert a string” command
0002 is the length of the string to be added (2 characters)
2A is the hex value for an asterisk (*)
2A is the hex value for an asterisk (*)
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
1234567890**ABCDEFGHIJ
<CR>
Insert symbology name
B3 Insert the name of the bar code’s symbology in the output message, without moving
the cursor. Only symbologies with a Honeywell ID are included (see Symbology
Charts on page 327). Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252),
beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex and character codes.
Insert bar code length
B4 Insert the bar code’s length in the output message, without moving the cursor. The
length is expressed as a numeric string and does not include leading zeros.
B3 and B4 Example: Insert the symbology name and length
Send the symbology name and length before the bar code data from the bar code
above. Break up these insertions with spaces. End with a carriage return.
Command string: B3F42001B4F42001F10D
B3 is the “Insert symbology name” command
F4 is the “Insert a character multiple times” command
20 is the hex value for a space
01 is the number of times the space character is sent
B4 is the “Insert bar code length” command
F4 is the “Insert a character multiple times” command
20 is the hex value for a space
01 is the number of times the space character is sent
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
164
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
Code128 20 1234567890ABCDEFGHIJ
<CR>
Insert key strokes
B5 Insert a key stroke or combination of key strokes. Key strokes are dependent on your
keyboard (see Keyboard Key References on page 337). Any key can be inserted,
including arrows and functions. Syntax = 5CB5xxssnn where xx is the number of
keys pressed (without key modifiers), ss is the key modifier from the table below, and
nn is the key number from the Keyboard Key References, page 337.
•
Key Modifiers
Hex
No Key Modifier
00
Shift Left
01
Shift Right
02
Alt Left
04
Alt Right
08
Control Left
10
Control Right
20
For example, B501021F inserts an “A” on a 104 key, U.S. style keyboard. B5 = the
command, 01 = number of key press events (without the key modifier), 02 is the
key modifier for Shift Right, and 1F is the “a” key. If a lower case “a” were to be
inserted, B501001F would be entered.
If there are three keystrokes, the syntax would change from B5xxssnn for one keystroke to B5xxssnnssnnssnn. An example that would insert "abc" is as follows:
B503001F00320030F833.
Note: Key modifiers can be added together when needed. The sum is converted to
hexadecimals.
Example: Control Left+Shift Left = 17, converted to hexadecimal = 11.
Move Commands
Move the cursor forward a number of characters
F5 Move the cursor ahead “nn” characters from current cursor position.
Syntax = F5nn where nn is the numeric value (00-99) for the number of characters
the cursor should be moved ahead.
F5 Example: Move the cursor forward and send the data
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
165
Move the cursor forward 3 characters, then send the rest of the bar code data from
the bar code above. End with a carriage return.
Command string: F503F10D
F5 is the “Move the cursor forward a number of characters” command
03 is the number of characters to move the cursor
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
4567890ABCDEFGHIJ
<CR>
Move the cursor backward a number of characters
F6 Move the cursor back “nn” characters from current cursor position.
Syntax = F6nn where nn is the numeric value (00-99) for the number of characters
the cursor should be moved back.
Move the cursor to the beginning
F7 Move the cursor to the first character in the input message. Syntax = F7.
FE and F7 Example: Manipulate bar codes that begin with a 1
Search for bar codes that begin with a 1. If a bar code matches, move the cursor
back to the beginning of the data and send 6 characters followed by a carriage
return. Using the bar code above:
Command string: FE31F7F2060D
FE is the “Compare characters” command
31 is the hex value for 1
F7 is the “Move the cursor to the beginning” command
F2 is the “Send a number of characters” command
06 is the number of characters to send
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
123456
<CR>
166
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Move the cursor to the end
EA Move the cursor to the last character in the input message. Syntax = EA.
Search Commands
Search forward for a character
F8 Search the input message forward for “xx” character from the current cursor
position, leaving the cursor pointing to the “xx” character. Syntax = F8xx where xx
stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code.
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
F8 Example: Send bar code data that starts after a particular character
Search for the letter “D” in bar codes and send all the data that follows, including
the “D.” Using the bar code above:
Command string: F844F10D
F8 is the “Search forward for a character” command
44 is the hex value for “D”
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
DEFGHIJ
<CR>
Search backward for a character
F9 Search the input message backward for “xx” character from the current cursor
position, leaving the cursor pointing to the “xx” character. Syntax = F9xx where xx
stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code.
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
167
Search forward for a string
B0 Search forward for “s” string from the current cursor position, leaving cursor
pointing to “s” string. Syntax = B0nnnnS where nnnn is the string length (up to
9999), and S consists of the ASCII hex value of each character in the match string.
For example, B0000454657374 will search forward for the first occurrence of the 4
character string “Test.”
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
B0 Example: Send bar code data that starts after a string of characters
Search for the letters “FGH” in bar codes and send all the data that follows, including “FGH.” Using the bar code above:
Command string: B00003464748F10D
B0 is the “Search forward for a string” command
0003 is the string length (3 characters)
46 is the hex value for “F”
47 is the hex value for “G”
48 is the hex value for “H”
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
FGHIJ
<CR>
Search backward for a string
B1 Search backward for “s” string from the current cursor position, leaving cursor
pointing to “s” string. Syntax = B1nnnnS where nnnn is the string length (up to
9999), and S consists of the ASCII hex value of each character in the match string.
For example, B1000454657374 will search backward for the first occurrence of the
4 character string “Test.”
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
168
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Search forward for a non-matching character
E6 Search the input message forward for the first non-“xx” character from the current
cursor position, leaving the cursor pointing to the non-“xx” character. Syntax = E6xx
where xx stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII code. Refer to the
ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for decimal, hex
and character codes.
E6 Example: Remove zeros at the beginning of bar code data
This example shows a bar code that has been zero filled. You may want to ignore
the zeros and send all the data that follows. E6 searches forward for the first character that is not zero, then sends all the data after, followed by a carriage return.
Using the bar code above:
Command string: E630F10D
E6 is the “Search forward for a non-matching character” command
30 is the hex value for 0
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
37692
<CR>
Search backward for a non-matching character
E7 Search the input message backward for the first non-“xx” character from the
current cursor position, leaving the cursor pointing to the non-“xx” character.
Syntax = E7xx where xx stands for the search character’s hex value for its ASCII
code. Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page
330 for decimal, hex and character codes.
Miscellaneous Commands
Suppress characters
FB Suppress all occurrences of up to 15 different characters, starting at the current
cursor position, as the cursor is advanced by other commands. When the FC
command is encountered, the suppress function is terminated. The cursor is not
moved by the FB command.
Syntax = FBnnxxyy . .zz where nn is a count of the number of suppressed characters
in the list, and xxyy .. zz is the list of characters to be suppressed.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
169
FB Example: Remove spaces in bar code data
This example shows a bar code that has spaces in the data. You may want to
remove the spaces before sending the data. Using the bar code above:
Command string: FB0120F10D
FB is the “Suppress characters” command
01 is the number of character types to be suppressed
20 is the hex value for a space
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
34567890
<CR>
Stop suppressing characters
FC Disables suppress filter and clear all suppressed characters. Syntax = FC.
Replace characters
E4 Replaces up to 15 characters in the output message, without moving the cursor.
Replacement continues until the E5 command is encountered. Syntax =
E4nnxx1xx2yy1yy2...zz1zz2 where nn is the total count of the number of characters
in the list (characters to be replaced plus replacement characters); xx1 defines
characters to be replaced and xx2 defines replacement characters, continuing
through zz1 and zz2.
E4 Example: Replace zeros with CRs in bar code data
If the bar code has characters that the host application does not want included,
you can use the E4 command to replace those characters with something else. In
this example, you will replace the zeros in the bar code above with carriage returns.
Command string: E402300DF10D
E4 is the “Replace characters” command
02 is the total count of characters to be replaced, plus the replacement characters
(0 is replaced by CR, so total characters = 2)
30 is the hex value for 0
170
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
0D is the hex value for a CR (the character that will replace the 0)
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
The data is output as:
1234
5678
ABC
<CR>
Stop replacing characters
E5 Terminates character replacement. Syntax = E5.
Compare characters
FE Compare the character in the current cursor position to the character “xx.” If
characters are equal, move the cursor forward one position. Syntax = FExx where xx
stands for the comparison character’s hex value for its ASCII code.
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
Compare string
B2 Compare the string in the input message to the string “s.” If the strings are equal,
move the cursor forward past the end of the string. Syntax = B2nnnnS where nnnn
is the string length (up to 9999), and S consists of the ASCII hex value of each
character in the match string. For example, B2000454657374 will compare the
string at the current cursor position with the 4 character string “Test.”
Refer to the ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252), beginning on page 330 for
decimal, hex and character codes.
Check for a number
EC Check to make sure there is an ASCII number at the current cursor position. The
format is aborted if the character is not numeric.
EC Example: Only output the data if the bar code begins with a number
If you want only data from bar codes that begin with a number, you can use EC to
check for the number.
Command string: ECF10D
EC is the “Check for a number” command
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
171
If this bar code is read,
the next data format, if there is one, will
be used on the data. If there is no other format, the format fails and the raw data is
output as AB1234.
If this bar code is read:
the data is output as:
1234AB
<CR>
Check for non-numeric character
ED Check to make sure there is a non-numeric ASCII character at the current cursor
position. The format is aborted if the character is numeric.
ED Example: Only output the data if the bar code begins with a letter
If you want only data from bar codes that begin with a letter, you can use ED to
check for the letter.
Command string: EDF10D
ED is the “Check for a non-numeric character” command
F1 is the “Send all characters” command
0D is the hex value for a CR
If this bar code is read,
the next data format, if there is one, will
be used on this data. If there is no other format, the format fails and the raw data is
output as 1234AB.
If this bar code is read:
the data is output as:
AB1234
<CR>
Insert a delay
EF Inserts a delay of up to 49,995 milliseconds (in multiples of 5), starting from the
current cursor position. Syntax = EFnnnn where nnnn stands for the delay in 5ms
increments, up to 9999. This command can only be used with keyboard emulation.
172
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Discard Data
B8 Discards types of data. For example, you may want to discard Code 128 bar codes
that begin with the letter A. In step 4 (page 158), select 6A (for Code 128), and in step
5, select 9999 (for all lengths). Enter FE41B8 to compare and discard Code 128 bar
codes that begin with the letter A. Syntax = B8.
Note: The B8 command must be entered after all other commands.
The Data Format must be Required (see page 173) in order for the B8 command to
work.
If Data Format is On, but Not Required (page 174), bar code data that meets the B8
format is scanned and output as usual.
Because the data format needs to be On and Required (page 174) for the B8
command, you must input data formats for all bar codes you wish to discard as well
as all bar codes you wish to output.
Other data format settings impact the B8 command. If Data Format Non-Match Error
Tone is On (page 174), the scanner emits an error tone. If Data format Non-Match
Error Tone is Off, the code is disabled for reading and no tone is sounded.
Data Formatter
When Data Formatter is turned Off, the bar code data is output to the host as read,
including prefixes and suffixes.
Data Formatter Off
You may wish to require the data to conform to a data format you have created and
saved. The following settings can be applied to your data format:
•
Data Formatter On, Not Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix
Scanned data is modified according to your data format, and prefixes and
suffixes are transmitted.
•
Data Formatter On, Not Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix
Scanned data is modified according to your data format. If a data format is
found for a particular symbol, those prefixes and suffixes are not transmitted. If
a data format is not found for that symbol, the prefixes and suffixes are
transmitted.
•
Data Format Required, Keep Prefix/Suffix
Scanned data is modified according to your data format, and prefixes and
suffixes are transmitted. Any data that does not match your data format
requirements generates an error tone and the data in that bar code is not
transmitted. If you wish to process this type of bar code without generating an
error tone, see Data Format Non-Match Error Tone.
•
Data Format Required, Drop Prefix/Suffix
Scanned data is modified according to your data format. If a data format is
found for a particular symbol, those prefixes and suffixes are not transmitted.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
173
Any data that does not match your data format requirements generates an error
tone. If you wish to process this type of bar code without generating an error
tone, see Data Format Non-Match Error Tone.
Choose one of the following options. Default = Data Formatter On, Not Required,
Keep Prefix/Suffix.
* Data Formatter On,
Not Required,
Keep Prefix/Suffix
Data Formatter On,
Not Required,
Drop Prefix/Suffix
Data Format Required,
Keep Prefix/Suffix
Data Format Required,
Drop Prefix/Suffix
Data Format Non-Match Error Tone
When a bar code is encountered that doesn’t match your required data format, the
scanner normally generates an error tone. However, you may want to continue
scanning bar codes without hearing the error tone. If you scan the Data Format
Non-Match Error Tone Off bar code, data that doesn’t conform to your data format is not transmitted, and no error tone will sound. If you wish to hear the error
tone when a non-matching bar code is found, scan the Data Format Non-Match
Error Tone On bar code. Default = Data Format Non-Match Error Tone On.
* Data Format Non-Match Error
Tone On
Data Format Non-Match
Error Tone Off
174
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Primary/Alternate Data Formats
You can save up to four data formats, and switch between these formats. Your primary data format is saved under 0. Your other three formats are saved under 1, 2,
and 3. To set your device to use one of these formats, scan one of the bar codes
below.
Primary Data Format
Data Format 1
Data Format 2
Data Format 3
Single Scan Data Format Change
You can also switch between data formats for a single scan. The next bar code is
scanned using an alternate data format, then reverts to the format you have
selected above (either Primary, 1, 2, or 3).
For example, you may have set your device to the data format you saved as Data
Format 3. You can switch to Data Format 1 for a single trigger pull by scanning the
Single Scan-Data Format 1 bar code below. The next bar code that is scanned
uses Data Format 1, then reverts back to Data Format 3.
Single Scan-Primary
Data Format
Single Scan-Data Format 1
Single Scan-Data Format 2
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
175
Single Scan-Data Format 3
176
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
9
SYMBOLOGIES
This programming section contains the following menu selections. Refer to
Chapter 12 for settings and defaults.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
All Symbologies
Aztec Code
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5)
Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code
Codabar
Codablock A
Codablock F
Code 11
Code 128
Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF)
Code 39
Code 93
Data Matrix
•
EAN/JAN-13
•
EAN/JAN-8
•
•
•
•
GS1 Composite Codes
GS1 DataBar Expanded
GS1 DataBar Limited
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional
•
GS1 Emulation
•
GS1-128
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Interleaved 2 of 5
Korea Post
Label Code
Matrix 2 of 5
MaxiCode
MicroPDF417
MSI
NEC 2 of 5
Postal Codes - 2D
Postal Codes - Linear
PDF417
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional
QR Code
Straight 2 of 5 IATA (two-bar start/
stop)
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial (three-bar
start/stop)
TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39)
Telepen
Trioptic Code
UPC-A
UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended
Coupon Code
UPC-E0
UPC-E1
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
177
All Symbologies
If you want to decode all the symbologies allowable for your scanner, scan the All
Symbologies On code. If on the other hand, you want to decode only a particular
symbology, scan All Symbologies Off followed by the On symbol for that particular
symbology.
Note: Scanner performance may reduce by scanning All Symbologies On. Only scan All
Symbologies On when needed.
All Symbologies On
All Symbologies Off
Note: When All Symbologies On is scanned, 2D Postal Codes are not enabled. 2D Postal
Codes must be enabled separately.
Message Length Description
You are able to set the valid reading length of some of the bar code symbologies.
You may wish to set the same value for minimum and maximum length to force the
scanner to read fixed length bar code data. This helps reduce the chances of a misread.
Example: Decode only those bar codes with a count of 9-20 characters.
Min. length = 09
Max. length = 20
Example: Decode only those bar codes with a count of 15 characters.
Min. length = 15
Max. length = 15
For a value other than the minimum and maximum message length defaults, scan
the bar codes included in the explanation of the symbology, then scan the digit
value of the message length and Save bar codes from the Programming Chart,
beginning on page 341. The minimum and maximum lengths and the defaults are
included with the respective symbologies.
178
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Codabar
<Default All Codabar Settings>
Codabar On/Off
* On
Off
Codabar Start /Stop Characters
Start/Stop characters identify the leading and trailing ends of the bar code. You
may either transmit, or not transmit Start/Stop characters. Default = Don’t Transmit.
Transmit
* Don’t Transmit
Codabar Check Character
Codabar check characters are created using different “modulos.” You can program
the scanner to read only Codabar bar codes with Modulo 16 check characters.
Default = No Check Character.
No Check Character indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data
with or without a check character.
When Check Character is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner will only read
Codabar bar codes printed with a check character, and will transmit this character
at the end of the scanned data.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
179
When Check Character is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit will only
read Codabar bar codes printed with a check character, but will not transmit the
check character with the scanned data.
* No Check Character
Validate Modulo 16, but
Don’t Transmit
Validate Modulo 16
and Transmit
Codabar Concatenation
Codabar supports symbol concatenation. When you enable concatenation, the
scanner looks for a Codabar symbol having a “D” start character, adjacent to a
symbol having a “D” stop character. In this case the two messages are concatenated into one with the “D” characters omitted.
A 1 2 3 4 D
D 5 6 7 8 A
Select Require to prevent the scanner from decoding a single “D” Codabar symbol
without its companion. This selection has no effect on Codabar symbols without
Stop/Start D characters.
On
* Off
Require
180
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Codabar Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 2-60. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 60.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Code 39
< Default All Code 39 Settings >
Code 39 On/Off
* On
Off
If you are reading Code 39 bar codes, Codablock A should remain disabled. If you
are enabling Codablock A (see Codablock A on page 213), you should disable Code
39.
Code 39 Start /Stop Characters
Start/Stop characters identify the leading and trailing ends of the bar code. You
may either transmit, or not transmit Start/Stop characters. Default = Don’t Transmit.
Transmit
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
181
* Don’t Transmit
Code 39 Check Character
No Check Character indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data
with or without a check character.
When Check Character is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit only reads
Code 39 bar codes printed with a check character, but will not transmit the check
character with the scanned data.
When Check Character is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner only reads
Code 39 bar codes printed with a check character, and will transmit this character
at the end of the scanned data. Default = No Check Character.
* No Check Character
Validate, but Don’t Transmit
Validate and Transmit
Code 39 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 0-48. Minimum Default = 0, Maximum Default = 48.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
182
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Code 39 Append
This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Code 39 bar
codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner
encounters a Code 39 bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers
Code 39 bar codes until it reads a Code 39 bar code that does not have the append
trigger. The data is then transmitted in the order in which the bar codes were read
(FIFO). Default = Off.
On
* Off
Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF)
Code 32 Pharmaceutical is a form of the Code 39 symbology used by Italian pharmacies. This symbology is also known as PARAF.
Note: Trioptic Code (page 212) must be turned off while scanning Code 32 Pharmaceutical
codes.
On
* Off
Full ASCII
If Full ASCII Code 39 decoding is enabled, certain character pairs within the bar
code symbol will be interpreted as a single character. For example: $V will be
decoded as the ASCII character SYN, and /C will be decoded as the ASCII character
#. Default = Off.
Full ASCII Table
NUL %U
SOH $A
STX $B
ETX $C
EOT $D
ENQ $E
ACK $F
DLE $P
DC1 $Q
DC2 $R
DC3 $S
DC4 $T
NAK $U
SYN $V
SP
!
“
#
$
%
&
SPACE
/A
/B
/C
/D
/E
/F
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
@
A
B
C
D
E
F
%V
A
B
C
D
E
F
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
‘
a
b
c
d
e
f
%W
+A
+B
+C
+D
+E
+F
p
q
r
s
t
u
v
+P
+Q
+R
+S
+T
+U
+V
183
Full ASCII Table (Continued)
BEL
BS
HT
LF
VT
FF
CR
SO
SI
$G
$H
$I
$J
$K
$L
$M
$N
$O
ETB $W
CAN $X
EM $Y
SUB $Z
ESC %A
FS %B
GS %C
RS %D
US %E
‘
(
)
*
+
,
.
/
/G
/H
/I
/J
/K
/L
.
/O
7
8
9
:
;
<
=
>
?
7
8
9
/Z
%F
%G
%H
%I
%J
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
W
X
Y
Z
[
\
]
^
_
W
X
Y
Z
%K
%L
%M
%N
%O
g
h
i
j
k
l
m
n
o
+G
+H
+I
+J
+K
+L
+M
+N
+O
w
x
y
z
{
|
}
~
DEL
+W
+X
+Y
+Z
%P
%Q
%R
%S
%T
Character pairs /M and /N decode as a minus sign and period respectively.
Character pairs /P through /Y decode as 0 through 9.
Full ASCII On
* Full ASCII Off
Code 39 Code Page
Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data
received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar
code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one
the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select
the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646
Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code
from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should
then appear properly.
Code 39 Code Page
184
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Interleaved 2 of 5
< Default All Interleaved 2 of 5 Settings >
Interleaved 2 of 5 On/Off
* On
Off
Check Digit
No Check Digit indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data with
or without a check digit.
When Check Digit is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit only reads Interleaved 2 of 5 bar codes printed with a check digit, but will not transmit the check
digit with the scanned data.
When Check Digit is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner only reads Interleaved 2 of 5 bar codes printed with a check digit, and will transmit this digit at the
end of the scanned data. Default = No Check Digit.
* No Check Digit
Validate, but Don’t Transmit
Validate and Transmit
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
185
Interleaved 2 of 5 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 6, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
NEC 2 of 5
< Default All NEC 2 of 5 Settings >
NEC 2 of 5 On/Off
* On
Off
Check Digit
No Check Digit indicates that the scanner reads and transmits bar code data with
or without a check digit.
When Check Digit is set to Validate, but Don’t Transmit, the unit only reads NEC 2
of 5 bar codes printed with a check digit, but will not transmit the check digit with
the scanned data.
186
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
When Check Digit is set to Validate and Transmit, the scanner only reads NEC 2 of
5 bar codes printed with a check digit, and will transmit this digit at the end of the
scanned data. Default = No Check Digit.
* No Check Digit
Validate, but Don’t Transmit
Validate and Transmit
NEC 2 of 5 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Code 93
< Default All Code 93 Settings >
Code 93 On/Off
* On
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
187
Off
Code 93 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 0-80. Minimum Default = 0, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Code 93 Append
This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Code 93 bar
codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When this function
is enabled, the scanner stores those Code 93 bar codes that start with a space
(excluding the start and stop symbols), and does not immediately transmit the
data. The scanner stores the data in the order in which the bar codes are read,
deleting the first space from each. The scanner transmits the appended data when
it reads a Code 93 bar code that starts with a character other than a space.
Default = Off.
On
* Off
Code 93 Code Page
Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data
received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar
code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one
the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select
the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646
188
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code
from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should
then appear properly.
Code 93 Code Page
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial (three-bar start/stop)
<Default All Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Settings>
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial On/Off
On
* Off
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-48. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
189
Straight 2 of 5 IATA (two-bar start/stop)
<Default All Straight 2 of 5 IATA Settings>
Straight 2 of 5 IATA On/Off
On
* Off
Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy
If you are encountering errors when reading Straight 2 of 5 IATA bar codes, you may
want to adjust the redundancy count. Redundancy adjusts the number of times a
bar code is decoded before transmission, which may reduce the number of errors.
Note that the higher the redundancy count, the longer it will take to decode the bar
code. To adjust the redundancy, scan the Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy bar code
below, then scan a redundancy count between 0 and 10 on the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341. Then scan the Save bar code. Default = 0.
Straight 2 of 5 IATA
Redundancy
Straight 2 of 5 IATA Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-48. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
190
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Matrix 2 of 5
<Default All Matrix 2 of 5 Settings>
Matrix 2 of 5 On/Off
On
* Off
Matrix 2 of 5 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
191
Code 11
<Default All Code 11 Settings>
Code 11 On/Off
On
* Off
Check Digits Required
This option sets whether 1 or 2 check digits are required with Code 11 bar codes.
Default = Two Check Digits.
One Check Digit
* Two Check Digits
Code 11 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
192
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Code 128
<Default All Code 128 Settings>
Code 128 On/Off
* On
Off
If you are reading Code 128 bar codes, Codablock F should remain disabled. If you
are enabling Codablock F (see Codablock F on page 214), you should disable Code
128.
ISBT 128 Concatenation
In 1994 the International Society of Blood Transfusion (ISBT) ratified a standard
for communicating critical blood information in a uniform manner. The use of ISBT
formats requires a paid license. The ISBT 128 Application Specification describes
1) the critical data elements for labeling blood products, 2) the current recommendation to use Code 128 due to its high degree of security and its space-efficient
design, 3) a variation of Code 128 that supports concatenation of neighboring
symbols, and 4) the standard layout for bar codes on a blood product label. Use the
bar codes below to turn concatenation on or off. Default =Off.
On
* Off
Code 128 Redundancy
If you are encountering errors when reading Code 128 bar codes, you may want to
adjust the redundancy count. Redundancy adjusts the number of times a bar code
is decoded before transmission, which may reduce the number of errors. Note that
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
193
the higher the redundancy count, the longer it will take to decode the bar code. To
adjust the redundancy, scan the Code 128 Redundancy bar code below, then scan
a redundancy count between 0 and 10 on the Programming Chart, beginning on
page 341. Then scan the Save bar code. Default = 0.
Code 128 Redundancy
Code 128 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 0-80. Minimum Default = 0, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Code 128 Append
This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Code 128 bar
codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner
encounters a Code 128 bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers
Code 128 bar codes until it reads a Code 128 bar code that does not have the
append trigger. The data is then transmitted in the order in which the bar codes
were read (FIFO). Default = Off.
On
* Off
Code 128 Code Page
Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data
received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar
code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one
the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select
the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646
194
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code
from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should
then appear properly.
Code 128 Code Page
GS1-128
<Default All GS1-128 Settings>
GS1-128 On/Off
* On
Off
GS1-128 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-80. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
195
Telepen
<Default All Telepen Settings>
Telepen On/Off
On
* Off
Telepen Output
Using AIM Telepen Output, the scanner reads symbols with start/stop pattern 1
and decodes them as standard full ASCII (start/stop pattern 1). When Original
Telepen Output is selected, the scanner reads symbols with start/stop pattern 1
and decodes them as compressed numeric with optional full ASCII (start/stop pattern 2). Default = AIM Telepen Output.
* AIM Telepen Output
Original Telepen Output
Telepen Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-60. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 60.
Minimum Message Length
196
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Maximum Message Length
UPC-A
<Default All UPC-A Settings>
UPC-A On/Off
* On
Off
Note: To convert UPC-A bar codes to EAN-13, see Convert UPC-A to EAN-13 on page 204.
UPC-A Check Digit
This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted
at the end of the scanned data or not. Default = On.
* On
Off
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
197
UPC-A Number System
The numeric system digit of a U.P.C. symbol is normally transmitted at the beginning of the scanned data, but the unit can be programmed so it will not transmit it
(Off). Default = On.
* On
Off
UPC-A Addenda
This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned UPC-A data.
Default = Off for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda.
2 Digit Addenda On
* 2 Digit Addenda Off
5 Digit Addenda On
* 5 Digit Addenda Off
UPC-A Addenda Required
When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read UPC-A bar codes that have
addenda. You must then turn on a 2 or 5 digit addenda listed on page 198.
Default = Not Required.
Required
198
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
* Not Required
Addenda Timeout
You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is
not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded,
based on the setting you are using for UPC-A Addenda Required. Set the length (in
milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming Chart,
beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500.
Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches.
Addenda Timeout
UPC-A Addenda Separator
When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and
the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On.
* On
Off
UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code
Use the following codes to enable or disable UPC-A and EAN-13 with Extended
Coupon Code. When left on the default setting (Off), the scanner treats Coupon
Codes and Extended Coupon Codes as single bar codes.
If you scan the Allow Concatenation code, when the scanner sees the coupon
code and the extended coupon code in a single scan, it transmits both as one symbologies. Otherwise, it transmits the first coupon code it reads.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
199
If you scan the Require Concatenation code, the scanner must see and read the
coupon code and extended coupon code in a single read to transmit the data. No
data is output unless both codes are read. Default = Off.
* Off
Allow Concatenation
Require Concatenation
Addenda Timeout
You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is
not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded,
based on the setting you are using for UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended Coupon
Code. Set the length (in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code
below, then setting the timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from
the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default
= 500.
Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches.
Addenda Timeout
Coupon GS1 DataBar Output
If you scan coupons that have both UPC and GS1 DataBar codes, you may wish to
scan and output only the data from the GS1 DataBar code. Scan the GS1 Output
On code below to scan and output only the GS1 DataBar code data. Default = GS1
Output Off.
* GS1 Output Off
GS1 Output On
200
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
UPC-E0
<Default All UPC-E Settings>
UPC-E0 On/Off
Most U.P.C. bar codes lead with the 0 number system. To read these codes, use the
UPC-E0 On selection. If you need to read codes that lead with the 1 number system, use UPC-E1 (page 203). Default = On.
* UPC-E0 On
UPC-E0 Off
UPC-E0 Expand
UPC-E Expand expands the UPC-E code to the 12 digit, UPC-A format.
Default = Off.
On
* Off
UPC-E0 Addenda Required
When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read UPC-E bar codes that have
addenda. Default = Not Required.
Required
* Not Required
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
201
Addenda Timeout
You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is
not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded,
based on the setting you are using for UPC-E0 Addenda Required. Set the length
(in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the
timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500.
Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches.
Addenda Timeout
UPC-E0 Addenda Separator
When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and
the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On.
* On
Off
UPC-E0 Check Digit
Check Digit specifies whether the check digit should be transmitted at the end of
the scanned data or not. Default = On.
* On
Off
202
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
UPC-E0 Leading Zero
This feature allows the transmission of a leading zero (0) at the beginning of
scanned data. To prevent transmission, scan Off. Default = On.
* On
Off
UPC-E0 Addenda
This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned UPC-E data. Default = Off
for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda.
2 Digit Addenda On
* 2 Digit Addenda Off
5 Digit Addenda On
* 5 Digit Addenda Off
UPC-E1
Most U.P.C. bar codes lead with the 0 number system. For these codes, use UPC-E0
(page 201). If you need to read codes that lead with the 1 number system, use the
UPC-E1 On selection. Default = Off.
UPC-E1 On
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
203
* UPC-E1 Off
EAN/JAN-13
<Default All EAN/JAN Settings>
EAN/JAN-13 On/Off
* On
Off
Convert UPC-A to EAN-13
When UPC-A Converted to EAN-13 is selected, UPC-A bar codes are converted to
13 digit EAN-13 codes by adding a zero to the front. When Do not Convert UPC-A
is selected, UPC-A codes are read as UPC-A.
UPC-A Converted to EAN-13
* Do not Convert UPC-A
204
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
EAN/JAN-13 Check Digit
This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted
at the end of the scanned data or not. Default = On.
* On
Off
EAN/JAN-13 Addenda
This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned EAN/JAN-13 data.
Default = Off for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda.
2 Digit Addenda On
* 2 Digit Addenda Off
5 Digit Addenda On
* 5 Digit Addenda Off
EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Required
When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read EAN/JAN-13 bar codes that
have addenda. Default = Not Required.
Required
* Not Required
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
205
Addenda Timeout
You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is
not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded,
based on the setting you are using for UPC-E0 Addenda Required. Set the length
(in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the
timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500.
Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches.
Addenda Timeout
EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Separator
When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and
the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On.
* On
Off
Note: If you want to enable or disable EAN13 with Extended Coupon Code, refer to UPC-A/
EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code (page 199).
ISBN Translate
When On is scanned, EAN-13 Bookland symbols are translated into their equivalent ISBN number format. Default = Off.
On
* Off
206
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
EAN/JAN-8
<Default All EAN/JAN-8 Settings>
EAN/JAN-8 On/Off
* On
Off
EAN/JAN-8 Check Digit
This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted
at the end of the scanned data or not. Default = On.
* On
Off
EAN/JAN-8 Addenda
This selection adds 2 or 5 digits to the end of all scanned EAN/JAN-8 data.
Default = Off for both 2 Digit and 5 Digit Addenda.
2 Digit Addenda On
* 2 Digit Addenda Off
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
207
5 Digit Addenda On
* 5 Digit Addenda Off
EAN/JAN-8 Addenda Required
When Required is scanned, the scanner will only read EAN/JAN-8 bar codes that
have addenda. Default = Not Required.
Required
* Not Required
Addenda Timeout
You can set a time during which the scanner looks for an addenda. If an addenda is
not found within this time period, the data can be either transmitted or discarded,
based on the setting you are using for UPC-E0 Addenda Required. Set the length
(in milliseconds) for this timeout by scanning the bar code below, then setting the
timeout (from 0-120 milliseconds) by scanning digits from the Programming
Chart, beginning on page 341 of this manual, then Save. Default = 500.
Note: The Addenda Timeout setting is applied to all addenda and coupon code searches.
Addenda Timeout
EAN/JAN-8 Addenda Separator
When this feature is On, there is a space between the data from the bar code and
the data from the addenda. When turned Off, there is no space. Default = On.
* On
208
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Off
MSI
<Default All MSI Settings>
MSI On/Off
On
* Off
MSI Check Character
Different types of check characters are used with MSI bar codes. You can program
the scanner to read MSI bar codes with Type 10 check characters.
Default = Validate Type 10, but Don’t Transmit.
When Check Character is set to Validate Type 10/11 and Transmit, the scanner
will only read MSI bar codes printed with the specified type check character(s), and
will transmit the character(s) at the end of the scanned data.
When Check Character is set to Validate Type 10/11, but Don’t Transmit, the unit
will only read MSI bar codes printed with the specified type check character(s), but
will not transmit the check character(s) with the scanned data.
* Validate Type 10, but Don’t
Transmit
Validate Type 10 and Transmit
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
209
Validate 2 Type 10 Characters,
but Don’t Transmit
Validate 2 Type 10 Characters
and Transmit
Validate Type 11 then Type 10
Character, but Don’t Transmit
Validate Type 11 then
Type 10 Character and Transmit
Disable MSI Check Characters
MSI Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 4-48. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
210
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional
< Default All GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional Settings >
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional On/Off
* On
Off
GS1 DataBar Limited
< Default All GS1 DataBar Limited Settings >
GS1 DataBar Limited On/Off
* On
Off
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
211
GS1 DataBar Expanded
< Default All GS1 DataBar Expanded Settings >
GS1 DataBar Expanded On/Off
* On
Off
GS1 DataBar Expanded Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 4-74. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 74.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Trioptic Code
Note: If you are going to scan Code 32 Pharmaceutical codes (page 183), Trioptic Code
must be off.
Trioptic Code is used for labeling magnetic storage media.
On
* Off
212
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Codablock A
<Default All Codablock A Settings>
Codablock A On/Off
On
* Off
If you are reading Code 39 bar codes, Codablock A should remain disabled. If you
are enabling Codablock A, you should disable Code 39 (see Code 39 on page 181).
Codablock A Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-600. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 600.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
213
Codablock F
<Default All Codablock F Settings>
Codablock F On/Off
On
* Off
If you are reading Code 128 bar codes, Codablock F should remain disabled. If you
are enabling Codablock F, you should disable Code 128 (see Code 128 on page
193).
Codablock F Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-2048. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 2048.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Label Code
The standard Label Code is used in libraries. Default = Off.
On
214
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
*Off
PDF417
< Default All PDF417 Settings >
PDF417 On/Off
* On
Off
PDF417 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-2750. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 2750.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
215
MacroPDF417
MacroPDF417 is an implementation of PDF417 capable of encoding very large
amounts of data into multiple PDF417 bar codes. When this selection is enabled,
these multiple bar codes are assembled into a single data string. Default = On.
* On
Off
MicroPDF417
< Default All MicroPDF417 Settings >
MicroPDF417 On/Off
On
* Off
MicroPDF417 Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-366. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 366.
Minimum Message Length
216
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Maximum Message Length
GS1 Composite Codes
Linear codes are combined with a unique 2D composite component to form a new
class called GS1 Composite symbology. GS1 Composite symbologies allow for the
co-existence of symbologies already in use. Default = Off.
On
* Off
UPC/EAN Version
Scan the UPC/EAN Version On bar code to decode GS1 Composite symbols that
have a U.P.C. or an EAN linear component. (This does not affect GS1 Composite
symbols with a GS1-128 or GS1 linear component.) Default = UPC/EAN Version Off.
UPC/EAN Version On
* UPC/EAN Version Off
Note: If you scan coupons that have both UPC and GS1 DataBar codes, you may wish to
scan and output only the data from the GS1 DataBar code. See Coupon GS1 DataBar
Output (page 200) for further information.
GS1 Composite Code Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-2435. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 2435.
Minimum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
217
Maximum Message Length
GS1 Emulation
The scanner can automatically format the output from any GS1 data carrier to
emulate what would be encoded in an equivalent GS1-128 or GS1 DataBar symbol.
GS1 data carriers include UPC-A and UPC-E, EAN-13 and EAN-8, ITF-14, GS1128, and GS1-128 DataBar and GS1 Composites. (Any application that accepts
GS1 data can be simplified since it only needs to recognize one data carrier type.)
If GS1-128 Emulation is scanned, all retail codes (U.P.C., UPC-E, EAN8, EAN13)
are expanded out to 16 digits. If the AIM ID is enabled, the value will be the GS1128 AIM ID, ]C1 (see Symbology Charts on page 327).
If GS1 DataBar Emulation is scanned, all retail codes (U.P.C., UPC-E, EAN8,
EAN13) are expanded out to 16 digits. If the AIM ID is enabled, the value will be the
GS1-DataBar AIM ID, ]em (see Symbology Charts on page 327).
If GS1 Code Expansion Off is scanned, retail code expansion is disabled, and UPCE expansion is controlled by the UPC-E0 Expand (page 201) setting. If the AIM ID
is enabled, the value will be the GS1-128 AIM ID, ]C1 (see Symbology Charts on
page 327).
If EAN8 to EAN13 Conversion is scanned, all EAN8 bar codes are converted to
EAN13 format.
Default = GS1 Emulation Off.
GS1-128 Emulation
GS1 DataBar Emulation
GS1 Code Expansion Off
EAN8 to EAN13 Conversion
* GS1 Emulation Off
218
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39)
This code is a composite code since it has a Code 39 linear component and a
MicroPDF417 stacked code component. All bar code readers are capable of reading the Code 39 linear component. The MicroPDF417 component can only be
decoded if TLC39 On is selected. The linear component may be decoded as Code
39 even if TLC39 is off. Default = Off.
On
* Off
QR Code
< Default All QR Code Settings >
QR Code On/Off
This selection applies to both QR Code and Micro QR Code.
* On
Off
QR Code Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-7089. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 7089.
Minimum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
219
Maximum Message Length
QR Code Append
This function allows the scanner to append the data from several QR Code bar
codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner
encounters an QR Code bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers
the number of QR Code bar codes determined by information encoded in those bar
codes. Once the proper number of codes is reached, the data is output in the order
specified in the bar codes. Default = On.
* On
Off
QR Code Page
QR Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data
received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar
code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one
the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select
the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646
Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code
from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should then appear properly.
QR Code Page
220
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Data Matrix
< Default All Data Matrix Settings >
Data Matrix On/Off
* On
Off
Data Matrix Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-3116. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 3116.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Data Matrix Append
This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Data Matrix bar
codes together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner
encounters an Data Matrix bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers
the number of Data Matrix bar codes determined by information encoded in those
bar codes. Once the proper number of codes is reached, the data is output in the
order specified in the bar codes. Default = On.
* On
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
221
Off
Data Matrix Code Page
Data Matrix Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the
data received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the
bar code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the
one the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below,
select the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646
Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code
from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should
then appear properly.
Data Matrix Code Page
MaxiCode
< Default All MaxiCode Settings >
MaxiCode On/Off
On
* Off
222
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
MaxiCode Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-150. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 150.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Aztec Code
< Default All Aztec Code Settings >
Aztec Code On/Off
* On
Off
Aztec Code Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-3832. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 3832.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
223
Aztec Append
This function allows the scanner to append the data from several Aztec bar codes
together before transmitting them to the host computer. When the scanner
encounters an Aztec bar code with the append trigger character(s), it buffers the
number of Aztec bar codes determined by information encoded in those bar codes.
Once the proper number of codes is reached, the data is output in the order specified in the bar codes. Default = On.
* On
Off
Aztec Code Page
Aztec Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data
received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar
code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one
the host program is expecting. If this is the case, scan the bar code below, select
the code page with which the bar codes were created (see ISO 2022/ISO 646
Character Replacements on page 334), and scan the value and the Save bar code
from the Programming Chart, beginning on page 341. The data characters should
then appear properly.
Aztec Code Page
Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code
< Default All Han Xin Settings >
Han Xin Code On/Off
On
224
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
* Off
Han Xin Code Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 1-7833. Minimum Default = 1, Maximum Default = 7833.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Postal Codes - 2D
The following lists the possible 2D postal codes, and 2D postal code combinations
that are allowed. Only one 2D postal code selection can be active at a time. If you
scan a second 2D postal code selection, the first selection is overwritten.
Default = 2D Postal Codes Off.
* 2D Postal Codes Off
Single 2D Postal Codes:
Australian Post On
British Post On
Canadian Post On
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
225
Intelligent Mail Bar Code On
Japanese Post On
KIX Post On
Planet Code On
Also see Planet Code Check
Digit, page 229.
Postal-4i On
Postnet On
Also see Postnet Check
Digit, page 229.
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
InfoMail On
Combination 2D Postal Codes:
InfoMail and British
Post On
226
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Intelligent Mail Bar Code and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
Postnet and
Postal-4i On
Postnet and
Intelligent Mail Bar Code On
Postal-4i and
Intelligent Mail Bar Code On
Postal-4i and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
Planet Code and
Postnet On
Planet Code and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
Planet Code and
Postal-4i On
Planet Code and
Intelligent Mail Bar Code
Planet Code,
Postnet, and
Postal-4i On
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
227
Planet Code,
Postnet, and
Intelligent Mail Bar Code On
Planet Code,
Postal-4i, and
Intelligent Mail Bar Code On
Postnet,
Postal-4i, and
Intelligent Mail Bar Code On
Planet Code,
Postal-4i, and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
Planet Code,
Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
Postal-4i,
Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
Planet Code,
Postal-4i,
Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and
Postnet On
Planet Code,
Postal-4i,
Intelligent Mail Bar Code, and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
228
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Planet Code Check Digit
This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted
at the end of Planet Code data. Default = Don’t Transmit.
Transmit Check Digit
* Don’t Transmit Check Digit
Postnet Check Digit
This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted
at the end of Postnet data. Default = Don’t Transmit.
Transmit Check Digit
* Don’t Transmit Check Digit
Australian Post Interpretation
This option controls what interpretation is applied to customer fields in Australian
4-State symbols.
Bar Output lists the bar patterns in “0123” format.
Numeric N Table causes that field to be interpreted as numeric data using the N
Table.
Alphanumeric C Table causes the field to be interpreted as alphanumeric data
using the C Table. Refer to the Australian Post Specification Tables.
Combination C and N Tables causes the field to be interpreted using either the C
or N Tables.
* Bar Output
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
229
Numeric N Table
Alphanumeric C Table
Combination C and N Tables
Postal Codes - Linear
The following lists linear postal codes. Any combination of linear postal code selections can be active at a time.
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5)
<Default All China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) Settings>
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) On/Off
On
* Off
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5) Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 80.
Minimum Message Length
230
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Maximum Message Length
Korea Post
<Default All Korea Post Settings>
Korea Post
On
* Off
Korea Post Message Length
Scan the bar codes below to change the message length. Refer to Message Length
Description (page 178) for additional information. Minimum and Maximum
lengths = 2-80. Minimum Default = 4, Maximum Default = 48.
Minimum Message Length
Maximum Message Length
Korea Post Check Digit
This selection allows you to specify whether the check digit should be transmitted
or not. Default = Don’t Transmit.
Transmit Check Digit
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
231
* Don’t Transmit Check Digit
232
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
10
IMAGING COMMANDS
The scanner is like a digital camera in the way it captures, manipulates, and transfers images. The following commands allow you to alter the way the scanner performs these functions.
Note: If you are using the scanner in a stand, you must set the In-Stand Sensor Mode to Off
in order to take images (see In-Stand Sensor Mode on page 122).
Single-Use Basis
Imaging Commands with their modifiers send instructions to the scanner on a single-use basis, and take effect for a single image capture. Once that capture is complete, the scanner reverts to its imaging default settings. If you want to
permanently change a setting, you must use the serial default commands (see
Chapter 12). When the serial default command is used, that selection becomes the
new, permanent setting for the scanner.
Command Syntax
Multiple modifiers and commands can be issued within one sequence. If additional
modifiers are to be applied to the same command, just add the modifiers to that
command. For example, to add 2 modifiers to the Image Snap command, such as
setting the Imaging Style to 1P and the Wait for Trigger to 1T, you would enter
IMGSNP1P1T.
Note: After processing an image capture command (IMGSNP or IMGBOX), you must follow
it with an IMGSHP command if you want to see it on your terminal.
To add a command to a sequence, each new command is separated with a semicolon. For example, to add the Image Ship command to the above sequence, you
would enter IMGSNP1P1T;IMGSHP.
The imaging commands are:
Image Snap - IMGSNP (page 234)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
233
Image Ship - IMGSHP (page 237)
Intelligent Signature Capture - IMGBOX (page 247)
The modifiers for each of these commands follow the command description.
Note: The images included with each command description are examples only. The results
you achieve may be different from those included in this manual. The quality of the
output you receive will vary depending on lighting, quality of the initial image/object
being captured, and distance of the scanner from the image/object. To achieve a high
quality image, it is recommended that you position your scanner 4-6" (10.2-15.2 cm)
away from the image/object you are capturing.
Step 1 - Take a Picture Using IMGSNP
Image Snap - IMGSNP
An image is taken whenever the hardware trigger is pressed, or when the Image
Snap (IMGSNP) command is processed.
The image snap command has many different modifiers that can be used to
change the look of the image in memory. Any number of modifiers may be
appended to the IMGSNP command.
Example: You can use the following command to snap an image, increase the gain, and have
the beeper sound once the snap is complete: IMGSNP2G1B
IMGSNP Modifiers
P - Imaging Style
This sets the Image Snap style.
234
0P
Decoding Style. This processing allows a few frames to be taken until the
exposure parameters are met. The last frame is then available for further
use.
1P
Photo Style (default). This mimics a simple digital camera, and results in
a visually optimized image.
2P
Manual Style. This is an advanced style that should only be used by an
experienced user. It allows you the most freedom to set up the scanner,
and has no auto-exposure.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
B - Beeper
Causes a beep to sound after an image is snapped.
0B
No beep (default)
1B
Sounds a beep when the image is captured.
T - Wait for Trigger
Waits for a hardware trigger press before taking the image. This is only available
when using Photo Style (1P).
0T
Takes image immediately (default)
1T
Waits for a trigger press, then takes the image
L - LED State
Determines if the LEDs should be on or off, and when. Ambient illumination (0L) is
preferred for taking pictures of color documents, such as ID cards, especially when
the scanner is in a stand. LED illumination (1L) is preferred when the scanner is
handheld. LED State is not available when using Decoding Style (0P).
0L
LEDs off (default)
1L
LEDs on
E - Exposure
Exposure is used in Manual Style only (2P), and allows you to set the exposure
time. This is similar to setting a shutter speed on a camera. The exposure time
determines how long the scanner takes to record an image. On a bright day, exposure times can be very short because plenty of light is available to help record an
image. At nighttime, exposure time can increase dramatically due to the near
absence of light. Units are 127 microseconds. (Default = 7874)
nE
Example:
Range: 1 - 7874
Exposure at 7874E with
fluorescent lighting:
Exposure at 100E with
fluorescent lighting:
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
235
G - Gain
Gain is used in Manual Style only (2P). Like a volume control, the gain modifier
boosts the signal and multiplies the pixel value. As you increase the gain, the noise
in an image is also amplified.
Example:
1G
No gain (default)
2G
Medium gain
4G
Heavy gain
8G
Maximum gain
Gain at 1G:
Gain at 4G:
Gain at 8G:
W - Target White Value
Sets the target for the median grayscale value in the captured image. For capturing
close-up images of high contrast documents, a lower setting, such as 75, is recommended. Higher settings result in longer exposure times and brighter images, but
if the setting is too high, the image may be overexposed. Target White Value is only
available when using Photo Style (1P). (Default = 125)
nW
Example:
Range: 0 - 255
White Value at 75W:
White Value at 125W:
White Value at 200W:
D - Delta for Acceptance
This sets the allowable range for the white value setting (see W - Target White
Value). Delta is only available when using Photo Style (1P). (Default = 25)
nD
236
Range: 0 - 255
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
U - Update Tries
This sets the maximum number of frames the scanner should take to reach the D Delta for Acceptance. Update Tries is only available when using Photo Style (1P).
(Default = 6)
nU
Range: 0 - 10
% - Target Set Point Percentage
Sets the target point for the light and dark values in the captured image. A setting
of 75% means 75% of the pixels are at or below the target white value, and 25% of
the pixels are above the target white value. Altering this setting from the default is
not recommended under normal circumstances. To alter grayscale values, W Target White Value should be used. (Default = 50)
n%
Example:
Range: 1 - 99
Target Set Point
Percentage at 97%:
Target Set Point
Percentage at 50%:
Target Set Point
Percentage at 40%:
Step 2 - Ship a Picture Using IMGSHP
Image Ship - IMGSHP
An image is taken whenever the trigger is pressed or when the Image Snap
(IMGSNP) command is processed. The last image is always stored in memory. You
can “ship” the image by using the IMGSHP command.
The image ship commands have many different modifiers that can be used to
change the look of the image output. Modifiers affect the image that is transmitted, but do not affect the image in memory. Any number of modifiers may be
appended to the IMGSHP command.
Example: You can use the following command to snap and ship a bitmap image with gamma
correction and document image filtering: IMGSNP;IMGSHP8F75K26U
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
237
IMGSHP Modifiers
A - Infinity Filter
Enhances pictures taken from very long distances (greater than 10 feet or 3m). The
Infinity Filter should not be used with IMGSNP Modifiers (page 234).
Example:
0A
Infinity filter off (default)
1A
Infinity filter on
Infinity Filter off (0A)
from approximately 12 feet
(3.66m) away:
nfinity Filter on (1A)
from approximately 12 feet (3.66m)
away:
C - Compensation
Flattens the image to account for variations in illumination across the image.
Example:
0C
Compensation disabled (default)
1C
Compensation enabled
Compensation at 0C:
Compensation at 1C:
D - Pixel Depth
Indicates the number of bits per pixel in the transmitted image (KIM or BMP format
only).
238
8D
8 bits per pixel, grayscale image (default)
1D
1 bit per pixel, black and white image
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
E - Edge Sharpen
An edge sharpen filter cleans up the edges of an image, making it look cleaner and
sharper. While edge sharpening does make the image look cleaner, it also removes
some fine detail from the original image. The strength of the edge sharpen filter
can be entered from 1 to 24. Entering a 23E gives the sharpest edges, but also
increases noise in the image.
Example:
0E
Don’t sharpen image (default)
14E
Apply edge sharpen for typical image
ne
Apply edge sharpen using strength n (n = 1-24)
Edge Sharpen at 0E:
Edge Sharpen at 24E:
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
239
F - File Format
Indicates the desired format for the image.
0F
KIM format
1F
TIFF binary
2F
TIFF binary group 4, compressed
3F
TIFF grayscale
4F
Uncompressed binary (upper left to lower right, 1 pixel/bit, 0 padded end
of line)
5F
Uncompressed grayscale (upper left to lower right, bitmap format)
6F
JPEG image (default)
8F
BMP format (lower right to upper left, uncompressed)
10F
TIFF color compressed image
11F
TIFF color uncompressed image
12F
JPEG color image
14F
BMP color format
15F
BMP Uncompressed raw image
H - Histogram Stretch
Increases the contrast of the transmitted image. Not available with some image
formats.
Example:
240
0H
No stretch (default)
1H
Histogram stretch
Histogram Stretch at 0H:
Histogram Stretch at 1H:
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
I - Invert Image
Invert image is used to rotate the image around the X or Y axis.
Example:
1ix
Invert around the X axis (flips picture upside down)
1iy
Invert around the Y axis (flips picture left to right)
Image not inverted:
Image with Invert
Image set to 1ix:
Image with Invert
Image set to 1iy:
IF- Noise Reduction
Used to reduce the salt and pepper noise in an image.
Example:
0if
No salt and pepper noise reduction (default)
1if
Salt and pepper noise reduction
Noise Reduction Off (0if):
Noise Reduction On (1if):
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
241
IR - Image Rotate
Example:
0ir
Image as snapped (rightside up) (default)
1ir
Rotate image 90 degrees to the right
2ir
Rotate image 180 degrees (upside down)
3ir
Rotate image 90 degrees to the left
Image Rotate set to 0ir:
Image Rotate set to 1ir:
Image Rotate set to 2ir:
Image Rotate set to 3ir:
J - JPEG Image Quality
Sets the desired quality when the JPEG image format is selected. Higher numbers
result in higher quality, but larger files. Smaller numbers result in greater amounts
of lossy compression, faster transmission times, lower quality, but smaller files.
(Default = 50)
nJ
Image is compressed as much as possible while preserving quality factor
of n (n = 0 - 100)
0J
worst quality (smallest file)
100J best quality (largest file)
242
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
K - Gamma Correction
Gamma measures the brightness of midtone values produced by the image. You
can brighten or darken an image using gamma correction. A higher gamma correction yields an overall brighter image. The lower the setting, the darker the image.
The optimal setting for text images is 50K.
Example:
0K
Gamma correction off (default)
50K
Apply gamma correction for brightening typical document image
nK
Apply gamma correction factor n (n = 0-1,000)
Gamma Correction set
to 0K:
Gamma Correction set
to 50K:
Gamma Correction set
to 255K:
L, R, T, B, M - Image Cropping
Ships a window of the image by specifying the left, right, top, and bottom pixel
coordinates. Device columns are numbered 0 through 1279, and device rows are
numbered 0 through 959.
nL
The left edge of the shipped image corresponds to column n of the image
in memory. Range: 000 - 843. (Default = 0)
nR
The right edge of the shipped image corresponds to column n - 1 of the
image in memory. Range: 000 - 843. (Default = all columns)
nT
The top edge of the shipped image corresponds to row n of the image in
memory. Range: 000 - 639. (Default = 0)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
243
nB
Example:
The bottom edge of the shipped image corresponds to row n - 1 of the
image in memory. Range: 000 - 639. (Default = all rows)
Uncropped Image:
Image Crop set to
300R:
Image Crop set to 200B:
Image Crop set to
300L:
Image Crop set to 200T:
Alternately, specify the number of pixels to cut from the outside margin of the
image; thus only the center pixels are transmitted.
nM
Example:
Margin: cut n columns from the left, n + 1 columns from the right, n rows
from the top, and n + 1 rows from the bottom of the image. Ship the
remaining center pixels. Range: 0 - 238.
(Default = 0, or full image)
Image Crop set to 238M:
P - Protocol
Used for shipping an image. Protocol covers two features of the image data being
sent to the host. It addresses the protocol used to send the data (Hmodem, which is
an Xmodem 1K variant that has additional header information), and the format of
the image data that is sent.
0P
None (raw data)
2P
None (default for USB)
3P
Hmodem compressed (default for RS232)
4P
Hmodem
S - Pixel Ship
Pixel Ship sizes an image in proportion to its original size. It decimates the image
by shipping only certain, regularly spaced pixels.
Example: 4S would transmit every fourth pixel from every fourth line.
244
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
The smaller number of pixels shipped, the smaller the image, however, after a certain point the image becomes unusable.
Example:
1S
ship every pixel (default)
2S
ship every 2nd pixel, both horizontally and vertically
3S
ship every 3rd pixel, both horizontally and vertically
Pixel Ship set to 1S:
Pixel Ship
set to 2S:
Pixel Ship
set to 3S:
Pixel Ship
set to 4S:
U - Document Image Filter
Allows you to input parameters to sharpen the edges and smooth the area between
the edges of text in an image. This filter should be used with gamma correction
(see page 243), with the scanner in a stand, and the image captured using the
command:
IMGSNP1P0L168W90%32D
This filter typically provides better JPEG compression than the standard E - Edge
Sharpen command (see page 246). This filter also works well when shipping pure
black and white images (1 bit per pixel). The optimal setting is 26U.
Example:
0U
Document image filter off (default)
26U
Apply document image filter for typical document image
nU
Apply document image filter using grayscale threshold n. Use lower
numbers when the image contrast is lower. 1U will have a similar effect to
setting E - Edge Sharpen (page 239) to 22e. Range: 0-255.
Document Image Filter set to 0U:
Document Image Filter set to 26U:
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
245
V - Blur Image
Smooths transitions by averaging the pixels next to the hard edges of defined lines
and shaded areas in an image.
Example:
0V
Don’t blur (default)
1V
Blur
Blur Image Off (0V):
Blur Image On (1V):
W - Histogram Ship
A histogram gives a quick picture of the tonal range of an image, or key type. A lowkey image has detail concentrated in the shadows; a high-key image has detail
concentrated in the highlights; and an average-key image has detail concentrated
in the midtones. This modifier ships the histogram for an image.
Example:
0W
Don’t ship histogram (default)
1W
Ship histogram
Image used for histogram:
Histogram of image:
Image Size Compatibility
If you have applications that expect an image ship to return exactly 640x480 pixels, scan the Force VGA Resolution bar code. Default = Native Resolution.
Force VGA Resolution
246
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
* Native Resolution
Intelligent Signature Capture - IMGBOX
IMGBOX allows you to configure the size and location of a signature capture area
relative to its proximity to a bar code. This allows you to tailor a signature capture
area to a specific form. In order to use IMGBOX, you need a set form where the signature box location is in a known location relative to a bar code. You can input the
overall size of the signature area, as well as specify how far the signature area is
from the bar code, vertically and horizontally. You can also set the resolution and
file format for the final output of the signature capture image.
Note: IMGBOX commands can only be triggered by one of the following types of bar codes:
PDF417, Code 39, Code 128, Aztec, Codabar, and Interleaved 2 of 5. Once one of
these symbologies has been read, the image is retained for a possible IMGBOX
command.
Signature Capture Optimize
If you will be using your scanner to capture signatures frequently, you should optimize it for this purpose. However, the speed of scanning bar codes may be slowed
when this mode is enabled. Default = Off.
Optimize On
* Optimize Off
Below is an example of a signature capture application. In this example, the aimer
is centered over the signature capture area and the trigger is pressed. A single beep
is emitted, indicating that the scanner has read a Code 128 bar code and the data
has been transferred to the host. If using a Granit scanner, the scanner also
vibrates. An IMGBOX command may now be sent from the host to specify the coordinates of the signature capture area below that code, and indicating that only that
area containing the signature should be transferred as an image to the host.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
247
To see this example, align the aimer with the signature area (not with the bar code),
then press the trigger.
Send the following IMGBOX command string after the trigger press:
Example: IMGBOX245w37h55y.
Note: Case is not important in the command string. It is used here only for clarity.
The following image is captured:
The IMGBOX commands have many different modifiers that can be used to change
the size and appearance of the signature image output by the scanner. Modifiers
affect the image that is transmitted, but do not affect the image in memory. Any
number of modifiers may be appended to the IMGBOX command.
Note: The IMGBOX command will return a NAK unless a window size (width and height) are
specified. See H - Height of Signature Capture Area (page 250) and W - Width of
Signature Capture Area (page 251).
IMGBOX Modifiers
A - Output Image Width
This option is used to size the image horizontally. If using this option, set the resolution (R) to zero.
Example:
Image Width set to 200A:
Image Width set to 600A:
248
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
B - Output Image Height
This option is used to size the image vertically. If using this option, set the resolution (R) to zero.
Example:
Image Height set to 50B:
Image Height set to 100B:
D - Pixel Depth
This indicates the number of bits per pixel in the transmitted image, which defines
whether it will be grayscale or black and white.
8D
8 bits per pixel, grayscale image (default)
1D
1 bit per pixel, black and white image
F - File Format
This option indicates the type of file format in which to save the image.
0F
KIM format
1F
TIFF binary
2F
TIFF binary group 4, compressed
3F
TIFF grayscale
4F
Uncompressed Binary
5F
Uncompressed grayscale
6F
JPEG image (default)
7F
Outlined image
8F
BMP format
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
249
H - Height of Signature Capture Area
The height of the signature capture area must be measured in inches divided by
.01. In the example, the height of the area to be captured is 3/8 inch, resulting in a
value of H = .375/0.01 = 37.5.
Example: IMGBOX245w37h55y.
K - Gamma Correction
Gamma measures the brightness of midtone values produced by the image. You
can brighten or darken an image using gamma correction. A higher gamma correction yields an overall brighter image. The lower the setting, the darker the image.
The optimal setting for text images is 50K.
Example:
0K
Gamma correction off (default)
50K
Apply gamma correction for brightening typical document image
nK
Apply gamma correction factor n (n = 1-255)
Gamma Correction set to 0K:
Gamma Correction set to 50K:
Gamma Correction set to 255K:
R - Resolution of Signature Capture Area
The resolution is the number of pixels that the scanner outputs per each minimum
bar width. The higher the value for R, the higher the quality of the image, but also
the larger the file size. Values begin at 1000. The scanner automatically inserts a
250
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
decimal point between the first and second digit. For example, use 2500 to specify
a resolution of 2.5. Set to zero when using the A and B modifiers (see A - Output
Image Width and B - Output Image Height on page 249).
Example:
Resolution set to 0R:
Resolution set to 1000R:
Resolution set to 2000R:
S - Bar Code Aspect Ratio
All dimensions used in IMGBOX are measured as multiples of the minimum element size of the bar code. The bar code aspect ratio allows you to set the ratio of
the bar code height to the narrow element width. In the example, the narrow element width is .010 inches and the bar code height is 0.400 inches, resulting in a
value of S = 0.4/0.01 = 40.
W - Width of Signature Capture Area
The width of the signature capture area must be measured in inches divided by .01.
In the example, the width of the area to be captured is 2.4 inches, resulting in a
value of W = 2.4/0.01 = 240. (A value of 245 was used in the example to accommodate a slightly wider image area.)
Example: IMGBOX245w37h55y.
X - Horizontal Bar Code Offset
The horizontal bar code offset allows you to offset the horizontal center of the signature capture area. Positive values move the horizontal center to the right and
negative values to the left. Measurements are in multiples of the minimum bar
width.
Example:
Horizontal Offset set to 75X:
Horizontal Offset set to -75X:
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
251
Y - Vertical Bar Code Offset
The vertical bar code offset allows you to offset the vertical center of the signature
capture area. Negative numbers indicate that the signature capture is above the
bar code, and positive numbers indicate that the area is below the bar code. Measurements are in multiples of the minimum bar width
Example:
.
Vertical Offset set to -7Y:
Vertical Offset set to 65Y:
RF Default Imaging Device
The scanner supports imaging command processing (IMGSHP, IMGSNP, IMGBOX)
so that EZConfig-Scanning (see page 255) and other applications are able to perform imaging functions as if they were communicating directly with a scanner. To
accomplish this, the scanner uses a menu command called RF_DID (RF Default
Imaging Device). RF_DID is the name of the scanner (BT_NAM) that is to receive
imaging commands. The default for RF_DID is “*”indicating that imaging commands are to be sent to all associated scanners. Change this setting to RF_DIDscanner_name to ensure that they are sent to a particular scanner. Refer to
"Page" on page 3-51 to generate a report containing the port, work group, scanner
name, and address for each scanner. Refer to "Scanner Name" on page 3-65 set a
unique name for each scanner.
252
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
11
UTILITIES
To Add a Test Code I.D. Prefix to All Symbologies
This selection allows you to turn on transmission of a Code I.D. before the decoded
symbology. (See the Symbology Charts, beginning on page 327) for the single
character code that identifies each symbology.) This action first clears all current
prefixes, then programs a Code I.D. prefix for all symbologies. This is a temporary
setting that will be removed when the unit is power cycled.
Add Code I.D. Prefix to
All Symbologies (Temporary)
Show Decoder Revision
Scan the bar code below to output the decoder revision.
Show Decoder Revision
Show Scan Driver Revision
Scan the bar code below to output the scan driver revision. The scan driver controls
image capture.
Show Scan Driver Revision
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
253
Show Software Revision
Scan the bar code below to output the current software revision, unit serial number,
and other product information for both the scanner and base.
Show Software Revision
Show Data Format
Scan the bar code below to show current data format settings.
DFMBK3?.
Data Format Settings
Test Menu
When you scan the Test Menu On code, then scan a programming code in this
manual, the scanner displays the content of a programming code. The programming function will still occur, but in addition, the content of that programming
code is output to the terminal.
Note: This feature should not be used during normal scanner operation.
On
* Off
TotalFreedom
TotalFreedom is an open system architecture that makes it possible for you create
applications that reside on your scanner. Decoding apps and Data Formatting
apps can be created using TotalFreedom. For further information about TotalFreedom, go to our website at www.honeywellaidc.com.
254
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Application Plug-Ins (Apps)
Any apps that you are using can be turned off or on by scanning the following bar
codes. Apps are stored in groups: Decoding, and Formatting. You can enable and
disable these groups of apps by scanning that group’s On or Off bar code below.
You can also scan the List Apps bar code to output a list of all your apps.
* Decoding Apps On
Decoding Apps Off
* Formatting Apps On
Formatting Apps Off
List Apps
Note: You must reset your device in order for the apps setting to take effect.
EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Introduction
EZConfig Cloud for Scanning provides a wide range of PC-based programming
functions that can be performed on a scanner connected to your PC. EZConfig
Cloud for Scanning allows you to download upgrades to the scanner's firmware,
change programmed parameters, and create and print programming bar codes.
Using EZConfig Cloud for Scanning, you can even save/open the programming
parameters for a scanner. This saved file can be e-mailed or, if required, you can
create a single bar code that contains all the customized programming parameters
and mail or fax that bar code to any location. Users in other locations can scan the
bar code to load in the customized programming.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
255
EZConfig Cloud for Scanning Operations
The EZConfig Cloud for Scanning software performs the following operations:
Scan Data
Scan Data allows you to scan bar codes and display the bar code data in a window.
Scan Data lets you send serial commands to the scanner and receive scanner
response that can be seen in the Scan Data window. The data displayed in the Scan
Data window can either be saved in a file or printed.
Configure
Configure displays the programming and configuration data of the scanner. The
scanner's programming and configuration data is grouped into different categories. Each category is displayed as a tree item under the "Configure" tree node in
the application explorer. When one of these tree nodes is clicked, the right-hand
side is loaded with the parameters' form belonging to that particular category. The
"Configure" tree option has all the programming and configuration parameters
specified for a scanner. You can set or modify these parameters as required. You
can later write the modified settings to the scanner, or save them to a dcf file.
Imaging
Imaging provides all the image-related functions that a 2D Scanner can perform.
You can capture an image using the current settings, and the image will be displayed in an image window. Images captured from the scanner can be saved to
files in different image formats. You can modify the image settings and save the
image settings to an INI file, which can be loaded later to capture new images.
Imaging also lets you preview the images continuously captured by the scanner.
Install EZConfig Cloud for Scanning
Use the EZConfig Cloud for Scanning tool to configure your scanner online:
1. Access the Honeywell web site at www.honeywellaidc.com
2. Click on the Browse Products tab. Under Software, select Device
Management.
3. Click on EZConfig Cloud for Scanning.
4. Scroll to the bottom of the page and click on Register for free access now to
sign up.
256
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Reset the Factory Defaults
Caution: This selection erases all your settings and resets the scanner to the
original factory defaults. It also disables all plugins.
If you aren’t sure what programming options are in your scanner, or you’ve
changed some options and want to restore the scanner to factory default settings,
first scan the Remove Custom Defaults bar code, then scan Activate Defaults.
This resets the scanner to the factory default settings.
Remove Custom Defaults
Activate Defaults
Note: If using a cordless system, scanning the Activate Defaults bar code also causes both
the scanner and the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked.
The scanner must be placed in its base to re-establish the link before any setup codes
are entered. If using an Access Point, the linking bar code must be scanned. See
Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i beginning
on page 41,or Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF beginning on page 79
for additional information.
The Menu Commands, beginning on page 264, list the factory default settings for
each of the commands (indicated by an asterisk (*) on the programming pages).
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
257
258
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
12
SERIAL PROGRAMMING
COMMANDS
The serial programming commands can be used in place of the programming bar
codes. Both the serial commands and the programming bar codes will program the
scanner. For complete descriptions and examples of each serial programming
command, refer to the corresponding programming bar code in this manual.
The device must be set to an RS232 interface (see page 16). The following commands can be sent via a PC COM port using terminal emulation software.
Conventions
The following conventions are used for menu and query command descriptions:
parameter
A label representing the actual value you should send as part of a
command.
[option]
An optional part of a command.
{Data}
Alternatives in a command.
bold
Names of menus, menu commands, buttons, dialog boxes, and windows that appear on the screen.
Menu Command Syntax
Menu commands have the following syntax (spaces have been used for clarity
only):
Prefix [:Name:] Tag SubTag {Data} [, SubTag {Data}] [; Tag SubTag {Data}] […] Storage
Prefix
Three ASCII characters: SYN M CR (ASCII 22,77,13).
:Name:
This command is only used with cordless devices. It is used to specify whether you’re communicating with the base or the scanner. To
send information to the scanner (with the base connected to host),
use :Xenon: The default factory setting for a Xenon scanner is Xenon
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
259
scanner. This setting is changed by using the BT_NAM command,
which accepts alphanumeric values. If the name is not known, a
wildcard (*) can be used :*
Note: Since the base stores all work group settings and transfers to them to scanner once
they are linked, changes are typically done to the base and not to the scanner.
Tag
A 3 character case-insensitive field that identifies the desired menu
command group. For example, all RS232 configuration settings are
identified with a Tag of 232.
SubTag
A 3 character case-insensitive field that identifies the desired menu
command within the tag group. For example, the SubTag for the
RS232 baud rate is BAD.
Data
The new value for a menu setting, identified by the Tag and SubTag.
Storage
A single character that specifies the storage table to which the command is applied. An exclamation point (!) performs the command’s
operation on the device’s volatile menu configuration table. A period
(.) performs the command’s operation on the device’s non-volatile
menu configuration table. Use the non-volatile table only for semipermanent changes you want saved through a power cycle.
Query Commands
Several special characters can be used to query the device about its settings.
^
What is the default value for the setting(s).
?
What is the device’s current value for the setting(s).
*
What is the range of possible values for the setting(s). (The device’s
response uses a dash (-) to indicate a continuous range of values. A
pipe (|) separates items in a list of non-continuous values.)
:Name: Field Usage (Optional)
This command returns the query information from the scanner.
Tag Field Usage
When a query is used in place of a Tag field, the query applies to the entire set of
commands available for the particular storage table indicated by the Storage field
of the command. In this case, the SubTag and Data fields should not be used
because they are ignored by the device.
260
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
SubTag Field Usage
When a query is used in place of a SubTag field, the query applies only to the subset of commands available that match the Tag field. In this case, the Data field
should not be used because it is ignored by the device.
Data Field Usage
When a query is used in place of the Data field, the query applies only to the specific command identified by the Tag and SubTag fields.
Concatenation of Multiple Commands
Multiple commands can be issued within one Prefix/Storage sequence. Only the
Tag, SubTag, and Data fields must be repeated for each command in the sequence.
If additional commands are to be applied to the same Tag, then the new command
sequence is separated with a comma (,) and only the SubTag and Data fields of the
additional command are issued. If the additional command requires a different Tag
field, the command is separated from previous commands by a semicolon (;).
Responses
The device responds to serial commands with one of three responses:
ACK
Indicates a good command which has been processed.
ENQ
Indicates an invalid Tag or SubTag command.
NAK
Indicates the command was good, but the Data field entry was out of
the allowable range for this Tag and SubTag combination, e.g., an
entry for a minimum message length of 100 when the field will only
accept 2 characters.
When responding, the device echoes back the command sequence with the status
character inserted directly before each of the punctuation marks (the period, exclamation point, comma, or semicolon) in the command.
Examples of Query Commands
In the following examples, a bracketed notation [ ] depicts a non-displayable
response.
Example: What is the range of possible values for Codabar Coding Enable?
Enter:
cbrena*.
Response:
CBRENA0-1[ACK]
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
261
This response indicates that Codabar Coding Enable (CBRENA) has a range of values from 0 to 1 (off and on).
Example: What is the default value for Codabar Coding Enable?
Enter:
cbrena^.
Response:
CBRENA1[ACK]
This response indicates that the default setting for Codabar Coding Enable
(CBRENA) is 1, or on.
Example: What is the device’s current setting for Codabar Coding Enable?
Enter:
cbrena?.
Response:
CBRENA1[ACK]
This response indicates that the device’s Codabar Coding Enable (CBRENA) is set
to 1, or on.
Example: What are the device’s settings for all Codabar selections?
Enter:
cbr?.
Response:
CBRENA1[ACK],
SSX0[ACK],
CK20[ACK],
CCT1[ACK],
MIN2[ACK],
MAX60[ACK],
DFT[ACK].
This response indicates that the device’s Codabar Coding Enable (CBRENA) is set
to 1, or on;
the Start/Stop Character (SSX) is set to 0, or Don’t Transmit;
the Check Character (CK2) is set to 0, or Not Required;
concatenation (CCT) is set to 1, or Enabled;
the Minimum Message Length (MIN) is set to 2 characters;
the Maximum Message Length (MAX) is set to 60 characters;
and the Default setting (DFT) has no value.
Trigger Commands
You can activate and deactivate the scanner with serial trigger commands. First,
the scanner must be put in Manual Trigger Mode by scanning a Manual Trigger
Mode bar code (page 117), or by sending a serial menu command for triggering
(page 119). Once the scanner is in serial trigger mode, the trigger is activated and
deactivated by sending the following commands:
262
Activate:
SYN T CR
Deactivate:
SYN U CR
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
The scanner scans until a bar code has been read, until the deactivate command is
sent, or until the serial time-out has been reached (see Read Time-Out on page
119 for a description, and the serial command on page 276).
Reset the Custom Defaults
If you want the custom default settings restored to your scanner, scan the Activate
Custom Defaults bar code below. This resets the scanner to the custom default
settings. If there are no custom defaults, it will reset the scanner to the factory
default settings. Any settings that have not been specified through the custom
defaults will be defaulted to the factory default settings.
Activate Custom Defaults
Note: If using a cordless system, scanning this bar code also causes both the scanner and
the base or Access Point to perform a reset and become unlinked. The scanner must
be placed in its base to re-establish the link. If using an Access Point, the linking bar
code must be scanned. See Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and
Granit 1911i/1981i beginning on page 41,or Cordless System Operation: Xenon
1902g-BF beginning on page 79 for additional information.
The charts on the following pages list the factory default settings for each of the
commands (indicated by an asterisk (*) on the programming pages).
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
263
Menu Commands
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Set Custom Defaults
MNUCDP
12
Save Custom Defaults
MNUCDS
12
Reset the Custom Defaults
Activate Custom Defaults
DEFALT
13
Reset the Factory Defaults cordless scanners
Factory Default Settings:
All Application Groups
PAPDFT&
68
Reset the Custom Defaults cordless scanners
Custom Default Settings:
All Application Groups
PAPDFT
69
Keyboard Wedge:
IBM PC AT and Compatibles with
CR suffix (not supported by Granit
1980i)
PAP_AT
15
Laptop Direct Connect with CR
suffix (not supported by Granit
1980i)
PAPLTD
16
RS232 Serial Port
PAP232
16
IBM Port 5B Interface
PAPP5B
16
IBM Port 9B HHBCR-1 Interface
PAP9B1
16
IBM Port 17 Interface
PAPP17
17
IBM Port 9B HHBCR-2 Interface
PAP9B2
17
RS485 Packet Mode On
RTLPDF1
17
RS485 Packet Mode Off
RTLPDF0
17
RS485 Packet Length (20-256)
RTLMPS
18
USB IBM SurePos Handheld
PAPSPH
18
USB IBM SurePos Tabletop
PAPSPT
18
USB Keyboard (PC)
PAP124
18
USB Keyboard (Mac)
PAP125
19
USB Japanese Keyboard (PC)
TRMUSB134
19
USB HID
PAP131
19
USB Serial
TRMUSB130
19
CTS/RTS Emulation On
USBCTS1
19
CTS/RTS Emulation Off*
USBCTS0
20
ACK/NAK Mode On
USBACK1
20
ACK/NAK Mode Off*
USBACK0
20
ReM Off
REMIFC0
20
ReM On
REMIFC1
20
Selection
Product Default Settings
Set Custom Defaults
Program the Interface
Plug and Play Codes
Plug and Play Codes:
RS485
Plug and Play Codes: IBM SurePos
Plug and Play Codes: USB
Remote MasterMind for USB
264
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Plug and Play Codes
Verifone Ruby Terminal
PAPRBY
20
Gilbarco Terminal
PAPGLB
21
Honeywell Bioptic Aux Port
PAPBIO
21
Datalogic Magellan Aux Port
PAPMAG
21
NCR Bioptic Aux Port
PAPNCR
22
Wincor Nixdorf Terminal
PAPWNX
22
Wincor Nixdorf Beetle
PAPBTL
22
Wincor Nixdorf RS232 Mode A
(not supported by all Granit
models)
PAPWMA
23
*U.S.A.
KBDCTY0
23
Albania
KBDCTY35
23
Azeri (Cyrillic)
KBDCTY81
24
Azeri (Latin)
KBDCTY80
24
Belarus
KBDCTY82
24
Belgium
KBDCTY1
24
Bosnia
KBDCTY33
24
Brazil
KBDCTY16
24
Brazil (MS)
KBDCTY59
24
Bulgaria (Cyrillic)
KBDCTY52
24
Bulgaria (Latin)
KBDCTY53
24
Canada (French legacy)
KBDCTY54
24
Canada (French)
KBDCTY18
24
Canada (Multilingual)
KBDCTY55
24
Croatia
KBDCTY32
25
Czech
KBDCTY15
25
Czech (Programmers)
KBDCTY40
25
Czech (QWERTY)
KBDCTY39
25
Czech (QWERTZ)
KBDCTY38
25
Denmark
KBDCTY8
25
Dutch (Netherlands)
KBDCTY11
25
Estonia
KBDCTY41
25
Faroese
KBDCTY83
25
Finland
KBDCTY2
25
France
KBDCTY3
25
Gaelic
KBDCTY84
25
Germany
KBDCTY4
26
Program Keyboard
Country
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
265
Selection
266
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Greek
KBDCTY17
26
Greek (220 Latin)
KBDCTY64
26
Greek (220)
KBDCTY61
26
Greek (319 Latin)
KBDCTY65
26
Greek (319)
KBDCTY62
26
Greek (Latin)
KBDCTY63
26
Greek (MS)
KBDCTY66
26
Greek (Polytonic)
KBDCTY60
26
Hebrew
KBDCTY12
26
Hungarian (101 key)
KBDCTY50
26
Hungary
KBDCTY19
26
Iceland
KBDCTY75
27
Irish
KBDCTY73
27
Italian (142)
KBDCTY56
27
Italy
KBDCTY5
27
Japan ASCII
KBDCTY28
27
Kazakh
KBDCTY78
27
Kyrgyz (Cyrillic)
KBDCTY79
27
Latin America
KBDCTY14
27
Latvia
KBDCTY42
27
Latvia (QWERTY)
KBDCTY43
27
Lithuania
KBDCTY44
27
Lithuania (IBM)
KBDCTY45
27
Macedonia
KBDCTY34
28
Malta
KBDCTY74
28
Mongolian (Cyrillic)
KBDCTY86
28
Norway
KBDCTY9
28
Poland
KBDCTY20
28
Polish (214)
KBDCTY57
28
Polish (Programmers)
KBDCTY58
28
Portugal
KBDCTY13
28
Romania
KBDCTY25
28
Russia
KBDCTY26
28
Russian (MS)
KBDCTY67
28
Russian (Typewriter)
KBDCTY68
28
SCS
KBDCTY21
29
Serbia (Cyrillic)
KBDCTY37
29
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Keyboard Conversion
Keyboard Style
Control Character Output
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Serbia (Latin)
KBDCTY36
29
Slovakia
KBDCTY22
29
Slovakia (QWERTY)
KBDCTY49
29
Slovakia (QWERTZ)
KBDCTY48
29
Slovenia
KBDCTY31
29
Spain
KBDCTY10
29
Spanish variation
KBDCTY51
29
Sweden
KBDCTY23
29
Switzerland (French)
KBDCTY29
29
Switzerland (German)
KBDCTY6
29
Tatar
KBDCTY85
30
Turkey F
KBDCTY27
30
Turkey Q
KBDCTY24
30
Ukrainian
KBDCTY76
30
United Kingdom
KBDCTY7
30
United Stated (Dvorak right)
KBDCTY89
30
United States (Dvorak left)
KBDCTY88
30
United States (Dvorak)
KBDCTY87
30
United States (International)
KBDCTY30
30
Uzbek (Cyrillic)
KBDCTY77
30
*Keyboard Conversion Off
KBDCNV0
32
Convert all Characters to Upper
Case
KBDCNV1
32
Convert all Characters to Lower
Case
KBDCNV2
32
*Regular
KBDSTY0
31
Caps Lock
KBDSTY1
31
Shift Lock
KBDSTY2
31
Automatic Caps Lock
KBDSTY6
31
Emulate External
Keyboard
KBDSTY5
31
*Control Character Output Off
KBDNPE0
32
*Control Character Output On
KBDNPE1
32
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
267
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Keyboard Modifiers
*Control + X Off
KBDCAS0
33
DOS Mode Control + X
KBDCAS1
33
Windows Mode Control + X
KBDCAS2
33
Windows Mode Prefix/Suffix Off
KBDCAS3
33
*Turbo Mode Off
KBDTMD0
33
Turbo Mode On
KBDTMD1
33
*Numeric Keypad Off
KBDNPS0
34
Numeric Keypad On
KBDNPS1
34
*Auto Direct Connect Off
KBDADC0
34
Auto Direct Connect On
KBDADC1
34
300 BPS
232BAD0
34
600 BPS
232BAD1
34
1200 BPS
232BAD2
34
2400 BPS
232BAD3
34
4800 BPS
232BAD4
35
9600 BPS
232BAD5
35
19200 BPS
232BAD6
35
38400 BPS
232BAD7
35
57600 BPS
232BAD8
35
*115200 BPS
232BAD9
35
7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even
232WRD3
35
7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None
232WRD0
35
7 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd
232WRD6
35
7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Even
232WRD4
36
7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity None
232WRD1
36
7 Data, 2 Stop, Parity Odd
232WRD7
36
8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Even
232WRD5
36
*8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity None
232WRD2
36
8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Odd
232WRD8
36
8 Data, 1 Stop, Parity Mark
232WRD14
36
Range 0 - 300 seconds
232LPT###
36
Baud Rate
Word Length: Data Bits, Stop Bits,
and Parity
RS232 Receiver Time-out
268
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
RS232 Handshaking
*RTS/CTS Off
232CTS0
37
Flow Control, No Timeout
232CTS1
37
Two-Direction Flow Control
232CTS2
37
Flow Control with Timeout
232CTS3
37
RS232 Timeout
232DEL####
37
*XON/XOFF Off
232XON0
38
XON/XOFF On
232XON1
38
*ACK/NAK Off
232ACK0
38
ACK/NAK On
232ACK1
38
*Packet Mode Off
232PKT0
39
Packet Mode On
232PKT2
39
*Bioptic ACK/NAK Off
232NAK0
39
Bioptic ACK/NAK On
232NAK1
39
ACK/NAK Timeout
*5100
232DLK#####
39
Scanner-Bioptic Packet Mode
Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Mode
Scanner-Bioptic ACK/NAK Timeout
Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g/1912 and Granit 1911i/1981i
This section applies only to cordless systems. It does not apply to corded scanners or Xenon 1902g-BF
scanners.
Replace a Linked Scanner
Override locked Scanner (Single
Scanner)
BT_RPL1
43
Temporary Streaming Presentation
Mode
*Temporary Streaming
Presentation Mode On
BEPPGE2
46
*10 Second Timeout
TRGTPM10000
46
60 Second Timeout
TRGTPM60000
46
*On
:*:BASRED1
50
Off
:*:BASRED0
50
Reset Scanner
Reset Scanner
RESET_
50
Scan While in Base Cradle
Scan in Cradle Off
BT_SIC0
50
*Scan in Cradle On (CCB01010BT default)
BT_SIC1
50
Shut Down Scanner in Cradle
BT_SIC2
50
Base Charge Off
BASCHG0
51
*External or Interface Cable Power
BASCHG1
51
External Power Only
BASCHG2
51
*On
BEPPGE1
51
Off
BEPPGE0
51
Range 400 - 9000 Hz (*1000)
BEPPFQ####
51
Base Power Communication
Indicator
Base Charge Modes
Page Mode
Page Pitch
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
269
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Beeper Pitch - Base Error
*Razz (250) (min 200Hz)
BASFQ2250
53
Medium (3250)
BASFQ23250
53
High (4200) (max 9000Hz)
BASFQ24200
53
*1
BASERR3
53
Range 1 - 9
BASERR#
53
Scanner Report
Scanner Report
RPTSCN
53
Scanner Address
Scanner Address
BT_LDA
53
Base Address
Base Address
:*:BASLDA
54
Scanner Modes
Charge Only Mode
:*:BASLNK0
54
*Charge and Link Mode
:*:BASLNK1
54
Locked Link Mode
BASCON0,DNG1
55
*Open Link Mode
BASCON1,DNG1
55
Unlink Scanner
BT_RMV
55
Override Locked Scanner
BT_RPL1
56
Base Alarm Duration (Range 1 3000 sec (*0))
BASORD
56
Scanner Alarm Duration (Range 1
- 3000 sec (*0))
BT_ORD
56
Base Alarm Type
BASORW
57
Scanner Alarm Type
BT_ORW
57
Timer (0-7200 seconds)
BT_LPT0
58
200 Seconds
BT_LPT200
58
400 Seconds
BT_LPT400
58
900 Seconds
BT_LPT900
58
3600 Seconds
BT_LPT3600
58
7200 Seconds
BT_LPT7200
58
*Full Power
BT_TXP100
59
Medium Power
BT_TXP35
59
Medium Low Power
BT_TXP5
59
Low Power
BT_TXP1
59
Automatic Batch Mode
BATENA1
60
*Batch Mode Off
BATENA0
60
Inventory Batch Mode
BATENA2
60
Persistent Batch Mode
BATENA3
60
Off
BATBEP0
60
*On
BATBEP1
60
*Flash Storage
BATNVS1
61
RAM Storage
BATNVS0
61
Number of Beeps - Base Error
Out-of-Range Alarm
Alarm Sound Type
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer
Flexible Power Management
Batch Mode
Batch Mode Beep
Batch Mode Storage
270
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Batch Mode Quantity
*Off
BATQTY0
61
On
BATQTY1
61
0
BATNUM0
62
*1
BATNUM1
62
2
BATNUM2
62
3
BATNUM3
62
4
BATNUM4
63
5
BATNUM5
63
6
BATNUM6
63
7
BATNUM7
63
8
BATNUM8
63
9
BATNUM9
63
*FIFO
BATLIF0
63
LIFO
BATLIF1
63
Total Records
Total Records
BATNRC
64
Delete Last Code
Delete Last Code
BATUND
64
Clear All Codes
Clear All Codes
BATCLR
64
Transmit Records to Host
Transmit Inventory Records
BAT_TX
64
Batch Mode Transmit Delay
*Off
BATDLY0
64
Short (ms)
BATDLY250
65
Medium (ms)
BATDLY500
65
Long (ms)
BATDLY1000
65
Multiple Scanner
Operation
Multiple Scanner Operation
BASCON2,DNG3
65
Scanner Name
Name 1-7
BT_NAM#####
66
Reset
RESET_
66
Scanner Name
BT_NAM
67
Application Work Group
Selections
*Group 0
GRPSEL0
67
Group 1-6
GRPSEL#
68
Reset the Factory Defaults: All
Application Work Groups
Factory Default Settings:
All Work Groups
PAPDFT&
68
Reset the Custom Defaults: All
Application Work Groups
Custom Default Settings:
All Work Groups
PAPDFT
69
Bluetooth Connection
*Bluetooth SSP On
BT_SSP1
69
Bluetooth SSP Off
BT_SSP0
69
Bluetooth HID Keyboard Connect
PAPBTH
70
Bluetooth HID Japanese Keyboard
Connect
PAPJKB
70
Quantity Codes
Batch Mode Output Order
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
271
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Bluetooth HID Keyboard
Disconnect
PAPSPP
71
Bluetooth Serial Port - PCs/
Laptops
BT_TRM0;BT_DNG5
72
BT Connection - PDA/Mobility
Systems Device
BT_TRM0;BT_DNG1
72
Bluetooth PIN Code
BT_PIN
72
*Auto Reconnect On
BT_ACM1
73
Auto Reconnect Off
BT_ACM0
73
Maximum Link Attempts
Maximum Link Attempts
BT_MLA###
74
Relink Time-Out
Relink Time-Out (*3)
BT_RLT###
74
Host Command Acknowledgment
Host ACK On
HSTACK1
77
*Host ACK Off
HSTACK0
77
Host ACK Timeout
HSTATO##
77
Setting
* Indicates default
Selection
Auto Reconnect Mode
Cordless System Operation: Xenon 1902g-BF
This section applies only to Xenon 1902g-BF systems. It does not apply to corded scanners or other cordless systems.
Replace a Linked Scanner
Override locked Scanner (Single
Scanner)
BT_RPL1
80
Low Power Alert Range
*Low Power Alert 10-30%
LPIRAG0
85
Low Power Alert 10-50%
LPIRAG1
85
Low Power Alert Flash Number
Range 1-9 (*3)
LPIFNO
85
Interval Between Flashes
Range 1-9 seconds (*2)
LPIFDL
85
Low Power Alert Repeat
Range 1-5 (*1)
LPI_NO
85
Interval Between Alerts
Range 10-120 seconds (*10)
LPI_DL
86
Low Power Alert Beep
Low Power Alert Beep Off
LPIBEP0
86
*Low Power Alert Beep On
LPIBEP1
86
Range 0 - 300000 ms (*10000)
TRGTPM######
89
*10 Second Timeout
TRGTPM10000
89
30 Second Timeout
TRGTPM30000
89
1 minute Timeout
TRGTPM60000
89
2 Minute Timeout
TRGTPM120000
89
3 Minute Timeout
TRGTPM180000
89
Base Power Communication
Indicator
*On
:*:BASRED1
87
Off
:*:BASRED0
87
Reset Scanner
Reset Scanner
RESET_
87
Temporary Streaming Presentation
Timeout
272
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Scan While in Base Cradle
Scan in Cradle Off
BT_SIC0
90
*Scan in Cradle On
BT_SIC1
90
Shut Down Scanner in Cradle
BT_SIC2
90
Base Charge Off
BASCHG0
88
*External or Interface Cable Power
BASCHG1
88
External Power Only
BASCHG2
88
*On
BEPPGE1
90
Off
BEPPGE0
90
Range 400 - 9000 Hz (*1000)
BEPPFQ####
91
*Low (1000 Hz)
BEPPFQ1000
91
Medium (3250 Hz)
BEPPFQ3250
91
High (4200 Hz)
BEPPFQ4200
91
*Linking Sound
BT_ACS1
91
Silent Linking
BT_ACS0
91
*Razz (250) (min 200Hz)
BASFQ2250
92
Medium (3250)
BASFQ23250
92
High (4200) (max 9000Hz)
BASFQ24200
92
Number of Beeps - Base Error
Range 1 - 9 (*1)
BASERR#
92
Scanner Report
Scanner Report
RPTSCN
92
Scanner Address
Scanner Address
BT_LDA
92
Base or Access Point Address
Base Address
:*:BASLDA
93
Scanner Modes
Charge Only Mode
:*:BASLNK0
93
*Charge and Link Mode
:*:BASLNK1
93
Locked Link Mode
BASCON0,DNG1
94
*Open Link Mode
BASCON1,DNG1
94
Unlink Scanner
BT_RMV
94
Override Locked Scanner
BT_RPL1
95
Base Alarm Duration (Range 1 3000 sec (*0))
BASORD
95
Scanner Alarm Duration (Range 1
- 3000 sec (*0))
BT_ORD
95
Base Alarm Type
BASORW
95
Scanner Alarm Type
BT_ORW
95
Base Charge Modes
Page Mode
Page Pitch
Linking Sound
Beeper Pitch - Base Error
Out-of-Range Alarm
Alarm Sound Type
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
273
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Scanner Power Time-Out Timer
Timer (0-7200 seconds)
BT_LPT0
96
200 Seconds
BT_LPT200
97
*400 Seconds
BT_LPT400
97
900 Seconds
BT_LPT900
97
3600 Seconds
BT_LPT3600
97
7200 Seconds
BT_LPT7200
97
Full Power
BT_TXP8
98
*Medium High Power
BT_TXP7
98
Medium Power
BT_TXP4
98
Low Power
BT_TXP1
98
Automatic Batch Mode
BATENA1
99
*Batch Mode Off
BATENA0
98
Inventory Batch Mode
BATENA2
99
Persistent Batch Mode
BATENA3
99
Off
BATBEP0
99
*On
BATBEP1
99
*Flash Storage
BATNVS1
99
RAM Storage
BATNVS0
99
*Off
BATQTY0
100
On
BATQTY1
100
0
BATNUM0
101
*1
BATNUM1
101
2
BATNUM2
101
3
BATNUM3
101
4
BATNUM4
101
5
BATNUM5
101
6
BATNUM6
101
7
BATNUM7
101
8
BATNUM8
102
9
BATNUM9
102
*FIFO
BATLIF0
102
LIFO
BATLIF1
102
Total Records
Total Records
BATNRC
102
Delete Last Code
Delete Last Code
BATUND
102
Clear All Codes
Clear All Codes
BATCLR
103
Transmit Records to Host
Transmit Inventory Records
BAT_TX
103
Flexible Power Management
Batch Mode
Batch Mode Beep
Batch Mode Storage
Batch Mode Quantity
Quantity Codes
Batch Mode Output Order
274
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Batch Mode Transmit Delay
*Off
BATDLY0
103
Short (ms)
BATDLY250
103
Medium (ms)
BATDLY500
103
Long (ms)
BATDLY1000
103
Name 1-7
BT_NAM#####
105
Reset
RESET_
104
Scanner Name
BT_NAM
105
Bluetooth Connection
Bluetooth PIN Code
BT_PIN
105
Auto Reconnect Mode
*Auto Reconnect On
BT_ACM1
105
Auto Reconnect Off
BT_ACM0
105
Maximum Link Attempts
Maximum Link Attempts (*4)
BT_MLA###
106
Relink Time-Out
Relink Time-Out (*2)
BT_RLT###
107
Host Command Acknowledgment
Host ACK On
HSTACK1
109
*Host ACK Off
HSTACK0
109
Host ACK Timeout
HSTATO##
109
Power Up Beeper Off - Scanner
BEPPWR0
111
*Power Up Beeper On - Scanner
BEPPWR1
111
Power Up Beeper Off - Cordless
Base
BASPWR0
111
Power Up Beeper On - Cordless
Base
BASPWR1
111
Beep on BEL On
BELBEP1
112
*Beep on BEL Off
BELBEP0
112
On
BEPTRG1
112
*Off
BEPTRG0
112
Off
BEPBEP0
112
*On
BEPBEP1
112
Off
BEPLVL0
112
*Low (Default-Xenon HC)
BEPLVL1
113
Medium
BEPLVL2
113
*High
BEPLVL3
113
Low (1600) (min 400Hz)
BEPFQ11600
113
*Medium - Xenon (2700 Hz)
BEPFQ12700
113
*Medium - Granit (3200 Hz)
BEPFQ13200
113
High (4200) (max 9000Hz)
BEPFQ14200
113
Vibrate - Good Read Off
TFBGRD0
113
*Vibrate - Good Read On
TFBGRD1
113
Scanner Name
Input/Output Selections
Power Up Beeper
Beep on BEL Character
Trigger Click
Beeper - Good Read
Beeper Volume - Good Read
Beeper Pitch - Good Read
(Frequency)
Vibrate - Good Read
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
275
Setting
* Indicates default
Selection
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Vibrate Duration
Duration
(100 - 2,000 ms) *300
TFBDUR####
114
Beeper Pitch - Error (Frequency)
*Razz (250) (min 200Hz)
BEPFQ2800
114
Medium (3250)
BEPFQ23250
114
High (4200) (max 9000Hz)
BEPFQ24200
114
*Normal Beep
BEPBIP0
115
Short Beep
BEPBIP1
115
Off
BEPLED0
115
*On
BEPLED1
115
*1
BEPERR3
115
Range 1 - 9
BEPERR#
115
*1
BEPRPT1
115
Range 1 - 9
BEPRPT#
115
Beeper Volume Max
Beeper Volume Max
PAPBLM
116
Good Read Delay
*No Delay
DLYGRD0
116
Short Delay (500 ms)
DLYGRD500
116
Medium Delay (1000 ms)
DLYGRD1000
116
Long Delay (1500 ms)
DLYGRD1500
116
User-Specified Good Read Delay
Range 0 - 30,000 ms
DLYGRD#####
117
Trigger Modes
*Manual Trigger - Normal
PAPHHF
117
Manual Trigger - Enhanced (not
supported by Granit 1980i and
1981i)
PAPHHS
117
*Trigger Toggle Off
TRGTGM0
118
Trigger Toggle - Image Capture
TRGTGM1
118
Trigger Toggle Off - Cell Phone
Read
TRGTGM2
118
Trigger Toggle Off - Centering
TRGTGM3
118
2 Quick Triggers
TRGTPC2
118
3 Quick Triggers
TRGTPC3
118
Beeper Duration - Good Read
LED - Good Read
Number of Beeps - Error
Number of Beeps - Good Read
Trigger Toggle
Trigger Number
4 Quick Triggers
TRGTPC4
118
Trigger Timing
Trigger Timing (Range 50 - 2000)
*400
TRGTTI####
118
Trigger Toggle Timeout
Trigger Toggle Timeout (Range 0 65) *5
TRGTGT##
119
Serial Trigger Mode
Read Time-Out
(0 - 300,000 ms) *30,000
TRGSTO####
119
Presentation Mode
Presentation Mode
PAPTPR
120
Presentation LED Behavior After
Decode
*LEDs On
TRGPCK1
120
LEDs Off
TRGPCK0
120
276
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Presentation Sensitivity (not
supported by Granit 1980i and
1981i)
Range 0-20 (*1)
TRGPMS##
120
Presentation Centering Window
Presentation Centering On
PDCWIN1
122
*Presentation Centering Off
PDCWIN0
122
Left of Presentation Centering
Window (*40%)
PDCLFT###
122
Right of Presentation Centering
Window (*60%)
PDCRGT###
122
Top of Presentation Centering
Window (*40%)
PDCTOP###
122
Bottom of Presentation Centering
Window (*60%)
PDCBOT###
122
Sensor On
TRGSSW1
123
Sensor Off
TRGSSW0
123
Poor Quality 1D Reading On
DECLDI1
123
*Poor Quality 1D Reading Off
DECLDI0
123
Poor Quality PDF Reading On
PDFXPR1
124
*Poor Quality PDF Reading Off
PDFXPR0
124
*CodeGate Off Out-of-Stand
AOSCGD0.
124
CodeGate On Out-of-Stand
AOSCGD1.
124
Streaming Presentation Mode Normal
PAPSPN
125
Streaming Presentation Mode Enhanced (not supported by
Granit 1980i and 1981i)
PAPSPE
125
Hand Held Scanning - Mobile
Phone
PAPHHC
125
Streaming Presentation - Mobile
Phone
PAPSPC
125
Hands Free Time-Out
Range 0 - 300,000 ms
TRGPTO######
126
Reread Delay
Short (500 ms)
DLYRRD500
126
*Medium (750 ms)
DLYRRD750
126
Long (1000 ms)
DLYRRD1000
126
Extra Long (2000 ms)
DLYRRD2000
126
User-Specified
Range 0 - 30,000 ms
DLYRRD#####
127
2D Reread Delay
*2D Reread Delay Off
DLY2RR0
127
Short (1000ms)
DLY2RR1000
127
Medium (2000ms)
DLY2RR2000
127
Long (3000ms)
DLY2RR3000
127
Extra Long (4000ms)
DLY2RR4000
127
Selection
In-Stand Sensor Mode
Poor Quality Codes
CodeGate
Streaming Presentation
Mobile Phone Read Mode (not
supported by Granit 1980i and
1981i)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
277
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Character Activation Mode
*Off
HSTCEN0
127
On
HSTCEN1
127
Activation Character (Range 0255) *12 [DC2]
HSTACH###
128
Do Not End Character Activation
After Good Read
HSTCGD0
128
End Character Activation After
Good Read
HSTCGD1
128
Character Activation Timeout
(Range 1 - 300,000) *30,000 ms
HSTCDT######
129
*Off
HSTDEN0
129
On
HSTDEN1
129
Deactivation Character (Range 0255) *14 [DC4]
HSTDCH###
129
*Lights On
SCNLED1
130
Lights Off
SCNLED0
130
200 milliseconds
SCNDLY200
130
400 milliseconds
SCNDLY400
130
*Off (no delay)
SCNDLY0
130
User-Specified Aimer Delay
Range 0 - 4,000 ms
SCNDLY####
131
Aimer Mode (not supported by
Granit 1980i and 1981i)
Off
SCNAIM0
131
*Interlaced
SCNAIM2
131
Single Code Centering
Single Code Centering
DECWIN1;DECTOP49;DECBOT
51;DECRGT51;DECLFT49
132
Centering Window
Centering On
DECWIN1
133
*Centering Off
DECWIN0
133
Left of Centering Window (*40%)
DECLFT###
134
Right of Centering Window (*60%)
DECRGT###
134
Top of Centering Window (*40%)
DECTOP###
134
Bottom of Centering Window
(*60%)
DECBOT###
134
On
PRFENA1
134
*Off
PRFENA0
135
High Priority Symbology
PRFCOD##
135
Low Priority Symbology
PRFBLK##
135
Preferred Symbology Timeout
(*500) Range 100-3000
PRFPTO####
135
Preferred Symbology Default
PRFDFT
136
Enter Sequence
SEQBLK
138
Default Sequence
SEQDFT
138
Character Deactivation Mode
Illumination Lights
Aimer Delay
Preferred Symbology
Output Sequence Editor
278
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Partial Sequence
Transmit Partial Sequence
SEQTTS1
139
*Discard Partial Sequence
SEQTTS0
139
Required
SEQ_EN2
139
On/Not Required
SEQ_EN1
139
*Off
SEQ_EN0
139
On
SHOTGN1
139
*Off
SHOTGN0
139
On
SHWNRD1
140
*Off
SHWNRD0
140
Video Reverse Only
VIDREV1
141
Video Reverse and Standard Bar
Codes
VIDREV2
141
*Video Reverse Off
VIDREV0
141
*Upright
ROTATN0
141
Vertical, Bottom to Top (Rotate
CCW 90°)
ROTATN1
142
Upside Down
ROTATN2
142
Vertical, Top to Bottom (Rotate CW
90°)
ROTATN3
142
Silent Mode with Flashing LED Cordless Scanner and Base
beplfn5;beplfr50;beppar0;basp
wr0;beppwr0;baslvl0;beplvl0;be
pbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot0.
143
Silent Mode with Flashing LED Corded Scanner
beplfn5;beplfr50;beppwr0;beplv
l0;bepbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot
0.
143
Silent Mode with Long LED Cordless Scanner and Base
beplfn0;beplfr10;beppar0;basp
wr0;beppwr0;baslvl0;beplvl0;be
pbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot1.
144
Silent Mode with Long LED Corded Scanner
beplfn0;beplfr10;beppwr0;beplv
l0;bepbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot
1.
144
Very Low Beeper (Nighttime
Mode) - Cordless Scanner and
Base
beplfn0;beplfr10;beppar0;basp
wr0;beppwr1;baslvl1;beplvl1;be
pbip1;bepFQ14200;beplot0.
144
Very Low Beeper (Nighttime
Mode) - Corded Scanner
beplfn0;beplfr10;beppwr1;beplv
l1;bepbip1;bepFQ14200;beplot
0.
144
Low Beeper (Daytime Mode) Cordless Scanner and Base
beplfn0;beplfr10;beppar1;basp
wr1;beppwr1;baslvl1;beplvl1;be
pbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot0.
145
Require Output Sequence
Multiple Symbols
No Read
Video Reverse
Working Orientation
Healthcare Selections
Quiet Operations - Combination
Codes
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
279
Setting
* Indicates default
Selection
Low Beeper (Daytime Mode) Corded Scanner
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
beplfn0;beplfr10;beppwr1;beplv
l1;bepbip0;bepFQ12700;beplot
0.
145
*Green LED Flashes/Sound
BEPPAR1
145
Red LED Flashes/Silent
BEPPAR0
145
*1 LED Flash
BEPLFN0
146
5 LED Flashes
BEPLFN5
146
10 LED Flashes
BEPLFN10
146
25 LED Flashes
BEPLFN25
146
*Fast Flash
BEPLFR50
146
Medium Flash
BEPLFR250
146
Slow Flash
BEPLFR500
146
*LED Solid Off (Resume Flash)
BEPLOT0
147
LED Solid 1 Second
BEPLOT1
147
LED Solid 3 Seconds
BEPLOT3
147
LED Solid 5 Seconds
BEPLOT5
147
Page Volume Off
BEPPGV0
147
*Page Volume Low
BEPPGV1
147
Page Volume Medium
BEPPGV2
148
Page Volume High
BEPPGV3
148
Base Alarm Volume Off
BASORV0
148
Scanner Alarm Volume Off
BT_ORV0
148
*Base Alarm Volume Low
BASORV1
148
*Scanner Alarm Volume Low
BT_ORV1
148
Base Alarm Volume Medium
BASORV2
148
Scanner Alarm Volume Medium
BT_ORV2
149
Base Alarm Volume High
BASORV3
149
Scanner Alarm Volume High
BT_ORV3
149
Out-of-Range Delay
(*0 No Delay) Range 0-3000
BT_ORY####
149
VSUFCR
153
Add Prefix
PREBK2##
153
Clear One Prefix
PRECL2
153
Clear All Prefixes
PRECA2
153
Quiet Operations - LED and Volume Settings
Linking LED Colors and
Sound
Number of LED Flashes
LED Flash Rate
LED Solid (No Flash)
Page Volume Control
Out-of-Range Alarm Volume
Out-of-Range Delay
Prefix/Suffix Selections
Add CR Suffix to All Symbologies
Prefix
280
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Suffix
Add Suffix
SUFBK2##
153
Clear One Suffix
SUFCL2
153
Clear All Suffixes
SUFCA2
153
*Enable
RMVFNC0
154
Disable
RMVFNC1
154
Intercharacter Delay
Range 0 - 1000 (5ms increments)
DLYCHR##
154
User Specified
Intercharacter Delay
Delay Length
0 - 1000 (5ms increments)
DLYCRX##
155
Character to Trigger Delay
DLY_XX##
155
Interfunction Delay
Range 0 - 1000 (5ms increments)
DLYFNC##
155
Intermessage Delay
Range 0 - 1000 (5ms increments)
DLYMSG##
156
*Default Data Format (None)
DFMDF3
158
Enter Data Format
DFMBK3##
159
Clear One Data Format
DFMCL3
159
Clear All Data Formats
DFMCA3
159
Data Formatter Off
DFM_EN0
173
*Data Formatter On,
Not Required,
Keep Prefix/Suffix
DFM_EN1
174
Data Format Required,
Keep Prefix/Suffix
DFM_EN2
174
Data Formatter On,
Not Required,
Drop Prefix/Suffix
DFM_EN3
174
Data Format Required,
Drop Prefix/Suffix
DFM_EN4
174
*Data Format Non-Match Error
Tone On
DFMDEC0
174
Data Format Non-Match Error
Tone Off
DFMDEC1
174
Primary Data Format
ALTFNM0
175
Data Format 1
ALTFNM1
175
Data Format 2
ALTFNM2
175
Data Format 3
ALTFNM3
175
Single Scan-Primary
Data Format
VSAF_0
175
Single Scan-Data Format 1
VSAF_1
175
Single Scan-Data Format 2
VSAF_2
175
Single Scan-Data Format 3
VSAF_3
176
Function Code Transmit
Data Formatter Selections
Data Format Editor
Data Formatter
Data Format Non-Match Error Tone
Primary/Alternate Data Formats
Single Scan Data Format Change
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
281
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
All Symbologies Off
ALLENA0
178
All Symbologies On
ALLENA1
178
Default All Codabar
Settings
CBRDFT
179
Off
CBRENA0
179
*On
CBRENA1
179
*Don’t Transmit
CBRSSX0
179
Transmit
CBRSSX1
179
*No Check Char.
CBRCK20
179
Validate, But Don’t Transmit
CBRCK21
179
Validate, and Transmit
CBRCK22
179
*Off
CBRCCT0
180
On
CBRCCT1
180
Require
CBRCCT2
180
Minimum (2 - 60) *4
CBRMIN##
181
Maximum (2 - 60) *60
CBRMAX##
181
Default All Code 39
Settings
C39DFT
181
Off
C39ENA0
181
*On
C39ENA1
181
*Don’t Transmit
C39SSX0
181
Transmit
C39SSX1
181
*No Check Char.
C39CK20
182
Validate, But Don’t
Transmit
C39CK21
182
Validate,
and Transmit
C39CK22
182
Minimum (0 - 48) *0
C39MIN##
182
Maximum (0 - 48) *48
C39MAX##
182
*Off
C39APP0
183
On
C39APP1
183
*Off
C39B320
183
On
C39B321
183
*Off
C39ASC0
183
On
C39ASC1
183
Code 39 Code Page
C39DCP
183
Symbologies
All Symbologies
Codabar
Codabar Start/Stop Char.
Codabar Check Char.
Codabar Concatenation
Codabar Message Length
Code 39
Code 39 Start/Stop Char.
Code 39 Check Char.
Code 39 Message Length
Code 39 Append
Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF)
Code 39 Full ASCII
282
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Default All Interleaved
2 of 5 Settings
I25DFT
185
Off
I25ENA0
185
*On
I25ENA1
185
*No Check Char.
I25CK20
185
Validate, But Don’t
Transmit
I25CK21
185
Validate, and Transmit
I25CK22
185
Minimum (2 - 80) *4
I25MIN##
186
Maximum (2 - 80) *80
I25MAX##
186
Default All NEC
2 of 5 Settings
N25DFT
186
Off
N25ENA0
186
*On
N25ENA1
186
*No Check Char.
N25CK20
186
Validate, But Don’t
Transmit
N25CK21
186
Validate, and Transmit
N25CK22
186
Minimum (2 - 80) *4
N25MIN##
187
Maximum (2 - 80) *80
N25MAX##
187
Default All Code 93
Settings
C93DFT
187
Off
C93ENA0
187
*On
C93ENA1
187
Minimum (0 - 80) *0
C93MIN##
188
Maximum (0 - 80) *80
C93MAX##
188
On
C93APP1
188
*Off
C93APP0
188
Code 93 Code Page
Code 93 Code Page
C93DCP
188
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial
Default All Straight 2 of 5
Industrial Settings
R25DFT
189
*Off
R25ENA0
189
On
R25ENA1
189
Minimum (1 - 48) *4
R25MIN##
189
Maximum (1 - 48) *48
R25MAX##
189
Straight 2 of 5 IATA
Default All Straight 2 of 5 IATA
Settings
A25DFT
190
Straight 2 of 5 IATA
*Off
A25ENA0
190
On
A25ENA1
190
Range (0 - 10) *0
A25VOT##
190
Setting
* Indicates default
Selection
Interleaved 2 of 5
Interleaved 2 of 5 Check Digit
Interleaved 2 of 5 Message Length
NEC 2 of 5
NEC 2 of 5 Check Digit
NEC 2 of 5 Message Length
Code 93
Code 93 Message Length
Code 93 Append
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial Message
Length
Straight 2 of 5 IATA Redundancy
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
283
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Straight 2 of 5 IATA Message
Length
Minimum (1 - 48) *4
A25MIN##
190
Maximum (1 - 48) *48
A25MAX##
190
Matrix 2 of 5
Default All Matrix 2 of 5
Settings
X25DFT
191
*Off
X25ENA0
191
On
X25ENA1
191
Minimum (1 - 80) *4
X25MIN##
191
Maximum (1 - 80) *80
X25MAX##
191
Default All Code 11
Settings
C11DFT
192
*Off
C11ENA0
192
On
C11ENA1
192
1 Check Digit
C11CK20
192
*2 Check Digits
C11CK21
192
Minimum (1 - 80) *4
C11MIN##
192
Maximum (1 - 80) *80
C11MAX##
192
Default All Code 128
Settings
128DFT
193
Off
128ENA0
193
*On
128ENA1
193
*Off
ISBENA0
193
On
ISBENA1
193
Code 128 Redundancy
Range (0 - 10) *0
128VOT##
193
Code 128 Message Length
Minimum (0 - 80) *0
128MIN##
194
Maximum (0 - 80) *80
128MAX##
194
*On
128APP1
194
Off
128APP0
194
Code 128 Code Page
Code 128 Code Page (*2)
128DCP##
194
GS1-128
Default All GS1-128 Settings
GS1DFT
195
*On
GS1ENA1
195
Off
GS1ENA0
195
Minimum (1 - 80) *1
GS1MIN##
195
Maximum (0 - 80) *80
GS1MAX##
195
Default All Telepen
Settings
TELDFT
196
*Off
TELENA0
196
On
TELENA1
196
*AIM Telepen Output
TELOLD0
196
Original Telepen Output
TELOLD1
196
Selection
Matrix 2 of 5 Message Length
Code 11
Code 11 Check Digits Required
Code 11 Message Length
Code 128
ISBT Concatenation
Code 128 Append
GS1-128 Message Length
Telepen
Telepen Output
284
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Telepen Message Length
Minimum (1 - 60) *1
TELMIN##
196
Maximum (1 - 60) *60
TELMAX##
196
Default All
UPC-A Settings
UPADFT
197
Off
UPBENA0
197
*On
UPBENA1
197
Off
UPACKX0
197
*On
UPACKX1
197
Off
UPANSX0
198
*On
UPANSX1
198
*Off
UPAAD20
198
On
UPAAD21
198
*Off
UPAAD50
198
On
UPAAD51
198
*Not Required
UPAARQ0
198
Required
UPAARQ1
198
Addenda Timeout
Range (0 - 120) *500
DLYADD#####
199
UPC-A Addenda
Separator
Off
UPAADS0
199
*On
UPAADS1
199
UPC-A/EAN-13 with Extended
Coupon Code
*Off
CPNENA0
199
Allow Concatenation
CPNENA1
199
Require Concatenation
CPNENA2
199
Addenda Timeout
Range (0 - 120) *500
DLYADD#####
200
Coupon GS1 DataBar Output
GS1 Output Off
CPNGS10
200
GS1 Output On
CPNGS11
200
Default All UPC-E
Settings
UPEDFT
201
Off
UPEEN00
201
*On
UPEEN01
201
*Off
UPEEXP0
201
On
UPEEXP1
201
Required
UPEARQ1
201
*Not Required
UPEARQ0
201
Addenda Timeout
Range (0 - 120) *500
DLYADD#####
202
UPC-E0 Addenda Separator
*On
UPEADS1
202
Off
UPEADS0
202
Off
UPECKX0
202
*On
UPECKX1
202
UPC-A
UPC-A Check Digit
UPC-A Number System
UPC-A 2 Digit Addenda
UPC-A 5 Digit Addenda
UPC-A Addenda Required
UPC-E0
UPC-E0 Expand
UPC-E0 Addenda Required
UPC-E0 Check Digit
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
285
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
UPC-E0 Leading Zero
Off
UPENSX0
203
*On
UPENSX1
203
2 Digit Addenda On
UPEAD21
203
*2 Digit Addenda Off
UPEAD20
203
5 Digit Addenda On
UPEAD51
203
*5 Digit Addenda Off
UPEAD50
203
*Off
UPEEN10
203
On
UPEEN11
203
Default All EAN/
JAN Settings
E13DFT
204
Off
E13ENA0
204
*On
E13ENA1
204
UPC-A Converted to EAN-13
UPAENA0
204
Do not Convert UPC-A
UPAENA1
204
Off
E13CKX0
205
*On
E13CKX1
205
2 Digit Addenda On
E13AD21
205
*2 Digit Addenda Off
E13AD20
205
5 Digit Addenda On
E13AD51
205
*5 Digit Addenda Off
E13AD50
205
*Not Required
E13ARQ0
205
Required
E13ARQ1
205
Addenda Timeout
Range (0 - 120) *500
DLYADD#####
206
EAN/JAN-13 Addenda
Separator
Off
E13ADS0
206
*On
E13ADS1
206
*Off
E13ISB0
206
On
E13ISB1
206
Default All EAN/
JAN 8 Settings
EA8DFT
207
Off
EA8ENA0
207
*On
EA8ENA1
207
Off
EA8CKX0
207
*On
EA8CKX1
207
*2 Digit Addenda Off
EA8AD20
207
2 Digit Addenda On
EA8AD21
207
*5 Digit Addenda Off
EA8AD50
207
5 Digit Addenda On
EA8AD51
207
UPC-E0 Addenda
UPC-E1
EAN/JAN-13
Convert UPC-A to EAN-13
EAN/JAN-13 Check Digit
EAN/JAN-13 2 Digit Addenda
EAN/JAN-13 Addenda Required
ISBN Translate
EAN/JAN-8
EAN/JAN-8 Check Digit
EAN/JAN-8 Addenda
286
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
EAN/JAN-8 Addenda Required
*Not Required
EA8ARQ0
208
Required
EA8ARQ1
208
Addenda Timeout
Range (0 - 120) *500
DLYADD#####
208
EAN/JAN-8 Addenda
Separator
Off
EA8ADS0
208
*On
EA8ADS1
208
Default All MSI Settings
MSIDFT
209
*Off
MSIENA0
209
On
MSIENA1
209
*Validate Type 10, but Don’t
Transmit
MSICHK0
209
Validate Type 10 and
Transmit
MSICHK1
209
Validate 2 Type 10 Chars, but
Don’t Transmit
MSICHK2
210
Validate 2 Type 10 Chars and
Transmit
MSICHK3
210
Validate Type 11 then Type 10
Char, but Don’t Transmit
MSICHK4
210
Validate Type 11 then Type 10
Char and Transmit
MSICHK5
210
Disable MSI Check Characters
MSICHK6
210
Minimum (4 - 48) *4
MSIMIN##
210
Maximum (4 - 48) *48
MSIMAX##
210
Default All
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional
Settings
RSSDFT
211
Off
RSSENA0
211
*On
RSSENA1
211
Default All GS1 DataBar Limited
Settings
RSLDFT
211
Off
RSLENA0
211
*On
RSLENA1
211
Default All GS1 DataBar
Expanded Settings
RSEDFT
212
Off
RSEENA0
212
*On
RSEENA1
212
Minimum (4 - 74) *4
RSEMIN##
212
Maximum (4 - 74) *74
RSEMAX##
212
*Off
TRIENA0
212
On
TRIENA1
212
MSI
MSI Check Character
MSI Message Length
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional
GS1 DataBar Limited
GS1 DataBar Expanded
GS1 DataBar Expanded Msg.
Length
Trioptic Code
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
287
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Codablock A
Default All Codablock A Settings
CBADFT
213
*Off
CBAENA0
213
On
CBAENA1
213
Minimum (1 - 600) *1
CBAMIN###
213
Maximum (1 - 600) *600
CBAMAX###
213
Default All Codablock F Settings
CBFDFT
214
*Off
CBFENA0
214
On
CBFENA1
214
Minimum (1 - 2048) *1
CBFMIN####
214
Maximum (1 - 2048) *2048
CBFMAX####
214
On
LBLENA1
214
* Off
LBLENA0
214
Default All PDF417 Settings
PDFDFT
215
*On
PDFENA1
215
Off
PDFENA0
215
Minimum (1-2750) *1
PDFMIN####
215
Maximum (1-2750) *2750
PDFMAX####
215
*On
PDFMAC1
216
Off
PDFMAC0
216
Default All Micro PDF417 Settings
MPDDFT
216
On
MPDENA1
216
*Off
MPDENA0
216
Minimum (1-366) *1
MPDMIN###
216
Maximum (1-366) *366
MPDMAX###
216
On
COMENA1
217
*Off
COMENA0
217
On
COMUPC1
217
*Off
COMUPC0
217
Minimum (1-2435) *1
COMMIN####
217
Maximum (1-2435) *2435
COMMAX####
217
GS1-128 Emulation
EANEMU1
218
GS1 DataBar Emulation
EANEMU2
217
GS1 Code Expansion Off
EANEMU3
218
EAN8 to EAN13 Conversion
EANEMU4
218
*GS1 Emulation Off
EANEMU0
218
On
T39ENA1
219
*Off
T39ENA0
219
Codablock A Msg. Length
Codablock F
Codablock F Msg. Length
Label Code
PDF417
PDF417 Msg. Length
MacroPDF417
MicroPDF417
MicroPDF417 Msg. Length
GS1 Composite Codes
UPC/EAN Version
GS1 Composite Codes Msg. Length
GS1 Emulation
TCIF Linked Code 39
288
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
QR Code
Default All QR Code Settings
QRCDFT
219
*On
QRCENA1
219
Off
QRCENA0
219
Minimum (1-7089) *1
QRCMIN####
219
Maximum (1-7089) *7089
QRCMAX####
219
*On
QRCAPP1
220
Off
QRCAPP0
220
QR Code Page
QR Code Page (*3)
QRCDCP##
220
Data Matrix
Default All Data Matrix Settings
IDMDFT
221
*On
IDMENA1
221
Off
IDMENA0
221
Minimum (1-3116) *1
IDMMIN####
221
Maximum (1-3116) *3116
IDMMAX####
221
*On
IDMAPP1
221
Off
IDMAPP0
221
Data Matrix Code Page
Data Matrix Code Page (*51)
IDMDCP##
222
MaxiCode
Default All MaxiCode Settings
MAXDFT
222
On
MAXENA1
222
*Off
MAXENA0
222
Minimum (1-150) *1
MAXMIN###
223
Maximum (1-150) *150
MAXMAX###
223
Default All Aztec Code Settings
AZTDFT
223
*On
AZTENA1
223
Off
AZTENA0
223
Minimum (1-3832) *1
AZTMIN####
223
Maximum (1-3832) *3832
AZTMAX####
223
*On
AZTAPP1
224
Off
AZTAPP0
224
Aztec Code Page
Aztec Code Page (*51)
AZTDCP##
224
Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code
Default All Han Xin Code Settings
HX_DFT
224
On
HX_ENA1
224
*Off
HX_ENA0
224
Minimum (1-7833) *1
HX_MIN####
225
Maximum (1-7833) *7833
HX_MAX####
225
*Off
POSTAL0
225
QR Code Msg. Length
QR Code Append
Data Matrix Msg. Length
Data Matrix Append
MaxiCode Msg. Length
Aztec Code
Aztec Code Msg. Length
Aztec Append
Chinese Sensible (Han Xin) Code
Msg. Length
Postal Codes - 2D
2D Postal Codes
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
289
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Single 2D Postal Codes
Australian Post On
POSTAL1
225
British Post On
POSTAL7
225
Canadian Post On
POSTAL30
225
Intelligent Mail Bar Code On
POSTAL10
226
Japanese Post On
POSTAL3
226
KIX Post On
POSTAL4
226
Planet Code On
POSTAL5
226
Postal-4i On
POSTAL9
226
Postnet On
POSTAL6
226
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
POSTAL11
226
InfoMail On
POSTAL2
226
InfoMail and British Post On
POSTAL8
226
Intelligent Mail Bar Code and
Postnet with B and B’ Fields On
POSTAL20
227
Postnet and Postal-4i On
POSTAL14
227
Postnet and Intelligent Mail Bar
Code On
POSTAL16
227
Postal-4i and Intelligent Mail Bar
Code On
POSTAL17
227
Postal-4i and Postnet with B and
B’ Fields On
POSTAL19
227
Planet and Postnet On
POSTAL12
227
Planet and Postnet with B and B’
Fields On
POSTAL18
227
Planet and Postal-4i On
POSTAL13
227
Planet and Intelligent Mail Bar
Code On
POSTAL15
227
Planet, Postnet, and Postal-4i On
POSTAL21
227
Planet, Postnet, and Intelligent
Mail Bar Code On
POSTAL22
228
Planet, Postal-4i, and Intelligent
Mail Bar Code On
POSTAL23
228
Postnet, Postal-4i, and Intelligent
Mail Bar Code On
POSTAL24
228
Planet, Postal-4i, and Postnet with
B and B’ Fields On
POSTAL25
228
Planet, Intelligent Mail Bar Code,
and Postnet with B and B’ Fields
On
POSTAL26
228
Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail Bar
Code, and Postnet with B and B’
Fields On
POSTAL27
228
Combination 2D Postal Codes
290
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Planet, Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail
Bar Code, and Postnet On
POSTAL28
228
Planet, Postal-4i, Intelligent Mail
Bar Code, and Postnet with B and
B’ Fields On
POSTAL29
228
Transmit
PLNCKX1
229
*Don’t Transmit
PLNCKX0
229
Transmit
NETCKX1
229
*Don’t Transmit
NETCKX0
229
Bar Output
AUSINT0
229
Numeric N Table
AUSINT1
230
Alphanumeric C Table
AUSINT2
230
Combination N and C Tables
AUSINT3
230
Default All China Post (Hong Kong
2 of 5) Settings
CPCDFT
230
*Off
CPCENA0
230
On
CPCENA1
230
Minimum (2 - 80) *4
CPCMIN##
230
Maximum (2 - 80) *80
CPCMAX##
230
Default All Korea Post Settings
KPCDFT
231
*Off
KPCENA0
231
On
KPCENA1
231
Minimum (2 - 80) *4
KPCMIN##
231
Maximum (2 - 80) *48
KPCMAX##
231
Transmit Check Digit
KPCCHK1
231
*Don’t Transmit Check Digit
KPCCHK0
231
Default all Imaging Commands
IMGDFT
233
Imaging Style - Decoding
SNPSTY0
234
*Imaging Style - Photo
SNPSTY1
234
Imaging Style - Manual
SNPSTY2
234
Beeper On
SNPBEP1
234
*Beeper Off
SNPBEP0
234
*Wait for Trigger Off
SNPTRG0
235
Wait for Trigger On
SNPTRG1
235
*LED State - Off
SNPLED0
235
LED State - On
SNPLED1
235
Exposure (1-7874 microseconds)
SNPEXP
235
Setting
* Indicates default
Selection
Planet Code Check Digit
Postnet Check Digit
Australian Post Interpretation
Postal Codes - Linear
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5)
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5)
Msg. Length
Korea Post
Korea Post Msg. Length
Korea Post Check Digit
Imaging Default Commands
Image Snap
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
291
Selection
Image Ship
292
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
*Gain - None
SNPGAN1
236
Gain - Medium
SNPGAN2
236
Gain - Heavy
SNPGAN4
236
Gain - Maximum
SNPGAN8
236
Target White Value (0-255) *125
SNPWHT###
236
Delta for Acceptance (0-255) *25
SNPDEL###
236
Update Tries (0-10) *6
SNPTRY##
237
Target Set Point Percentage (199) *50
SNPPCT##
237
*Infinity Filter - Off
IMGINF0
238
Infinity Filter - On
IMGINF1
238
*Compensation Off
IMGCOR0
238
Compensation On
IMGCOR1
238
*Pixel Depth - 8 bits/pixel
(grayscale)
IMGBPP8
238
Pixel Depth - 1 bit/pixel (B&W)
IMGBPP1
238
*Don’t Sharpen Edges
IMGEDG0
239
Sharpen Edges (0-23)
IMGEDG##
239
*File Format - JPEG
IMGFMT6
240
File Format - KIM
IMGFMT0
240
File Format - TIFF binary
IMGFMT1
240
File Format - TIFF binary group 4,
compressed
IMGFMT2
240
File Format - TIFF grayscale
IMGFMT3
240
File Format - Uncompressed
binary
IMGFMT4
240
File Format - Uncompressed
grayscale
IMGFMT5
240
File Format - BMP
IMGFMT8
240
*Histogram Stretch Off
IMGHIS0
240
Histogram Stretch On
IMGHIS1
240
*Noise Reduction Off
IMGFSP0
241
Noise Reduction On
IMGFSP1
241
Invert Image around X axis
IMGNVX1
241
Invert Image around Y axis
IMGNVY1
241
Rotate Image none
IMGROT0
242
Rotate Image 90° right
IMGROT1
242
Rotate Image 180° right
IMGROT2
242
Rotate Image 90° left
IMGROT3
242
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
JPEG Image Quality (0-100) *50
IMGJQF###
242
*Gamma Correction Off
IMGGAM0
243
Gamma Correction On (0-1000)
IMGGAM###
243
Image Crop - Left (0-843) *0
IMGWNL###
243
Image Crop - Right (0-843) *843
IMGWNR###
243
Image Crop - Top (0-639) *0
IMGWNT###
243
Image Crop - Bottom (0-639)
*639
IMGWNB###
244
Image Crop - Margin (1-238) *0
IMGMAR###
244
Protocol - None (raw)
IMGXFR0
244
Protocol - None (default USB)
IMGXFR2
244
Protocol - Hmodem Compressed
IMGXFR3
244
Protocol - Hmodem
IMGXFR4
244
Ship Every Pixel
IMGSUB1
245
Ship Every 2nd Pixel
IMGSUB2
245
Ship Every 3rd Pixel
IMGSUB3
245
*Document Image Filter Off
IMGUSH0
245
Document Image Filter On (0255)
IMGUSH###
245
*Don’t Ship Histogram
IMGHST0
246
Ship Histogram
IMGHST1
246
Force VGA Resolution
IMGVGA1
246
*Native Resolution
IMGVGA0
247
Optimize On
DECBND1
247
*Optimize Off
DECBND0
247
Add Code I.D. Prefix to All Symbologies (Temporary)
PRECA2,BK2995C80!
253
Show Decoder Revision
REV_DR
253
Show Scan Driver Revision
REV_SD
253
Show Software Revision
REVINF
254
Show Data Format
DFMBK3?
254
On
TSTMNU1
254
*Off
TSTMNU0
254
*Decoding Apps On
PLGDCE1
255
Decoding Apps Off
PLGDCE0
255
*Formatting Apps On
PLGFOE1
255
Formatting Apps Off
PLGFOE0
255
List Apps
PLGINF
255
Selection
Image Size Compatibility
Intelligent Signature Capture
Utilities
Test Menu
Application Plug-Ins (Apps)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
293
Selection
Setting
* Indicates default
Serial Command
# Indicates a numeric
entry
Page
Reset the Factory Defaults
Remove Custom Defaults
DEFOVR
257
Activate Defaults
DEFALT
257
294
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
13
PRODUCT SPECIFICATIONS
Xenon 1900/1900h/1910 Corded Scanner Product
Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
6.3 inches (160mm)
Length
4.1 inches (104.1mm)
Width
2.8 inches (71.1mm)
Weight
5.2 ounces (147.42g)
Electrical
Voltage Requirements
4 - 5.5 VDC at input connector
Current Draw @5VDC
B&W
Color
ScanningStandby
470mA, 2.35W90mA, .45W
490mA, 2.45W90mA, .45W
Power Supply Noise Rejection
Maximum 100mV peak to peak, 10 to 100 kHz
Illumination LED:
Peak Wavelength
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
442nm, 552nm (white LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Aiming:
Peak Wavelength Laser
650nm
IEC 60825-1: “Class 2”
Peak Wavelength LED
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
520nm + 18nm (green LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Optical Power Laser
<1mW
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
+32F to +122F (0C to 50C)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
295
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Storage
-40F to +158F (-40C to 70C)
Humidity
0 to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 6 feet
(1.83m) to concrete at 23°C
Vibration
Withstands 5G peak from 22 to 300 Hz
ESD Tolerance
Up to 15kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Image
Image Size
838 x 640 pixels
Scan Performance
Skew Angle
+65°
Pitch Angle
+45°
Motion Tolerance:
Streaming Presentation Trigger
up to 240 inches per second for 13 mil UPC
Symbol Contrast
Grade 1.0 (20% or greater)
Xenon 1902/1902h/1912 Cordless Scanner Product
Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
6.3 inches (160mm)
Length
4.1 inches (104.1mm)
Width
2.8 inches (71.1mm)
Weight
7.5 ounces (212.62g)
Electrical
Illumination LED:
Peak Wavelength
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
442nm, 552nm (white LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Aiming:
Peak Wavelength Laser
650nm
IEC 60825-1: “Class 2”
Peak Wavelength LED
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
520nm + 18nm (green LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Optical Power Laser
<1mW
Battery
Lithium Ion
296
2400 mAHr minimum
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Parameter (Continued)
Number of Scans
Specification
Up to 50,000 per charge
Expected Hours of Operation
14
Expected Charge Time
4.5 hours
Radio
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping
Bluetooth v.2.1
Range
33 ft. (10 m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 1 MBps
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
32 F to +122 F (0 C to 50 C)
Storage with battery*
-4F to +95F (-20C to 35C) for storage up to 90
days
-4F to +68F (-20C to 20C) for storage up to 365
days
Storage without battery
-40F to +158F (-40C to 70C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 6 feet
(1.8 m) to concrete
Vibration
Withstands 5G peak from 22 to 300 Hz
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 15kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Sealant Rating
IP41
Image
Image Size
838 x 640 pixels
Scan Performance
Skew Angle
+65°
Pitch Angle
+45°
Motion Tolerance:
Streaming Presentation Trigger
up to 240 inches per second for 13 mil UPC
Symbol Contrast
Grade 1.0 (20% or greater)
*Storage outside of this temperature range could be detrimental to battery life.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
297
Xenon 1902g-BF Scanner Product Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
6.3 inches (160mm)
Length
4.1 inches (104.1mm)
Width
2.8 inches (71.1mm)
Weight
6.9 ounces (195g)
Electrical
Illumination LED:
Peak Wavelength
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
442nm, 552nm (white LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Aiming:
Peak Wavelength Laser
650nm
IEC 60825-1: “Class 2”
Peak Wavelength LED
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
520nm + 18nm (green LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Optical Power Laser
<1mW
Radio
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping
Bluetooth v.2.1
Range
33 ft. (10 m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 1 MBps
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
32 F to +122 F (0 C to 50 C)
Storage
-40F to +158F (-40C to 70C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 3.3 feet
(1 m) to concrete
Vibration
Withstands 5G peak from 22 to 300 Hz
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 15kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Sealant Rating
IP41
Image
Image Size
838 x 640 pixels
Scan Performance
298
Skew Angle
+65°
Pitch Angle
+45°
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Motion Tolerance:
Up to 240 inches per second for 13 mil UPC
Symbol Contrast
Grade 1.0 (20% or greater)
Granit 1910i Industrial Corded Scanner Product
Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
7.7 in. (195.6mm)
Length
5.2 in. (132.1mm)
Width
2.9 in. (73.7mm)
Weight
10.6 oz. (300g)
Electrical
Voltage Requirements
4 - 5.5 VDC at input connector
Current Draw @5VDC
ScanningStandby
470mA, 2.35W100mA, 5W
Power Supply Noise Rejection
Maximum 100mV peak to peak, 10 to 100 kHz
Illumination LED:
Peak Wavelength
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Aiming:
Peak Wavelength Laser
650nm
IEC 60825-1: “Class 2”
Optical Power Laser
<1mW
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
-22F to +122F (-30C to 50C)
Storage
-40F to +158F (-40C to 70C)
Humidity
0 to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet
(1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C
Vibration
Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex
C
ESD Tolerance
Up to 20kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Sealant Rating
IP65
Image
Image Size
838 x 640 pixels
Scan Performance
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
299
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Skew Angle
+65°
Pitch Angle
+45°
Motion Tolerance:
Streaming Presentation Trigger:
13 mil UPC
240 inches per second at 6.5 in. (16.5cm)
150 inches per second at 10 in. (25.4cm)
Symbol Contrast
Grade 1.0 (20% or greater)
Granit 1911i Industrial Cordless Scanner Product
Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
7.7 in. (195.6mm)
Length
5.2 in. (132.1mm)
Width
2.9 in. (73.7mm)
Weight
13.8 oz. (390g)
Electrical
Illumination LED:
Peak Wavelength
624nm + 18nm (red LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Aiming:
Peak Wavelength Laser
650nm
IEC 60825-1: “Class 2”
Optical Power Laser
<1mW
Battery
Lithium Ion
Number of Scans
1800 mAHr minimum
Up to 50,000 per charge
Expected Hours of Operation
14
Expected Charge Time
4.5 hours
Radio
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping
Bluetooth v.2.1
Range
330 ft. (100m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 1 MBps
Environmental
300
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Temperature Ranges:
Operating while not charging
-4F to + 122F (-20C to 50C)
Operating while charging
41F to + 104F (5C to 40C)
Storage with battery*
-4F to +95F (-20C to 35C) for storage up to 90
days
-4F to +68F (-20C to 20C) for storage up to 365
days
Storage without battery
-40F to +158F (-40C to 70C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet
(1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C
Vibration
Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex
C
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 20kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Sealant Rating
IP65
Image
Image Size
838 x 640 pixels
Scan Performance
Skew Angle
+65°
Pitch Angle
+45°
Motion Tolerance:
Streaming Presentation Trigger:
13 mil UPC
240 inches per second at 6.5 in. (16.5cm)
150 inches per second at 10 in. (25.4cm)
Symbol Contrast
Grade 1.0 (20% or greater)
*Storage outside of this temperature range could be detrimental to battery life.
Granit 1980i Industrial Full Range Corded Scanner
Product Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
7.7 in. (195.6mm)
Length
5.2 in. (132.1mm)
Width
2.9 in. (73.7mm)
Weight
11.8 oz. (335g)
Electrical
Voltage Requirements
4 - 5.5 VDC at input connector
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
301
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Current Draw @5VDC
ScanningStandby
470mA, 2.35W100mA, 0.5W
Power Supply Noise Rejection
Maximum 100mV peak to peak, 10 to 100 kHz
Illumination LED:
Peak Wavelength
617nm + 18nm (amber LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Aiming:
Peak Wavelength Laser
650nm
IEC 60825-1: “Class 2”
Optical Power Laser
<1mW
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
-22F to +122F (-30C to 50C)
Storage
-40F to +158F (-40C to 70C)
Humidity
0 to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet
(1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C
Vibration
Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6, Annex
C
ESD Tolerance
Up to 20kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Sealant Rating
IP65
Image
Image Size
1280 x 800 pixels
Scan Performance
Skew Angle
+80° typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC
Pitch Angle
+70°typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC
Motion Tolerance:
30 inches per second typical on 13 mil UPC/EAN bar
code 8 in. from scanner nose
Symbol Contrast
1D codes 30% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 13 mil)
2D codes 40% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 20 mil)
Granit 1981i Industrial Full Range Cordless Scanner
Product Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
302
Height
7.7 in. (195.6mm)
Length
5.2 in. (132.1mm)
Width
2.9 in. (73.7mm)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Weight
14.8 oz. (420g)
Electrical
Illumination LED:
Peak Wavelength
617nm + 18nm (amber LED)
IEC 62471: “Exempt Risk Group”
Aiming:
Peak Wavelength Laser
650nm
IEC 60825-1: “Class 2”
Optical Power Laser
<1mW
Battery
Battery:
Lithium Ion
Number of Scans
1800 mAHr minimum
at least 7200 scans (1 scan every 4 seconds for 8
hours)
Expected Hours of Operation
8
Expected Charge Time
4.5 hours
Radio
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping
Bluetooth v.2.1
Range
330 ft. (100m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 1 MBps
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating while not charging
-4F to + 122F (-20C to 50C)
Operating while charging
41F to + 104F (5C to 40C)
Storage with battery*
-4F to +95F (-20C to 35C) for storage up to 90
days
-4F to +68F (-20C to 20C) for storage up to 365
days
Storage without battery
-40F to +158F (-40C to 70C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 6.5 feet
(1.98m) to concrete at 23°, -30°, and 50°C
Vibration
Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6,
Annex C
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 20kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Sealant Rating
IP65
Image
Image Size
1280 x 800 pixels
Scan Performance
Skew Angle
+80° typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
303
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Pitch Angle
+70° typical, 200 lux, EAN/UPC
Motion Tolerance:
30 inches per second typical on 13 mil UPC/EAN bar
code 8 in. from scanner nose
Symbol Contrast
1D codes 30% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 13 mil)
2D codes 40% or greater (typical, 200 lux, 20 mil)
*Storage outside of this temperature range could be detrimental to battery life.
CCB01-010BT Charge Base Product Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
3.2 inches (81.3mm)
Length
5.19 inches (131.8mm)
Width
3.98 inches (101.1mm)
Weight
6.3 oz (179g)
Electrical
Voltage:
4.5 to 5.5 volts
Current Draw:
Host Terminal Port
500mA
Aux Power Port
1A
Charge Time
5 hours
Radio
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping
Bluetooth v.2.1
Range
33 ft. (10 m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 1 MBps
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
304
Operating
32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C)
Storage
-40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 3.28 feet
(1 m) to concrete
Vibration
5G Peak from 22Hz to 300Hz
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 15kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CCB01-010BT-BF Charge Base Product Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
3.2 inches (81.3mm)
Length
5.19 inches (131.8mm)
Width
3.98 inches (101.1mm)
Weight
6.3 oz (179g)
Electrical
Voltage:
4.5 to 5.5 volts
Current Draw:
Host Terminal Port
500mA
Aux Power Port
1A
Charge Time
From shut down to fully charged:
3 minutes via standard USB only
1 minute via powered USB with external power
Radio
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping
Bluetooth v.4.2
Range
33 ft. (10 m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 130 kbps
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C)
Battery Charge
32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C)
Storage without battery
-40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 3.28 feet
(1 m) to concrete
Vibration
5G Peak from 22Hz to 300Hz
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 15kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Industrial
Charge Base Product Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Mechanical
Height
2.6 in. (66mm)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
305
Parameter (Continued)
Specification
Length
9.8 in. (248.9mm)
Width
4.05 in. (102.9cm)
Weight
10.05 oz. (285g)
Electrical
Voltage:
4.5 to 5.5 volts
Current Draw:
Host Terminal Port
500mA
Aux Power Port
1A
Charge Time
5 hours
Radio
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency Hopping
Bluetooth v.2.1
Range
330 ft. (100m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 1 MBps
Environmental
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
-4 F to +122 F (-20 C to +50 C)
Battery Charge
41 F to +104 F (5 C to +40 C)
Storage without battery
-40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 3.94 feet
(1.2m) to concrete
Vibration
Complies with MIL-STD-810G, Method 514.6,
Annex C
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 20kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
Depth of Field Charts
Xenon B&W Scanner Typical Performance
Focus
High Density (HD)
Standard Range (SR)
Extended Range (ER)
Symbology
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
in.
.2
3.8
1.6
5.3
3.7
8
mm
5.1
96.5
40.6
134.6
94
203.2
in.
.5
6.5
.3
16.7
1
20.7
mm
12.7
165.1
7.6
424.2
25.4
525.8
5 mil Code 39
13 mil UPC
306
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Focus (Continued)
High Density (HD)
Standard Range (SR)
Extended Range (ER)
Symbology (Continued)
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
20 mil Code 39
in.
.6
8.6
.4
24.6
1
23.5
mm
15.2
218.4
10.2
624.8
25.4
596.9
in.
.4
4
.7
6
2.8
9.2
mm
10.2
101.6
17.8
152.4
71.1
233.7
in.
.3
4.2
.8
7
2.5
11.3
mm
7.6
106.7
20.3
177.8
63.5
287
in.
.7
7
.5
14.8
.7
19
mm
17.8
177.8
12.7
375.9
17.8
482.6
6.7 mil PDF417
10 mil Data Matrix
20 mil QR Code
Resolution (1D Code 39)
3 mil (.076mm)
5 mil (.127mm)
5 mil (.127mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
5 mil (.127mm)
6.7 mil (.170mm)
7.5 mil (.191mm)
Xenon B&W Scanner Guaranteed Performance
Focus
High Density (HD)
Standard Range (SR)
Extended Range (ER)
Symbology
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
Near
Distance
Far
Distance
in.
.3
3.3
2.1
5.1
4.2
7.8
mm
7.62
83.8
53.3
129.5
106.7
198.1
in.
.7
6.1
.4
15.6
1.1
19.7
mm
17.8
154.9
10.2
396.2
27.9
500.4
in.
.7
7.8
.5
20.2
1.5
25
mm
17.8
198.1
12.7
513.1
38.1
635
in.
.5
3.8
.9
5.8
3.3
8.7
mm
12.7
96.5
22.9
147.3
83.8
221
in.
.4
3.8
.9
6.6
3.4
10.3
mm
10.2
96.5
22.9
167.6
86.4
261.6
in.
1.2
6.4
.7
13
.9
18
mm
30.5
162.6
17.8
330.2
22.9
457.2
5 mil Code 39
13 mil UPC
20 mil Code 39
6.7 mil PDF417
10 mil Data Matrix
20 mil QR Code
Resolution (1D Code 39)
3 mil (.076mm)
5 mil (.127mm)
5 mil (.127mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
5 mil (.127mm)
6.7 mil (.170mm)
7.5 mil (.191mm)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
307
Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Typical Performance
Focus
High Density (HD)
Standard Range (SR)
Symbology
Near
Distance
Far Distance
Near Distance
Far Distance
in.
0
3.6
1.1
5.2
mm
0
91.4
27.9
132.1
in.
.4
5.9
.4
16.2
mm
10.2
149.9
10.2
411.5
in.
.4
8.4
.5
22
mm
10.2
213.4
12.7
558.8
in.
0
3.8
.4
6
mm
0
96.5
10.2
152.4
in.
0
4.2
.5
7
mm
0
106.7
12.7
177.8
in.
.4
6.8
.6
13.4
mm
10.2
172.7
15.2
340.4
5 mil Code 39
13 mil UPC
20 mil Code 39
6.7 mil PDF417
10 mil Data Matrix
20 mil QR Code
Resolution (1D Code 39)
3 mil (.076mm)
5 mil (.127mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
5 mil (.127mm)
6.7 mil (.170mm)
Xenon Color Scanner (Model COL) Guaranteed Performance
Focus
High Density (HD)
Standard Range (SR)
Symbology
Near
Distance
Far Distance
Near
Distance
Far Distance
in.
0
3.3
1.7
4.9
mm
0
83.8
43.2
124.5
in.
.6
5.2
.4
14.5
mm
15.2
132.1
10.2
368.3
in.
.5
7.4
.5
17.5
mm
12.7
188
12.7
444.5
in.
0
3.4
.5
5.7
mm
0
86.4
12.7
144.8
in.
0
4
.8
6.4
mm
0
101.6
20.3
162.6
in.
.7
6.2
.7
12.3
mm
17.8
157.5
17.8
312.4
5 mil Code 39
13 mil UPC
20 mil Code 39
6.7 mil PDF417
10 mil Data Matrix
20 mil QR Code
Resolution (1D Code 39)
3 mil (.076mm)
5 mil (.127mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
5 mil (.127mm)
6.7 mil (.170mm)
308
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Typical Performance
Focus
Extended Range (ER)
Symbology
Near Distance
Far Distance
in.
3.6
7.4
mm
91.4
188
in.
.6
29.5
mm
15.2
749.3
in.
.6
21.4
mm
15.2
543.6
in.
2.7
8.9
mm
68.6
226.1
in.
2.8
10.3
mm
71.1
261.6
in.
.8
19.5
mm
20.3
495.3
5 mil Code 39
20 mil Code 39
100% UPC
6.7 mil PDF417
10 mil Data Matrix
20 mil QR Code
Resolution (1D Code 39)
5 mil (.127mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
7.5 mil (.191mm)
Granit 1910i/1911i Scanner Guaranteed Performance
Focus
Extended Range (ER)
Symbology
Near Distance
Far Distance
in.
3.8
7.2
mm
96.5
182.9
in.
1
28.7
mm
25.4
729
in.
.6
21.7
mm
15.2
551.2
in.
3
8.5
mm
76.2
215.9
in.
3.1
9.7
mm
78.7
246.4
in.
.9
19.8
mm
22.9
502.9
5 mil Code 39
20 mil Code 39
100% UPC
6.7 mil PDF417
10 mil Data Matrix
20 mil QR Code
Resolution (1D Code 39)
5 mil (.127mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
7.5 mil (.191mm)
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
309
Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Typical Performance (200 lux)
Focus
Full Range (FR)
Symbology
Near Distance
Far Distance
in.
3.9
64.9
cm
10.0
164.9
in.
3.9
85.0
cm
10.0
216.0
in.
6.0
171.1
cm
15.2
434.5
in.
14.3
389.4
cm
36.4
989.1
in.
20.6
521.0
cm
52.2
1322.4
in.
40.7
more than 629.9
cm
103.4
more than 1600.0
in.
4.8
90.5
cm
12.2
229.8
in.
3.9
29.9
cm
10.0
75.9
in.
3.9
40.3
cm
10.0
102.3
in.
16.9
232.8
cm
42.8
591.3
in.
31.8
406.5
cm
80.7
1032.5
7.5 mil Code 39
10 mil Code 39
20 mil Code 39
40 mil Code 39
55 mil Code 39
100 mil Code 39
100% UPC
7.5 mil Data Matrix
10 mil Data Matrix
55 mil Data Matrix
100 mil Data Matrix
Resolution (1D Code 39)
2 mil (.051mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
2 mil (.051mm)
Granit 1980i/1981i Scanner Guaranteed Performance (200 lux)
Focus
Full Range (FR)
Symbology
Near Distance
Far Distance
in.
3.9
62.4
cm
10.0
158.6
in.
3.9
82.1
cm
10.0
208.6
in.
6.2
165.8
cm
15.8
421.2
7.5 mil Code 39
10 mil Code 39
20 mil Code 39
310
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Focus (Continued)
Full Range (FR)
Symbology (Continued)
Near Distance
Far Distance
in.
15
371.7
cm
38.1
944.1
in.
22.2
461.2
cm
56.5
1171.4
in.
47.5
more than 629.9
cm
120.7
more than 1600.0
in.
5.0
85.3
cm
12.7
216.7
in.
3.9
26.9
cm
10.0
68.3
in.
3.9
35.8
cm
10.0
90.8
in.
19.2
213.1
cm
48.7
541.2
in.
35.7
357.2
cm
90.6
907.3
40 mil Code 39
55 mil Code 39
100 mil Code 39
100% UPC
7.5 mil Data Matrix
10 mil Data Matrix
55 mil Data Matrix
100 mil Data Matrix
Resolution (1D Code 39)
2 mil (.051mm)
Resolution (2D Data Matrix)
2 mil (.051mm)
Standard Connector Pinouts
Note: The following pin assignments are not compatible with Honeywell legacy products.
Use of a cable with improper pin assignments may lead to damage to the unit. Use of
any cables not provided by the manufacturer may result in damage not covered by
your warranty.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
311
Keyboard Wedge
10 Pin RJ41 Modular Plug - connects to the base
1
Cable shield
2
Cable select
3
Supply ground
4
Terminal data
5
Terminal clock
6
Keyboard clock
7
+5V power
8
Keyboard data
9
10
Serial Output
10 Pin RJ41 Modular Plug - connects to the base
1
Cable shield
2
Cable select
3
Supply ground
4
Transmit data
5
Receive data - serial data to scanner
6
CTS
7
+5V power
8
RTS
9
10
RS485 Output
10 Pin RJ41 Modular Plug - connects to the base
Note: RS485 signal conversion is performed in the cable.
312
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
1
Cable shield
2
Cable select
3
Supply ground
4
Transmit data
5
Receive data - serial data to scanner
6
7
+5V power
8
Transmit Enable
9
10
USB
10 Pin Modular Plug - connects to the base
1
Cable shield
2
Cable select
3
Supply ground
4
5
6
7
+5V power
8
9
Data +
10 Data -
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
313
Required Safety Labels
Xenon 1900/1910/1902/1912 Scanner
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Illumination output
Part
Number,
Serial Number
and Revision
Information
location
314
Compliance
Label location
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CCB01-010BT/CCB01-010BT-BF Base
Part Number,
Serial
Number and
Revision
Information
location
Compliance Label
locations
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
315
Granit 1910i/1911i/1980i/1981i Scanner
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Illumination
output
Laser Label
location
Part Number, Serial
Number and
Revision
Information location
316
Compliance
label location
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base
Compliance
Label locations
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
317
318
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CHAPTER
14
MAINTENANCE AND
TROUBLESHOOTING
Repairs
Repairs and/or upgrades are not to be performed on this product. These services
are to be performed only by an authorized service center (see Customer Support on
page xvii).
Maintenance
Your device provides reliable and efficient operation with a minimum of care.
Although specific maintenance is not required, the following periodic checks
ensure dependable operation:
Cleaning the Scanner
The scanner or base’s housing may be cleaned with a soft cloth or tissue dampened with water (or a mild detergent-water solution.) If a detergent solution is
used, rinse with a clean tissue dampened with water only.
Caution: Do not submerge the scanner in water. The scanner’s housing is
not watertight. Do not use abrasive wipes or tissues on the
scanner’s window. Abrasive wipes may scratch the window.
Never use solvents (e.g., acetone) on the housing or window.
Solvents may damage the finish or the window.
Cleaning the Window
Reading performance may degrade if the scanner’s window is not clean. If the window is visibly dirty, or if the scanner isn’t operating well, clean the window with one
of the cleaning solutions listed for Health Care Housing, below.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
319
Health Care Housing
Some configurations of Xenon scanners are available with an external plastic
housing that is designed to resist the effects of harsh chemicals in a health care
environment. The plastic is crystalline in nature, which helps prevent chemicals
from seeping through the housing.
Important! The following cleaning solutions have been tested to assure safe cleaning of your scanner’s disinfectant-ready housing. They are the only solutions
approved for use with these scanners. Damage caused by the use of cleaners other
than those listed below may not be covered by the warranty.
•
®
Sani-Cloth® Plus wipes
Super Sani-Cloth® wipes
•
Isopropyl Alcohol wipes (70%)
•
CaviWipes
•
•
® 256
409® Glass and Surface Cleaner
Windex ® Blue
Clorox ® Bleach – 10%
•
Gentle dish soap and water
•
•
•
•
Sani-Cloth HB wipes
™
Virex
Inspecting Cords and Connectors
Inspect the interface cable and connector for wear or other signs of damage. A
badly worn cable or damaged connector may interfere with scanner operation.
Contact your distributor for information about cable replacement. Cable replacement instructions are on page 320.
Replacing Cables in Corded Scanners
The standard interface cable is attached to the scanner with an 10-pin modular
connector. When properly seated, the connector is held in the scanner’s handle by
a flexible retention tab. The interface cable is designed to be field replaceable.
320
•
Order replacement cables from Honeywell or from an authorized distributor.
•
When ordering a replacement cable, specify the cable part number of the
original interface cable.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Replacing a Xenon Interface Cable
1. Turn the power to the host system OFF.
2. Disconnect the scanner’s cable from the terminal
or computer.
3. Locate the small hole on the back of the scanner’s
handle. This is the cable release.
4. Straighten one end of a paper clip.
5. Insert the end of the paper clip into the small hole
and press in. This depresses the retention tab,
releasing the connector. Pull the connector out
while maintaining pressure on the paper clip, then
remove the paper clip.
Cable
Release
6. Replace with the new cable.
Insert the connector into the opening and press firmly. The connector is keyed
to go in only one way, and will click into place.
Replacing a Granit Interface Cable
1. Turn the power to the host system OFF.
2. Disconnect the scanner’s cable from the terminal or
computer.
3. Unscrew the locking plate on the bottom of the
scanner.
4. Slide the locking plate away from the connector and
pull the cable out of the scanner.
5. Replace with the new cable.
Insert the connector into the opening and press firmly.
6. Slide the locking plate over the base of the connector
to secure the cable, and screw the plate into place.
Replacing Cables and Batteries in Cordless Systems
Replacing an Interface Cable in a Base
1. Turn the power to the host system OFF.
2. Disconnect the base’s cable from the terminal or computer.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
321
3. Turn the base upside down.
4. Pull the connector out while maintaining pressure on the connector release
clip.
CCB01-010BT Base:
CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base:
5. Replace with the new cable.
Insert the connector into the opening and press firmly. The connector is keyed
to go in only one way, and will click into place.
Changing a Xenon Scanner Battery
End Cap
1. Use a Phillips head screwdriver to remove the screw from the end cap.
2. Remove the end cap and remove the battery from the handle.
3. Insert replacement battery.
4. Replace end cap and screw.
322
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Changing a Granit Scanner Battery
1. Twist the tab in the bottom of the end cap and open the hinged battery door.
(When new, the battery door may stick. Use pliers to twist the tab and open the
door until it loosens up.)
2. Remove the battery from the handle.
3. Insert replacement battery.
4. Close the battery door and twist the tab to lock it.
Note: The battery door is designed to pop off the hinge if the scanner is dropped while
changing a battery. If this occurs, simply snap it back on.
Troubleshooting a Corded Scanner
The scanner automatically performs self-tests whenever you turn it on. If your
scanner is not functioning properly, review the following Troubleshooting Guide to
try to isolate the problem.
Is the power on? Is the aimer on?
If the aimer isn’t illuminated, check that:
•
The cable is connected properly.
•
The host system power is on (if external power isn’t used).
•
The trigger works.
Is the scanner having trouble reading your symbols?
If the scanner isn’t reading symbols well, check that the symbols:
•
Aren’t smeared, rough, scratched, or exhibiting voids.
•
Aren’t coated with frost or water droplets on the surface.
•
Are enabled in the scanner or in the decoder to which the scanner connects.
Is the bar code displayed but not entered?
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
323
The bar code is displayed on the host device correctly, but you still have to press a
key to enter it (the Enter/Return key or the Tab key, for example).
•
You need to program a suffix. Programming a suffix enables the scanner to
output the bar code data plus the key you need (such as “CR”) to enter the data
into your application. Refer to Prefix/Suffix Overview on page 151 for further
information.
The scanner won’t read your bar code at all.
1. Scan the sample bar codes in the back of this manual. If the scanner reads the
sample bar codes, check that your bar code is readable.
Verify that your bar code symbology is enabled (see Chapter 9).
2. If the scanner still can’t read the sample bar codes, scan All Symbologies
On, page 178.
If you aren’t sure what programming options have been set in the scanner, or if you
want the factory default settings restored, refer to Reset the Factory Defaults on
page 257.
Troubleshooting a Cordless System
Troubleshooting a Base
Note: Visit the Services and Support section of our website (www.honeywellaidc.com) to
check for the latest software for both the scanner and the base.
If your base is not functioning properly, review the following troubleshooting
guidelines to try to isolate the problem.
Is the red LED on?
If the red LED isn’t illuminated, check that:
•
The power cable is connected properly and there is power at the power source.
•
The host system power is on (if external power isn’t used).
Is the green LED on?
If the green LED isn’t illuminated, check that:
324
•
The scanner is correctly placed in the base.
•
There is external power or 12 volt host power.
•
Charge mode is turned on. (See "Beeper and LED Sequences and Meaning" on
page 48)
•
The battery is not bad or deeply discharged. In some cases, the scanner’s battery
may trickle charge to bring it into an acceptable level and then transition to a
normal charge cycle.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Troubleshooting a Cordless Scanner
Note: Make sure that your scanner’s battery is charged.
Visit the Services and Support section of our website (www.honeywellaidc.com) to
check for the latest software for both the scanner and the base or Access Point.
Is the scanner having trouble reading your symbols?
If the scanner isn’t reading symbols well, check that the symbols:
•
Aren’t smeared, rough, scratched, or exhibiting voids.
•
Aren’t coated with frost or water droplets on the surface.
•
Are enabled in the base or Access Point to which the scanner connects.
Is the bar code displayed but not entered into the application?
The bar code is displayed on the host device correctly, but you still have to press a
key to enter it (the Enter/Return key or the Tab key, for example).
•
You need to program a suffix. Programming a suffix enables the scanner to
output the bar code data plus the key you need (such as “CR”) to enter the data
into your application. Refer to Prefix/Suffix Overview on page 151 for further
information.
The scanner won’t read your bar code at all.
•
Scan the sample bar codes in the back of this manual. If the scanner reads the
sample bar codes, check that your bar code is readable.
•
Verify that your bar code symbology is enabled (see Chapter 9).
•
If the scanner still can’t read the sample bar codes, scan All Symbologies on
page 178.
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
325
326
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
APPENDIX
A
REFERENCE CHARTS
Symbology Charts
Note: “m” represents the AIM modifier character. Refer to International Technical
Specification, Symbology Identifiers, for AIM modifier character details.
Prefix /Suffix entries for specific symbologies override the universal (All Symbologies,
99) entry.
Refer to Data Edit beginning on page 151 and Data Format beginning on page 157
for information about using Code ID and AIM ID.
Linear Symbologies
AIM
Symbology
ID
Honeywell
Possible modifiers
(m)
ID
All Symbologies
Hex
99
Codabar
]Fm
Code 11
]H3
Code 128
]Cm
Code 32 Pharmaceutical (PARAF)
]X0
Code 39 (supports Full ASCII mode)
]Am
TCIF Linked Code 39 (TLC39)
]L2
0-1
0, 1, 2, 4
0, 1, 3, 4, 5, 7
a
61
h
68
j
6A
<
3C
b
62
T
54
Code 93 and 93i
]Gm
0-9, A-Z,
a-m
i
69
EAN
]Em
0, 1, 3, 4
d
64
EAN-13 (including Bookland EAN)
]E0
d
64
EAN-13 with Add-On
]E3
d
64
EAN-13 with Extended Coupon Code
]E3
d
64
EAN-8
]E4
D
44
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
327
AIM
Symbology
ID
EAN-8 with Add-On
Honeywell
Possible modifiers
(m)
]E3
ID
Hex
D
44
y
79
GS1
GS1 DataBar
]em
GS1 DataBar Limited
]em
{
7B
GS1 DataBar Expanded
]em
}
7D
GS1-128
]C1
I
49
China Post (Hong Kong 2 of 5)
]X0
Q
51
Interleaved 2 of 5
]Im
e
65
Matrix 2 of 5
]X0
m
6D
NEC 2 of 5
]X0
Y
59
Straight 2 of 5 IATA
]Rm
f
66
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial
]S0
f
66
g
67
t
74
0
2 of 5
MSI
]Mm
Telepen
]Bm
UPC
0, 1, 3
0, 1, 3
0, 1
0, 1, 2, 3, 8, 9, A, B, C
UPC-A
]E0
c
63
UPC-A with Add-On
]E3
c
63
UPC-A with Extended Coupon Code
]E3
c
63
UPC-E
]E0
E
45
UPC-E with Add-On
]E3
E
45
UPC-E1
]X0
E
45
Add Honeywell Code ID
5C80
Add AIM Code ID
5C81
Add Backslash
5C5C
Batch mode quantity
5
35
2D Symbologies
AIM
Symbology
ID
Honeywell
Possible modifiers
(m)
ID
All Symbologies
Aztec Code
328
Hex
99
]zm
0-9, A-C
z
7A
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
AIM
Symbology
ID
Chinese Sensible Code (Han Xin Code)
]X0
Codablock A
]O6
Codablock F
Honeywell
Possible modifiers
(m)
ID
Hex
H
48
0, 1, 4, 5, 6
V
56
]Om
0, 1, 4, 5, 6
q
71
Code 49
]Tm
0, 1, 2, 4
l
6C
Data Matrix
]dm
0-6
w
77
GS1
]em
0-3
y
79
GS1 Composite
]em
0-3
y
79
GS1 DataBar Omnidirectional
]em
0-3
y
79
MaxiCode
]Um
0-3
x
78
PDF417
]Lm
0-2
r
72
]Lm
0-5
R
52
]Qm
0-6
s
73
]Qm
s
73
AIM
Honeywell
MicroPDF417
QR Code
Micro QR Code
Postal Symbologies
Symbology
ID
Possible modifiers
(m)
ID
All Symbologies
Hex
99
Australian Post
]X0
A
41
British Post
]X0
B
42
Canadian Post
]X0
C
43
China Post
]X0
Q
51
InfoMail
]X0
,
2c
Intelligent Mail Bar Code
]X0
M
4D
Japanese Post
]X0
J
4A
KIX (Netherlands) Post
]X0
K
4B
Korea Post
]X0
?
3F
Planet Code
]X0
L
4C
Postal-4i
]X0
N
4E
Postnet
]X0
P
50
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
329
ASCII Conversion Chart (Code Page 1252)
In keyboard applications, ASCII Control Characters can be represented in 3 different ways, as shown below. The CTRL+X function is OS and application dependent.
The following table lists some commonly used Microsoft functionality. This table
applies to U.S. style keyboards. Certain characters may differ depending on your
Country Code/PC regional settings.
Non-printable
ASCII
control characters
DEC
330
HEX
Char
Keyboard Control + ASCII (CTRL+X) Mode
Control + X Mode Off
(KBDCAS0)
Windows Mode Control + X
Mode On (KBDCAS2)
CTRL + X
CTRL + X
function
0
00
NUL
Reserved
CTRL+ @
1
01
SOH
NP Enter
CTRL+ A
2
02
STX
Caps Lock
CTRL+ B
Bold
3
03
ETX
ALT Make
CTRL+ C
Copy
4
04
EOT
ALT Break
CTRL+ D
Bookmark
5
05
ENQ
CTRL Make
CTRL+ E
Center
6
06
ACK
CTRL Break
CTRL+ F
Find
7
07
BEL
Enter / Ret
CTRL+ G
8
08
BS
(Apple Make)
CTRL+ H
9
09
HT
Tab
CTRL+ I
Italic
10
0A
LF
(Apple Break)
CTRL+ J
Justify
11
0B
VT
Tab
CTRL+ K
hyperlink
CTRL+ L
list,
left align
Select all
History
12
0C
FF
Delete
13
0D
CR
Enter / Ret
CTRL+ M
14
0E
SO
Insert
CTRL+ N
New
15
0F
SI
ESC
CTRL+ O
Open
16
10
DLE
F11
CTRL+ P
Print
17
11
DC1
Home
CTRL+ Q
Quit
18
12
DC2
PrtScn
CTRL+ R
19
13
DC3
Backspace
CTRL+ S
20
14
DC4
Back Tab
CTRL+ T
21
15
NAK
F12
CTRL+ U
22
16
SYN
F1
CTRL+ V
23
17
ETB
F2
CTRL+ W
24
18
CAN
F3
CTRL+ X
25
19
EM
F4
CTRL+ Y
26
1A
SUB
F5
CTRL+ Z
27
1B
ESC
F6
CTRL+ [
28
1C
FS
F7
CTRL+ \
29
1D
GS
F8
CTRL+ ]
30
1E
RS
F9
CTRL+ ^
31
1F
US
F10
CTRL+ -
127
7F
⌂
NP Enter
Save
Paste
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Lower ASCII Reference Table
Note: Windows Code page 1252 and lower ASCII use the same characters.
Printable Characters
DEC
HEX
Character
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
2A
2B
2C
2D
2E
2F
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
3F
<SPACE>
!
"
#
$
%
&
'
(
)
*
+
,
.
/
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
:
;
<
=
>
?
DEC
HEX
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
4A
4B
4C
4D
4E
4F
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
5A
5B
5C
5D
5E
5F
Extended ASCII Characters
DEC
HEX
CP 1252 ASCII
Character DEC
@
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
[
\
]
^
_
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
Alternate Extended
HEX
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
up arrow ↑
0x48
ü
down arrow ↓
0x50
‚
é
right arrow →
0x4B
83
ƒ
â
left arrow ←
0x4D
84
85
86
87
88
89
8A
8B
„
…
†
‡
ˆ
‰
Š
‹
ä
à
å
ç
ê
ë
è
ï
Insert
Delete
Home
End
Page Up
Page Down
Right ALT
Right CTRL
0x52
0x53
0x47
0x4F
0x49
0x51
0x38
0x1D
80
129
81
130
82
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
€
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
`
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
h
i
j
k
l
m
n
o
p
q
r
s
t
u
v
w
x
y
z
{
|
}
~
⌂
PS2 Scan Code
Ç
128
Character
331
Extended ASCII Characters (Continued)
DEC
HEX
CP 1252 ASCII
Alternate Extended
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
332
8C
8D
8E
8F
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
9A
9B
9C
9D
9E
9F
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
AA
AB
AC
AD
AE
AF
B0
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
BA
BB
BC
BD
BE
BF
C0
C1
Œ
Ž
‘
’
“
”
•
–
—
˜
™
š
›
œ
ž
Ÿ
¡
¢
£
¤
¥
¦
§
¨
©
ª
«
¬
®
¯
°
±
²
³
´
µ
¶
·
¸
¹
º
»
¼
½
¾
¿
À
Á
î
ì
Ä
Å
É
æ
Æ
ô
ö
ò
û
ù
ÿ
Ö
Ü
¢
£
¥
₧
ƒ
á
í
ó
ú
ñ
Ñ
ª
º
¿
⌐
¬
½
¼
¡
«
»
░
▒
▓
│
┤
╡
╢
╖
╕
╣
║
╗
╝
╜
╛
┐
└
┴
Reserved
Reserved
Numeric Keypad Enter
Numeric Keypad /
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F9
F10
F11
F12
Numeric Keypad +
Numeric Keypad Numeric Keypad *
Caps Lock
Num Lock
Left Alt
Left Ctrl
Left Shift
Right Shift
Print Screen
Tab
Shift Tab
Enter
Esc
Alt Make
Alt Break
Control Make
Control Break
Alt Sequence with 1 Character
Ctrl Sequence with 1 Character
PS2 Scan Code
n/a
n/a
0x1C
0x35
0x3B
0x3C
0x3D
0x3E
0x3F
0x40
0x41
0x42
0x43
0x44
0x57
0x58
0x4E
0x4A
0x37
0x3A
0x45
0x38
0x1D
0x2A
0x36
n/a
0x0F
0x8F
0x1C
0x01
0x36
0xB6
0x1D
0x9D
0x36
0x1D
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Extended ASCII Characters (Continued)
DEC
HEX
CP 1252 ASCII
Alternate Extended
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
240
241
242
243
244
245
246
247
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
CA
CB
CC
CD
CE
CF
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
DA
DB
DC
DD
DE
DF
E0
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
E6
E7
E8
E9
EA
EB
EC
ED
EE
EF
F0
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
Â
Ã
Ä
Å
Æ
Ç
È
É
Ê
Ë
Ì
Í
Î
Ï
Ð
Ñ
Ò
Ó
Ô
Õ
Ö
×
Ø
Ù
Ú
Û
Ü
Ý
Þ
ß
à
á
â
ã
ä
å
æ
ç
è
é
ê
ë
ì
í
î
ï
ð
ñ
ò
ó
ô
õ
ö
÷
PS2 Scan Code
┬
├
─
í
╞
╟
╚
╔
╩
╦
╠
═
╬
╧
╨
╤
╥
╙
╘
╒
╓
╫
╪
┘
┌
█
▄
▌
▐
▀
α
ß
Γ
π
Σ
σ
µ
τ
Φ
Θ
Ω
δ
∞
φ
ε
∩
≡
±
≥
≤
⌠
⌡
÷
≈
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
333
Extended ASCII Characters (Continued)
DEC
HEX
CP 1252 ASCII
Alternate Extended
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
F8
F9
FA
FB
FC
FD
FE
FF
ø
ù
ú
û
ü
ý
þ
ÿ
PS2 Scan Code
°
·
·
√
ⁿ
²
■
ISO 2022/ISO 646 Character Replacements
Code pages define the mapping of character codes to characters. If the data
received does not display with the proper characters, it may be because the bar
code being scanned was created using a code page that is different from the one
the host program is expecting. If this is the case, select the code page with which
the bar codes were created. The data characters should then appear properly.
Standard
Keyboard
Country
Honeywell
Code
Page
Option
United States
(standard ASCII)
ISO/IEC 646-IRV
n/a
1
Automatic National Character
Replacement
ISO/IEC 2022
n/a
2 (default)
Binary Code page
n/a
n/a
3
Code Page Selection Method/
Country
Default “Automatic National Character replacement” will select the below Honeywell Code
Page options for Code128, Code 39 and Code 93.
334
United States
ISO/IEC 646-06
0
1
Canada
ISO /IEC 646-121
54
95
Canada
ISO /IEC 646-122
18
96
Japan
ISO/IEC 646-14
28
98
China
ISO/IEC 646-57
92
99
Great Britain (UK)
ISO /IEC 646-04
7
87
France
ISO /IEC 646-69
3
83
Germany
ISO/IEC646-21
4
84
Switzerland
ISO /IEC 646-CH
6
86
Sweden / Finland (extended Annex C)
ISO/IEC 646-11
2
82
Ireland
ISO /IEC 646-207
73
97
Denmark
ISO/IEC 646-08
8
88
Norway
ISO/IEC 646-60
9
94
Italy
ISO/IEC 646-15
5
85
Portugal
ISO/IEC 646-16
13
92
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Standard
Keyboard
Country
Honeywell
Code
Page
Option
Spain
ISO/IEC 646-17
10
90
Spain
ISO/IEC 646-85
51
91
Code Page Selection Method/
Country
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
335
64
91
92
93
94
96
123
124
125
126
Hex
23
24
40
5B
5C
5D
5E
60
7B
7C
7D
7E
US
0
1
#
$
@
[
\
]
^
`
{
|
}
~
CA
54
95
#
$
à
â
ç
ê
î
ô
é
ù
è
û
CA
18
96
#
$
à
â
ç
ê
É
ô
é
ù
è
û
JP
28
98
#
$
@
[
¥
]
^
`
{
|
}
⎯
CN
92
99
#
¥
@
[
\
]
^
`
{
|
}
⎯
GB
7
87
£
$
@
[
\
]
^
`
{
|
}
˜
FR
3
83
£
$
à
°
ç
§
^
µ
é
ù
è
¨
DE
4
84
#
$
§
Ä
Ö
Ü
^
`
ä
ö
ü
ß
CH
6
86
ù
$
à
é
ç
ê
î
ô
ä
ö
ü
û
SE/FI
2
82
#
¤
É
Ä
Ö
Å
Ü
é
ä
ö
å
ü
DK
8
88
#
$
@
Æ
Ø
Å
^
`
æ
ø
å
˜
NO
9
94
#
$
@
Æ
Ø
Å
^
`
æ
ø
å
¯
IE
73
97
£
$
Ó
É
Í
Ú
Á
ó
é
í
ú
á
IT
5
85
£
$
§
°
ç
é
^
ù
à
ò
è
ì
PT
13
92
#
$
§
Ã
Ç
Õ
^
`
ã
ç
õ
°
ES
10
90
#
$
§
¡
Ñ
¿
^
`
°
ñ
ç
˜
ES
51
91
#
$
·
¡
Ñ
Ç
¿
`
´
ñ
ç
¨
Honeywell
CodePage
36
Country
Keyboard
35
COUNTRY
Dec
336
ISO / IEC 646 National Character Replacements
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Keyboard Key References
6E
70 71 72 73
74 75 76 77
78 79 7A 7B
7C 7D 7E
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0F
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D
1E 1F 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2B
4B 50 55
4C 51 56
2C 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
39
3D
3A 3B 3C
3E 3F 38 40
53
4F 54 59
5A 5F
5B 60
5C 61
5D 62
63
64 69
65
6A
66
67
6C
68
5A 5F
5B 60
5C 61
5D 62
63
64 69
65
6A
66
67
6C
68
104 Key U.S. Style Keyboard
6E
70 71 72 73
74 75 76 77
78 79 7A 7B
7C 7D 7E
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0F
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1A 1B 1C 2B
1E 1F 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2A
4B 50 55
4C 51 56
2C 2D 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
39
3D
3A 3B 3C
3E 3F 38 40
53
4F 54 59
105 Key European Style Keyboard
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
337
338
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Sample Symbols
UPC-A
Interleaved 2 of 5
0 123456 7890
01234567890
EAN-13
9 780330 290951
Code 128
Code 39
Code 128
BC321
Codabar
A13579B
Code 93
Straight 2 of 5 Industrial
123456-9$
123456
Matrix 2 of 5
6543210
RSS-14
PDF417
(01) 00123456789012
Car Registration
Code 49
1234567890
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
339
Sample Symbols (Continued)
Postnet
Data Matrix
Zip Code
Test Symbol
QR Code
Numbers
MaxiCode
Micro PDF417
Test Message
Test Message
340
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Programming Chart
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
341
Programming Chart (Continued)
A
B
C
D
E
F
Save
Discard
Reset
Note: If you make an error while scanning the letters or digits (before scanning Save), scan
Discard, scan the correct letters or digits, and Save again.
342
Xenon/Granit User Guide
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
SCANNING & MOBILITY
CBL-020-300-C00
Cable for product :
Description:
Interface:
Connector A:
Connector B:
Connector C:
Cable length:
Generic HSM – bar code scanner
Standard Serial RS232 DB9 Female coiled
RS232 TTL (5V)
Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like)
Molded DB9 - Female
STD HSM Power link 5V (DC Jack with shunt)
2.80 meter (retracted ~1.35 m)
Max extended
Pin assignment
Connector assignment
Connector A
Connector B
NOTE:
· WARNING: connecting to 12V host powered systems with these cables will damage
the 5V-only scanner when the External Power (PSU) is disconnected from con. C.
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental,
consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including,
without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been
specifically advised of the possibility of such damages .
Document Revision: 1.3
Last updated June 7, 2011
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Scanning & Mobility
CBL-020-500-C00
Cable for:
Description:
Interface:
Connector A:
Connector B:
Connector C:
Xenon 190x series, Hyperion 1300g, Voyager 12xx, Voyager 14xx,
Granit 19xxi,
Serial 9pin sub D – FEMALE, coiled, black (standard PC)
232TTL, 5VDC
RJ41 10pin modular
DB9 female
Powerlink 5V DC
Cable length retracted: minimum ~ 1 m
Cable length extended: minimum ~ 5 m
This is an entry from the Honeywell Scanning and Mobility Knowledge base. As part of our ongoing effort to improve and enhance the quality of
the solutions, we ask you to inform us if you feel that we can improve on the content of this solution.Please send an email to:
[email protected]
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Molded RJ41 - 10pin modular
DB9 female
This is an entry from the Honeywell Scanning and Mobility Knowledge base. As part of our ongoing effort to improve and enhance the quality of
the solutions, we ask you to inform us if you feel that we can improve on the content of this solution.Please send an email to:
[email protected]
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
SCANNING & MOBILITY
CBL-220-300-C00
Cable for product :
Description:
Interface:
Connector A:
Connector B:
Connector C:
Cable length:
Generic HSM – bar code scanner
Serial RS232 DB9 Male coiled (Wincor / Toshiba ECR’s)
RS232 TTL (5V)
Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like)
Molded DB9 - Male
STD HSM Power link 5V (DC Jack with shunt)
2.80 meter (retracted ~1.35 m)
Max extended
Pin assignment
Connector assignment
Connector A
Connector B
NOTE:
· WARNING: connecting to 12V host powered systems with these cables will damage
the 5V-only scanner when the External Power (PSU) is disconnected from con. C.
· Former part number: 42206454-01E.
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental,
consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including,
without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been
specifically advised of the possibility of such damages .
Document Revision: 1.3
Last updated June 7, 2011
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
SCANNING & MOBILITY
CBL-500-300-S00
Cable for product :
Description:
Interface:
Connector A:
Connector B:
Cable length:
Generic HSM – bar code scanner
Standard 3 Meter straight USB cable – Type A
USB
Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like)
Molded USB Type A
~3.00 meter
Max extended
Pin assignment
Connector assignment
Connector A
Connector B
NOTE:
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental,
consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including,
without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been
specifically advised of the possibility of such damages .
Document Revision: 1.3
Last updated June 7, 2011
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
SCANNING & MOBILITY
CBL-503-300-S00
Cable for product :
Description:
Interface:
Connector A:
Connector B:
Cable length:
Generic HSM – bar code scanner
3 Meter straight USB Power Plus cable
USB
Molded 10 Pin Modular (RJ50 like)
USB Plus Power (12V)
~3.00 meter
Max extended
Pin assignment
Connector assignment
Connector A
Connector B
NOTE:
Uses strictly the 5V (pin 1 to 4) lower USB connector, (Teal) Plus power connector suits 12 volt
socket only.
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental,
consequential or other damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including,
without limitation, any lost profits, business interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been
specifically advised of the possibility of such damages .
Document Revision: 1.3
Last updated June 7, 2011
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
SCANNING & MOBILITY
Holder-010-U
Granit 191X Wall Mount Holder Dimensional drawing
fig 1.
PN# has 2 components (1- plastic Ind. Cup and 2- set of Screws)
Fig 2.1 (front)
Although due to the angle, the official drawing isn't specific on this, the
screw holes are more or less vertically centered on the cup and therefore
~31.6 mm from both top or bottom.
Fig 3.1 (bottom)
Fig 2.2 detail
Fig 3.2 (side view - wall mounted)
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other
damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business
interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages
Document Revision: 1.0
Last updated October 8, 2015
Author: E411793
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
SCANNING & MOBILITY
Fig 4. (Height / Width in mm)
Honeywell currently doesn't provide mounting guidance / measurements for the HOLDER-10-U
and hence the support team provides below some rough guidance on the required space for
mounting.
Fig 5. indicational drawing for required space
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other
damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business
interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages
Document Revision: 1.0
Last updated October 8, 2015
Author: E411793
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Se n s i n g a n d P r o d u c t i v i t y So l u t i o n s
VMHOLDERK - Vehicle Mount Holder Kit
The Vehicle Mount Holder kit, is a kit that includes all that is needed to have a holder to rest the scanner
in, when it is not used. The intention is that the operator can quickly put the scanner in to the holder, and
get it out again. The adjustable joint allows mounting the holder in a way the scanner will not fall out the
holder, when the vehicle it is mounted to, encounters bumps and sills on its way.
The kit is packed in a white box with label;
 BOX, MOTTLED WHITE W/O LOGO
size 7.625 x 4 x 3.25
with label;
 LABEL, AGENCY PKG LABEL
(The standard 4" x 2" Honeywell box label 'J" with item
barcode, description en BOM rev indication)
It includes the following parts:

BRACKET, 3800I VEHICLE MT HOLDER,
PN# 100003664 -->

MOUNTING BRKET SMALL 7400VB, RAM-B-101U,
PN# 8000046 -->

SCREW ASSEMBLY FOR VMHOLDERE
4 screws in a plastic bag
PN# 50111876-001 --> 10-32 Philips, black zinc, 0.375
NOTE: Granit housing is not hold as tight by the holder as the original 3800i,4800i, IT5800 housings did
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other
damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business
interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages
Document Revision: 1.0
Last updated January 26, 2016
Author: E411793
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Se n s i n g a n d P r o d u c t i v i t y So l u t i o n s
Measurements: BRACKET, 3800I VEHICLE MT HOLDER PN# 100003664
Measurements: MOUNTING BRKET SMALL 7400VB, RAM-B-101U (adjustable mount) PN# 8000046
Under no circumstances will Honeywell International Inc. be liable to any person or business entity for any direct, indirect, special, incidental, consequential or other
damages based on any use of the information in this document or any other linked or referenced document, including, without limitation, any lost profits, business
interruption, or loss of programs or information, even if Honeywell International Inc. has been specifically advised of the possibility of such damages
Document Revision: 1.0
Last updated January 26, 2016
Author: E411793
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
INSTALLATION & MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS
TOOL BALANCER
MOUNT
REEL
'�@
NOTE:
Disregard this
step if reel is
pre-mounted to
Torq-Arm or other
equipment.
Mount reel to
secure structure
directly above
work.
ATTACH
TOOL
�&)
Raise tool and
attach to hook on
end of cable.
j
CAUTION:
Do not pull cable
down. It is spring
loaded and could
cause injury if
allowed to snap
back.
Be sure tool
is securely
hooked to
cable. Do not
drop tool. Tool
may be heavier
than spring can
lift before spring
is adjusted.
ADJUST TOOL
HEIGHT
�(8
Determine ideal height
for tool when tool is
not being used.
(DCAUTION
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Access Point 
AP-010BT/AP-100BT
Quick Start Guide
Aller à www.honeywellaidc.com pour le français.
Vai a www.honeywellaidc.com per l'italiano.
Gehe zu www.honeywellaidc.com für Deutsch.
Ir a www.honeywellaidc.com para español.
Idź na stronę : www.honeywellaidc.com po quick start w języku polskim.
Перейти на русскоязычный сайт www.honeywellaidc.com.
Pro češtinu jdi na www.honeywellaidc.com.
Pre slovenčinu choď na www.honeywellaidc.com
Para Português, acesse www.honeywellaidc.com.br.
日本語 : www.honeywellaidc.com をご覧ください。
如要到中国 www.honeywellaidc.com(简体)。
查看繁体版请登陆 www.honeywellaidc.com
한글 www.honeywellaidc.com 로 이동합니다 .
.www.honeywellaidc.com ʺʡʥʺʫʡʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤʸʺʠʬʸʥʡʲˬʺʩʸʡʲʡʤʱʸʢʬ
¬íéÑõàÇ ¬úàà www.honeywellaidc.com ˆàÅ á´èäÇ
Rev E
7/15
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Connecting the Access Point
Note: Refer to your User’s Guide at www.honeywellaidc.com to
determine which Access Point model is compatible with your
scanner.
1. Slide the O-ring into the groove in the connector.
Note: If you choose not to install the O-ring, the Access Point will be
rated to IP41, instead of IP54.
2. Plug the interface cable into the Access Point first and then into
the appropriate port on the computer. The Page button blinks
when the Access Point is first connected to the host.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
3. Turn on the computer (laptop/desktop).
USB Connection:
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
RS232 Connection:
RS485 Connection:
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Keyboard Wedge Connection:
Linking a Scanner
4. Scan the linking bar code on the top of the Access
Point to establish a connection between the
Access Point and the scanner. 

The scanner emits a short beep and flashes the
green LED to confirm a connection with the
Access Point. The Access Point’s Page button
light turns solid blue.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Linking a 4820 Scanner
5. Remove the 4820 Linking bar code from the Access Point kit and
attach it to the Access Point. Scan the 4820 Linking bar code to
establish a connection between the Access Point and the 4820
scanner. The scanner emits a short beep and flashes the green
LED to confirm a connection with the Access Point. The Access
Point’s Page button remains blue. If you have difficulty
connecting with your 4820, it may be due to Code XML software
in your scanner. Scan the following bar code, then scan the 4820
Linking bar code. These steps may resolve this connection
problem.
Code XML Off
Managing Connections
Auto Reconnect Mode
By default, the Access Point is set to Auto Reconnect On, so
the scanner begins the relink process immediately, when a connection to the Access Point is lost. If you do not want to relink
automatically, scan the Auto Reconnect Off bar code.
* Auto Reconnect On
Auto Reconnect Off
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Changing Batteries
If the scanner turns off due to a low battery, you can change the
battery without losing the link with the Access Point, provided
the scanner is in range. A few seconds after the scanner powers up, the scanner relinks to the Access Point. Refer to your
User’s Guide at www.honeywellaidc.com for additional information about charging the batteries.
Low Power Mode
When there is no activity within a specified time period, the
scanner enters a low power mode. The default time out period
is one hour. Press the scanner’s trigger to power the scanner
back up. If the scanner was linked to the Access Point when it
went to “sleep,” it will re-link as long as it is in range.
If multiple scanners use the same Access Point, it is possible to
inadvertently unlink a scanner that is in “sleep” mode, that has a
dead battery, or is in the process of getting a new battery. To
prevent this from happening, you can disable the sleep mode
(time out) by scanning the No Time Out bar code below.
No Time Out (0)
Unlinking the Scanner from Access Point
If you know that your scanner is not going to be used for a while,
you can unlink the scanner by scanning the Unlink Scanner
bar code below.
Unlink Scanner
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Page Button
Note: This feature does not apply to 4820 scanners.
When you press the Page button on the
Access Point, the scanners associated
with that Access Point will begin beeping
(3 short and 1 long beep). If you press the
trigger on a scanner that is beeping in
response, or press the Page button on the
Access Point a second time, all associated scanners will stop beeping.
Page
button
LED Dimmer
Scan a bar code to set the brightness of your Page button.
LED Dimmer Off
LED Dimmer - Low
LED Dimmer - Bright
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Adding Carriage Return Suffix
If you want a carriage return (CR) to display after the bar code data
on your output, scan the Add CR Suffix bar code below. Scan the
Clear All Suffixes bar code to remove suffixes.
Add CR Suffix
Clear All Suffixes
Standard Product Defaults
This bar code resets all standard product default settings.
Note: Resetting standard defaults disconnects the scanner from the
Access Point. Scan the Linking bar code to re-establish a
connection. Refer to your User’s Guide at
www.honeywellaidc.com for additional information about
product defaults.
Standard Product Default Settings
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Additional Programming
The Access Point has all the programming capability of a Cordless
Charge Base. Refer to Cordless System Operation information in
your User’s Guide at www.honeywellaidc.com for programming
information.
Required Safety Labels
Label location for item number, serial
number, revision information, compliance, and safety information
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Product Specifications
Parameter
Specification
Dimensions (Typical):
Height
1.1 inch (28mm)
Length
4.3 inches (109mm)
Width
2.8 inches (71mm)
Weight
2.3 ounces (66g)
Voltage Requirements
5 VDC + 0.5V
Current Draw
100mA @ 5 volts typical
300mA @ 5 volts maximum
Temperature Ranges:
Operating
32 F to +122 F (0 C to +50 C)
Storage
-40 F to +158 F (-40 C to +70 C)
Radio:
Frequency
2.4 to 2.5 GHz (ISM Band) Frequency
Hopping Bluetooth v.2.1
Range - AP-010BT
33 ft. (10m) typical
Range - AP-100BT
328 ft. (100m) typical
Data Rate
Up to 1MBps
Humidity
5 to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from 3.28 feet 
(1 m) to concrete
Vibration
5G Peak from 22Hz to 300Hz
ESD Sensitivity
Up to 15kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Technical Assistance
Contact information for technical support and product service can be
found at www.honeywellaidc.com.
Limited Warranty
Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/warranty_information for your
product’s warranty information.
Disclaimer
Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in
specifications and other information contained in this document without prior
notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether
any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does
not represent a commitment on the part of HII.
HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained
herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material.
This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied,
reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII.
 2010-2015 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved.
Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Charge-Only Base
COB02
Installation Guide
Rev B
9/15
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Introduction
Honeywell’s Charge-Only Base can fully charge an industrial
wireless area-imaging scanner in 5 hours, maximizing uptime in any
application.
Note: When a scanner is placed into the Charge-Only Base, the
battery will charge. Please note that the Charge-Only Base
will not facilitate communication with the host system or other
scanners.
Installation
Connect the power adapter to the Charge-Only Base, then plug the
power supply into an AC power outlet. Make sure the AC power
outlet voltage is the same as the power supply.
Use only a Listed Limited Power Source (LPS) or Class 2 type
power supply with output rated 5 to 5.2Vdc, 1A. We recommend
use of Honeywell power adapters. Use of any non-Honeywell
power adapters may cause damage not covered by the
warranty.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Mounting a COB02 Base
The COB02 Base can be mounted on either a horizontal or vertical
surface. The cable can be routed through either the top or the bottom
of the base.
The cable can be routed down through the bottom of the base,
securing the cable in the wireway.
The cable can also be routed up through the top of the base, but must
be crossed over and secured in the wireway.
When routing the cable up through the top of the base, be sure to
cross the cable over before placing in the wireway. If not, too much
strain is placed on the cable connector.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
When mounted on a vertical surface, a locking system is used to
secure the scanner when it is in the stand. When mounted on a
horizontal surface, the locking mechanism should be set to unlocked
(pushed up). When mounted on a vertical surface, the locking
mechanism should be set to locked (pushed down).
Locked
position for
vertical
mount
Unlocked
position for
horizontal
mount
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Use 30mm screws, appropriate for the mounting surface material, to
mount the base securely.
2.51 in.
63.7mm
5.31 in.
134.92mm
2 in.
51.17mm
2.36 in.
60mm
.84 in.
21.42mm
Operation and Indicators
1. Place a scanner into the cradle to charge.
2. When a scanner is inserted, the green LED flashes according to
the chart below. If the Green LED does not appear, check to
make sure the scanner is seated completely in the charger with
the battery contacts touching the contacts on the charger.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
3. When the battery is completely charged, the green charging
indicator stops flashing and stays illuminated.
LED Indicators
Red
On
Power is on
Green
Off
Battery not detected
Slow flash
Pre-charge and charge
On
Charge completed
Fast flash
Charge suspended due to a fault
condition
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
COB02 Product Specifications
Dimensions
(Typical):
Height
2.6 in. (6.6cm)
Length
9.8 in. (24.98mm)
Width
4.05 in. (10.28cm)
Weight
10.05 oz. (285g)
Voltage
4.5 to 5.5 volts
Current
1A
Charge Time
5 hours
Charge
Temperature
41 F to +104 F (5 C to +40 C)
Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Mechanical Drop
Operational after 50 drops from
3.94 feet 
(1.2m) to concrete within the
temperature range of -4 F (-20 C)
to 122 F (50 C).
Vibration
Complies with MIL-STD-810G,
Method 514.6, Annex C
ESD Immunity
Up to 20kV direct air
Up to 8 kV indirect coupling plane
IP Rating
IP51, immunity of foreign particles
and dripping water
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Required Safety Labels
Compliance
Label locations
Cleaning the Charge-Only Base
Unplug the Charge-Only Base from the power supply before
cleaning.
Clean the housing of the Charge-Only Base with a soft cloth or tissue
dampened with water (or a mild detergent- water solution). If a
detergent solution is used, rinse with a clean tissue dampened with
water only.
!
Never use solvents (e.g., alcohol or
acetone) on the housing – solvents
may damage the finish.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Technical Assistance
Contact information for technical support, product service, and repair
can be found at www.honeywellaidc.com.
Limited Warranty
Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/warranty_information for your
product’s warranty information.
Patents
For patent information, please refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/
patents.
Disclaimer
Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in
specifications and other information contained in this document without prior
notice, and the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether
any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does
not represent a commitment on the part of HII.
HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained
herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the
furnishing, performance, or use of this material. HII disclaims all responsibility
for the selection and use of software and/or hardware to achieve intended
results.
This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright.
All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied,
reproduced, or translated into another language without the prior written
consent of HII.
2012-2015 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved.
Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Mounting a CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT
Base
CCB02-100BT/
CCB05-100BT Base
The cables can also be routed up through the top of
the base, crossing them over and securing the cables
in the wireways.
The CCB02-100BT/CCB05-100BT Base can be
mounted on either a horizontal or vertical surface.
The cables can be routed through either the bottom or
the top of the base.
The cables can be routed down through the bottom of
the base, securing the cables in the wireways.
Installation Guide
When routing the cables up through the top of the
base, be sure to cross the cables over before placing
in the wireways. If not, too much strain is placed on
the cable connectors.
GRNTBASE-INST
Rev B 03/15
When mounted on a vertical surface, a locking
system is used to secure the scanner when it is in the
stand. When mounted on a horizontal surface, the
locking mechanism should be set to unlocked
(pushed up). When mounted on a vertical surface, the
locking mechanism should be set to locked (pushed
down).
Use 3 screws, appropriate for the mounting surface
material, to mount the base securely.
Limited Warranty
Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/
warranty_information for your product’s warranty
information.
Patents
For patent information, see www.hsmpats.com.
Disclaimer
Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to
make changes in specifications and other information
contained in this document without prior notice, and the
reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether
any such changes have been made. The information in this
publication does not represent a commitment on the part of
HII.
Unlocked
position for
horizontal mount
HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or
omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or
consequential damages resulting from the furnishing,
performance, or use of this material.
Locked
position for
vertical mount
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
This document contains proprietary information that is
protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of
this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or
translated into another language without the prior written
consent of HII.
Copyright  2012–2015 Honeywell International Inc. All
rights reserved.
Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Multi-Bay Battery Charger
Installation Guide
MBC-INST Rev C
10/14
For localized language versions of this document, go to www.honeywellaidc.com.
Introduction
Honeywell’s Multi-Bay Battery Charger can fully charge up to four lithium-ion batteries in less than eight hours (typically 4.5 hours), maximizing uptime in any application.
Note: When a battery is placed into the Multi-Bay Battery Charger, the battery will charge. Please note that the Multi-Bay Battery Charger will not facilitate
communication with the host system or other imagers.
Multi-Bay Battery Charger Operation and Indicators
First, connect the right angle power adapter to the Multi-Bay Battery Charger. Then plug the power supply into an AC power outlet. Make sure the AC power outlet
voltage is the same as the power supply.
Note: Use only a UL/cUL listed power supply with output rated 5Vdc, 4A.
We recommend use of Honeywell approved power adapters. Use of any non-Honeywell approved power adapters may cause damage not covered by the
warranty.
1. Place a battery into a cradle to charge.
2. When a battery is inserted, the green LED flashes 3 times, then flashes slowly. If the Green LED does not appear, check to make sure the battery pack is seated
completely in the charger with the battery contacts facing the contacts on the charger.
3. When the battery is completely charged, the charging indicator stops flashing and stays illuminated.
Operational temperature for charging the battery is 41° to 104°F (5° to 40°C).
LED Indicators
Off
Battery not detected
3 flashes
Battery inserted into base
Slow flash
Pre-charge and charge
On
Charge completed
Fast flash
Charge suspended due to a fault condition
Mounting
Mount the Multi-Bay Battery Charger on any smooth surface according to the following dimensions:
3.5 in.
(90mm)
.18 in.
(4.5mm)
.29 in.
(7.5mm)
Back
Bottom
.29 in.
(7.5mm)
3.5 in.
(90mm)
.18 in.
(4.5mm)
If a metal or wood stud is present, drill a 3/32 inch (2.38mm) pilot hole into the stud and use the supplied #6 x 1 screw to attach the Multi-Bay Charger to the wall. For
any of the screws positioned so that they are going directly into dry wall, use a sheet rock anchor/screw set such as the one listed below. Make sure the weight of the
power supply is supported separately.
Wall
Recommended Anchors
Sheet Rock
Buildex E-Z Anchor Stud Solver Medium Duty Drywall Anchor (Model #25216); supports 50 lbs. (22.68kg)
Wood/Metal
#6 x 1 screws included
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
About the Battery
Use only Honeywell Li-ion battery packs BAT-SCN01 in this device. Use of any non-Honeywell battery may result in damage not covered by the
warranty.
Battery Recommendations
• Batteries are shipped approximately 30% to 60% charged and should be fully charged for maximum charge capacity.
• The battery is a lithium ion cell and can be used without a full charge, and can also be charged without fully discharging without impacting the battery life. There
is no need to perform any charge/discharge conditioning on this type of battery.
• Do not disassemble the battery. There are no user-serviceable parts in the battery.
• Do not allow metallic conductive objects to contact battery terminals. Do not short-circuit a battery or throw it into a fire; it can explode and cause severe personal
injury.
• Improper battery use may result in a fire, explosion, or other hazard.
• Although your battery can be recharged many times, it will eventually be depleted. Replace it after the battery is unable to hold an adequate charge.
• If you are not sure if the battery or charger is working properly, send it to Honeywell International Inc. or an authorized service center for inspection. Refer to
Technical Assistance on page 2 for additional information.
Proper Disposal of the Battery
When the battery has reached the end of its useful life, promptly dispose of used batteries in accordance with local regulations. Do not incinerate the battery. This battery pack contains Lithium-ion chemistry. You may send the imager’s battery to us (postage paid). The shipper is responsible for complying
with all federal, state, and local laws and regulations related to the packing, labeling, manifesting, and shipping of spent batteries. Contact Technical
Assistance, below, for recycling or disposal information. Since you may find that your cost of returning the batteries significant, it may be more cost effective to locate a local recycle/disposal company.
Cleaning the Multi-Bay Battery Charger
Unplug the Multi-Bay Battery Charger from the power supply before cleaning.
Clean the housing of the Multi-Bay Battery Charger with a soft cloth or tissue dampened with water (or a mild detergent- water solution). If a detergent solution is
used, rinse with a clean tissue dampened with water only.
Never use solvents (e.g., alcohol or acetone) on the housing – solvents may damage the finish.
Disclaimer
Honeywell International Inc. (“HII”) reserves the right to make changes in specifications and other information contained in this document without prior notice, and
the reader should in all cases consult HII to determine whether any such changes have been made. The information in this publication does not represent a commitment on the part of HII.
HII shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein; nor for incidental or consequential damages resulting from the furnishing, performance, or use of this material.
This document contains proprietary information that is protected by copyright. All rights are reserved. No part of this document may be photocopied, reproduced, or
translated into another language without the prior written consent of HII.
 2009-2014 Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved.
Other product names or marks mentioned in this document may be trademarks or registered trademarks of other companies and are the property of their respective
owners.
Web Address: www.honeywellaidc.com
Technical Assistance
Contact information for technical support, product service, and repair can be found at www.honeywellaidc.com.
Limited Warranty
Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/warranty_information for your product’s warranty information.
MBC-INST Rev C
Page 2
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
Rev C
FCC Part 15 Subpart B Class B
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not
installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off
and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
 Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
 Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
 Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
 Consult the dealer or an experienced radio or television technician for help.
If necessary, the user should consult the dealer or an experienced radio/television technician for additional suggestions. Honeywell is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by unauthorized modifications of this equipment or the substitution or attachment of connecting cables and equipment other than those specified
by Honeywell. The correction is the responsibility of the user.
Caution: Any changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Honeywell may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment.
Canadian Compliance
Conformité à la règlementation canadienne
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. Operation is subject to the following conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Cet appareil numérique de la Classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada. Son fonctionnement est assujetti aux conditions suivantes :
1. Cet appareil ne doit pas causer de brouillage préjudiciable.
2. Cet appareil doit pouvoir accepter tout brouillage reçu, y compris le brouillage pouvant causer un fonctionnement indésirable.
Use only shielded data cables with
this system. This unit has been tested
with cables less than 3 meters.
Cables greater than 3 meters may not
meet class B performance.
Utiliser uniquement des câbles de
données blindés avec ce système.
L’appareil a été testé avec des
câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Les
câbles de longueur supérieure à 3
mètres peuvent ne pas satisfaire à la
performance de la classe B.
Utilisez uniquement des câbles de
données blindés avec ce système.
Ce dispositif a été testé avec des
câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Il est
possible que les câbles de plus de 3
mètres ne permettent pas d’atteindre
des performances de classe B.
Utilizzare solo cavi dati schermati con
questo sistema. Questa unità è stata
testata con cavi di lunghezza
inferiore a 3 metri. I cavi di
lunghezza superiore a 3 metri
potrebbero non essere conformi alle
prestazioni di classe B.
Für dieses System nur abgeschirmte
Datenkabel verwenden. Dieses
System wurde mit Kabeln unter 3
Metern Länge geprüft. Kabel mit einer
Länge von über 3 Metern erfüllen
möglicherweise nicht die Richtlinien
der Klasse B.
此系统仅能使用屏蔽数据电缆。 此设
备是以短于 3 米的电缆进行的测试。
长度超过 3 米的电缆可能无法满足 B
级性能。
此系統只能使用包覆的資料傳輸線。
此裝置是使用不到 3 公尺長的電纜進
行測試。 超過 3 公尺長的電纜可能無
法達到 B 級裝置效能。
このシステムにはシールド付きデー
タケーブルのみを使用してください。
この装置は長さ 3 m 以下のケーブル
でテストされています。3 m 以上の
ケーブルはクラス B の性能を満たさ
ない場合があります。
이 시스템에는 차폐된 데이터 케이블
만 사용하십시오 . 본 장치는 3 미터
미만의 케이블로 테스트를 받았습니
다 . 3 미터를 초과하는 케이블을 사
용하면 Class B 성능을 만족시키지 못
할 수 있습니다 .
Используйте с этой системой только
экранированные кабели передачи
данных. Это устройство прошло
испытания с использованием
кабелей длиной менее 3 метров.
Рабочие характеристики кабелей
длиной свыше 3 м могут не
соответствовать классу В.
The CE marking
indicates compliance
with the following
directives:
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Recast)
In addition, complies to 2014/35/EU
Low Voltage Directive, when shipped
with recommended power supply.
European contact:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Le marquage CE
indique la conformité
avec les directives
suivantes :
• 2014/30/EU CEM
• 2011/65/UE – RoHS
(Refonte)
De plus, ce produit est conforme à la
Directive européenne 2014/35/EU
relative aux basses tensions lorsqu’il
est expédié avec le bloc
d’alimentation recommandé.
Personne-ressource en Europe :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Les Pays-Bas
Le marquage CE
indique la conformité
aux directives
suivantes :
• 2014/30/EUE CEM
• 2011/65/UE RoHS
(refonte)
De plus, indique la conformité à la
directive 2014/35/EU Basse tension,
lorsque le dispositif est livré avec
l’alimentation électrique
recommandée. Contact en Europe :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Pays-Bas
La marcatura CE indica
conformità alle seguenti
direttive:
• 2014/30/EU CEM
• Direttiva RoHS 2011/
65/UE (rifusione)
È inoltre conforme ai sensi della
Direttiva bassa tensione 2014/35/EU,
se spedito con l'alimentatore
consigliato. Contatto in Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Paesi Bassi
Die CE-Kennzeichnung
signalisiert die
Konformität mit
folgenden Richtlinien:
• 2014/30/EU EMV
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Recast)
Weiterhin entspricht dieses Produkt
der Niederspannungsrichtlinie 2014/
35/EU, wenn es mit dem
empfohlenen Netzteil geliefert wird.
Ansprechpartner Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Niederlande
CE 标 记表示 符合以下
指令:
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(新版)
此外,在随附建议的电源时,设备还
符合 2014/35/EU 低电压指令的要
求。欧洲联系信息:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE 標記表示 符合下 列
指令:
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(重訂)
此外,出廠時如附帶建議的電源,亦
符合 2014/35/EU 低電壓指令。歐洲
聯絡資訊:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE マークは、本装置が
次の指令に準拠してい
ることを示します。
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS (
改正 )
また、推奨電源付きで出荷されてい
る場合は、2014/35/EU Low Voltage
Directive にも準拠しています。欧州
でのお問い合わせ :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE 마크는 다음 지침을
준수함을 나타냅니다 .
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Recast)
또한 , 권장 전원 공급장치와 함께 배
송된 경우에는 2014/35/EU Low
Voltage Directive( 저전압 지침 ) 를
준수합니다 . 유럽 연락처 :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Маркировка CE
означает
соответствие
требованиям
следующих директив:
• 2014/30/EU
Директива по
электромагнитной
совместимости (ЭМС)
•
2011/65/EU Директива
RoHS (исправленная)
Кроме того, соответствует
требованиям директивы по
низковольтному оборудованию
2014/35/EU при поставке с
рекомендованным источником
питания. Контактное лицо в
Европе:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
LED Safety Statement
Norme de sécurité sur les
DEL
Norme de sécurité DEL
Disposizione di sicurezza
LED
Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit
LEDs have been tested and classified
as “EXEMPT RISK GROUP” to the
standard: IEC 62471:2006.
Les DEL ont été testées et classées
en tant que « GROUPE DE RISQUE
EXEMPT » par rapport à la norme :
IEC 62471:2006.
Les DEL ont été testées et classées «
GROUPE SANS RISQUE » selon la
norme : CEI 62471:2006.
I LED sono stati testati e classificati
come "GRUPPO ESENTE DA
RISCHI" rispetto allo standard: IEC
62471:2006.
Die LEDs wurden geprüft und gemäß
der Norm IEC 62471:2006 unter
„EXEMPT RISK GROUP“ eingestuft.
Заявление о безопасности
светодиода
Utilice sólo cables de datos blindados
con este sistema. Esta unidad se ha
probado con cables de longitud
inferior a 3 metros. Cables superiores
a 3 metros quizá no satisfagan los
requisitos de rendimiento de la clase
B.
ʭʩʫʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʰʥʺʰ ʩʬʡʫʡ ʹʮʺʹʤʬ ʹʩ ,ʥʦ ʺʫʸʲʮʡ
ʺʥʧʴ ʬʹ ʪʸʥʠʡ ʭʩʬʡʫ ʭʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ .ʣʡʬʡ
3 ʬʲ ʤʬʥʲ ʭʫʸʥʠʹ ʭʩʬʡʫʹ ʯʫʺʩʩ .ʭʩʸʨʮ 3-ʮ
ʭʩʸʩʹʫʮ ʬʹ ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡʤ ʺʥʹʩʸʣʡ ʥʣʮʲʩ ʠʬ ʭʩʸʨʮ
.B ʤʢʸʣʮ
La marca CE indica el
cumplimiento de las
siguientes normativas:
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Refundida)
Asimismo, cumple la normativa de
bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU cuando se
envía con la fuente de alimentación
recomendada. Contacto europeo:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Países Bajos
CE
: Γϱϝ΍Εϝ΍ έϱϱ΍ωϡϝ΍Ώ
2014/30/EU EMC
2011/65/EU RoHS
)Γύ΍ϱιϝ΍ ΓΩ΍ω·(
Use únicamente cables protegidos
para datos con este sistema. Esta
unidad ha sido evaluada con cables
de menos de 3 metros. Es posible
que los cables de más de 3 metros no
cumplan con el desempeño de clase
B.
Use somente cabos de dados
blindados com este sistema. Esta
unidade foi testada com cabos com
menos de 3 metros. Cabos com mais
de 3 metros não atendem o
desempenho de classe B.
‫ ﺗﻢ‬.‫اﺳﺘﺨﺪم ﻓﻘﻂ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎت اﳌﺼﻔﺢ ﻣﻊ ﻫﺬا اﻟﻨﻈﺎم‬
.‫ أﻣﺘﺎر‬3 ‫اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬه اﻟﻮﺣﺪة ﺑﻮاﺳﻄﺔ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت ﻳﻘﻞ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ أﻣﺘﺎر ﻣﻊ‬3 ‫ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ اﻟﻜﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ‬
.B ‫أداء اﻟﻔﺌﺔ‬
La indicación CE indica
el cumplimiento con las
siguientes directivas:
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Reformulada)
Además, cumple con la directiva de
bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU cuando se
envía con la fuente de poder
recomendada. Contacto europeo:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Países Bajos
A marca CE indica
conformidade com as
seguintes diretivas:
• 2014/30/EU EMC
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Reformulação)
Além disso, o produto está em
conformidade com a Diretiva para
baixa tensão 2014/35/EU, quando
fornecido com a fonte de alimentação
recomendada. Contato na Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Holanda
CE
:
2014/30/EU EMC
2011/65/EU RoHS
,
2014/35/EU
.ϩΏ ϯιϭϡϝ΍ Γϕ΍ρϝ΍
,
2014/35/EU
.
:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Declaración de seguridad
del LED
Declaración de seguridad
del LED
Declaração de segurança do
LED
Los LED se han probado y clasificado
como “GRUPO EXENTO DE
RIESGOS” según la normativa: IEC
62471:2006.
Las LED han sido evaluadas y
clasificadas como “GRUPO LIBRE
DE RIESGOS” según la norma: IEC
62471:2006.
Os LEDs foram testados e
classificados como “GRUPO DE
RISCO ISENTO” conforme a norma:
IEC 62471:2006.
LED ʺʥʸʥʰ - ʺʥʧʩʨʡ ʺʸʤʶʤ
"ʯʥʫʩʱ ʺʥʬʥʨʰʫ" ʥʢʥʥʱʥ ʥʷʣʡʰ LED-ʤ ʺʥʸʥʰ
IEC 62471:2006 :ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ
LED ‫ﺑﻴﺎن ﺳﻼﻣﺔ‬
ǀŸǞƵƆƵż)ƾƷƱƸƶƫůȶ LED ljƸŮƾƫžȤƾƃƄųȚƖ
:ȤƾƸƯƵƴŽƾ ȹƲźȶ(ǍƭƒȚǜžǑƴƈƄŽȚ
.IEC 62471:2006
LED 安全声明
LED 安全聲明
LED の安全性について
LED 안전 고지 사항
LED 经测试属于 IEC 62471:2006 标
准的 “ 豁免风险组 ”(EXEMPT RISK
GROUP)。
LED 經測試被列為 IEC 62471:2006
標準的 「豁免風險組」 (EXEMPT
RISK GROUP)。
LED は IEC 62471:2006 安全規格に
対してテスト済みで、「EXEMPT
RISK GROUP ( リスクグループ除外
)」に分類されています。
LED 는 표준 IEC 62471:2006 에 대해
테스트되어 "EXEMPT RISK GROUP"
으로 분류되었습니다 .
CB Scheme
Plan OC (organismes de
certification)
Schéma OC
Schema CB
CB-Zertifizierung
Esquema CB
Esquema CB
Esquema CB
Certifié selon la norme CEI 60950-1
seconde édition (schéma OC).
Certificato in base allo Schema CB
IEC 60950-1, seconda edizione.
CB-zertifiziert gemäß IEC 60950,
Second Edition.
Se ha certificado que cumple el
esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda
edición.
Se ha certificado que cumple con el
esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda
edición.
Certificação CB Scheme IEC 609501, Segunda edição.
Certified to CB Scheme IEC 60950-1,
Second Edition.
Certifié CB CEI 60950-1, deuxième
édition.
Светодиоды прошли испытания и
отнесены к «БЕЗРИСКОВОЙ ГРУППЕ»
согласно стандарту МЭК 62471:2006.
CB Scheme
CB ‫ﻣﺨﻄﻂ‬
‫ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ‬
CB 方案
CB Scheme
CB Scheme
CB Scheme
Схема CB
已通过 CB 方案 IEC 60950-1 第二版
的认证。
經過認證符合 CB Scheme IEC
60950-1 標準第二版。
CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second
Edition に認定されています。
CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second
Edition 인증을 받았습니다 .
Сертификация согласно схеме CB
МЭК 60950-1, издание второе.
Patents
Brevets
Brevets
Brevetti
Patente
Patentes
Patentes
Patentes
For patent information, refer to
www.hsmpats.com.
Veuillez consulter le site
www.hsmpats.com pour obtenir des
renseignements au sujet du brevet.
Pour plus d’informations sur les
brevets, visitez la page
www.hsmpats.com.
Per i dettagli sui brevetti, fare
riferimento al sito Web
www.hsmpats.com.
Patentinformationen sind unter
www.hsmpats.com erhältlich.
Para obtener información sobre las
patentes, visite www.hsmpats.com.
Para obtener información sobre
patentes, consulte
www.hsmpats.com.
Para obter informações sobre
patente, consulte www.hsmpats.com.
专利
專利
特許
특허
Патенты
有关专利信息,请参阅
www.hsmpats.com。
相關專利資訊請參閱
www.hsmpats.com 中的說明。
特許情報については、
www.hsmpats.com を参照してくだ
さい。
특허 정보는 www.hsmpats.com 를 참
조하십시오 .
Информация о патентах приведена
на веб-странице www.hsmpats.com.
Laser Safety Statement
Déclaration de sécurité
relative au laser
Déclaration de sécurité laser
Dichiarazione sulla
sicurezza del dispositivo
laser
Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit
If the following label is attached to
your product, it indicates the product
contains a laser:
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
This device has been tested in
accordance with and complies with
IEC60825-1:2007 and 21 CFR
1040.10 and 1040.11, except for
deviations pursuant to Laser Notice
No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
LASER LIGHT, DO NOT STARE
INTO BEAM, CLASS 2 LASER
PRODUCT, 1.0 mW MAX OUTPUT:
630-650nM.
Caution - use of controls or
adjustments or performance of
procedures other than those
specified herein may result in
hazardous radiation exposure.
Si l’étiquette suivante est apposée à
votre produit, cela signifie que le
produit contient un laser :
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Cet appareil a été testé et reconnu
conforme aux normes IEC608251:2007 et 21 CFR 1040.10 et
1040.11sauf pour les dérogations en
accord avec l'avis de conformité sur
les lasers No. 50, en date du 24 juin
2007.
LUMIÈRE LASER, NE PAS
REGARDER DIRECTEMENT DANS
LE FAISCEAU, PRODUIT LASER DE
CLASSE 2, SORTIE MAX. DE 1,0
MW : 630-650 nm.
Mise en garde – l’utilisation de
contrôles ou d’ajustements ou de
performance de procédures autres
que ceux spécifiées dans la présente
peut provoquer une exposition
dangereuse au rayonnement.
Si l'étiquette suivante est attachée à
votre produit, elle indique que le
produit contient un laser :
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Cet appareil a été testé et certifié
conforme aux normes CEI 608251:2007, 21 CFR 1040.10 et 21 CFR
1040.11, à l'exception des déviations
selon le document Laser Notice n° 50
en date du 24 juin 2007.
ATTENTION, LUMIÈRE LASER : NE
PAS FIXER LE FAISCEAU,
PRODUIT LASER DE CLASSE 2 1
mW SORTIE MAX :630-650 nM.
L'utilisation de contrôles ou réglages
ou la réalisation de procédures
autres que ceux spécifiés dans la
documentation utilisateur peut
entraîner une exposition à des
rayonnements dangereux.
La presenza della seguente etichetta
sul prodotto indica che il prodotto
contiene un laser:
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Questo dispositivo è stato testato in
base a ed è conforme agli standard
IEC60825-1:2007 e 21, CFR 1040.10
e 1040.11, ad eccezione delle
deviazioni ai sensi del documento
Laser Notice No. 50, datato 24
giugno 2007.
LUCE LASER, NON FISSARE IL
RAGGIO LASER, PRODOTTO DI
CLASSE 2, POTENZA DI USCITA
MAX 1.0 mW : 630-650nM.
Un utilizzo dei comandi, dei
dispositivi di regolazione o delle
procedure non conforme a quanto
specificato nella documentazione
d'uso può determinare
un'esposizione pericolosa alle
radiazioni.
激光安全声明
鐳射安全聲明
レーザーの安全性について
레이저 안전 고지 사항
如果您的产品附有以下标签,说明产
品具有激光功能:
若產品上貼有下列之標籤,即表示該
產品具有雷射功能:
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
製品に次のラベルが添付されている
場合は、製品にレーザーが含まれて
いることを示しています。
제품에 다음과 같은 표시가 부착되어
있는 경우 제품에 레이저가 포함되어
있음을 의미합니다 .
此设备已经过测试,符合 IEC608251:2007 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 和
1040.11 标准, 2007 年 6 月 24 日颁
布的第 50 号激光通告所规定的偏离
除外。
激光辐射,不可凝视光束, 2 类激光
产品,最大输出为 1.0 mW:630650nM。
如果使用了用户文档范围之外的操作
步骤控制或调整或执行,可能会导致
危险的辐射暴露。
此裝置已經過測試,符合 IEC608251:2007 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 與
1040.11 標準,但 2007 年 6 月 24 日
發佈的第 50 號鐳射通告中所述的偏
差不在此限。
雷射光,請勿直視雷射光束,CLASS
2 雷射產品,1.0 mW 最大輸出功率:
630-650nM。
若使用的控制、調整或執行等程序並
非依照使用者文件中所指示,可能會
發生危險,導致輻射曝露。
Product Environmental
Information
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
この装置は、IEC60825-1:2007 と、
21 CFR 1040.10 および 1040.11 に
従ってテストされ、Laser Notice
No. 50 (2007 年 6 月 24 日 ) に従う
ことによる逸脱を除き適合していま
す。
レーザー光はビームをのぞき込まな
いでください。クラス 2 レーザー製
品、1.0 mW 最大出力 : 630-650nM
ユーザー マニュアルで指定されてい
ない制御や調整の使用または手順の
実行によって、有害な放射線照射が
発生する可能性があります。
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
본 장치는 IEC60825-1:2007 과 21
CFR 1040.10 및 1040.11 에 따라 테
스트되었으며 이를 준수하는 것으로
확인되었습니다 . 단 , 2007 년 6 월 24
일자 Laser Notice No. 50 에 의거한
편차는 제외합니다 .
레이저 광선 , 안구에 직접적인 광선
노출 금지 , CLASS 2 레이저 제품 ,
1.0mW 최대 출력 : 630-650nM
사용자 설명서에 명시된 내용 이외의
절차를 통해 장치를 조작하거나 조정
하거나 작동하는 경우 인체에 심각한
위해를 끼치는 방사선에 노출될 수 있
습니다
Renseignements relatifs à
l’environnement à propos
des produits
Informations
environnementales sur les
produits
Reportez-vous à la page
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental pour obtenir des
renseignements concernant les
directives RoHS/REACH/WEEE.
Reportez-vous au site
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental pour obtenir les
informations sur les directives RoHS/
REACH/WEEE.
产品环境信息
產品環境資訊
製品の環境情報
제품 환경 정보
有关 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 信息,
请参阅 www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 。
請參閱 www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 以瞭解 RoHS /
REACH / WEEE 資訊。
RoHS / REACH / WEEE に関する情
報については、
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental を参照してください。
RoHS / REACH / WEEE 정보는
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 에서 참조하십시오 .
Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental for the RoHS / REACH
/ WEEE information.
Informazioni ambientali
relative al prodotto
Consultare il sito web
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental per informazioni su
RoHS/REACH/RAEE.
Wenn Ihr Produkt mit dem folgenden
Etikett gekennzeichnet ist, bedeutet
dies, dass das Produkt einen Laser
enthält:
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Dieses Gerät wurde geprüft und
erfüllt die Anforderungen von
IEC60825-1:2007, 21 CFR 1040.10
und 1040.11, mit Ausnahme von
Abweichungen gemäß Laser Notice
Nr. 50, vom 24. Juni 2007.
LASERSTRAHLUNG, NICHT IN
DEN STRAHL BLICKEN,
LASERPRODUKT DER KLASSE 2,
MAXIMALE ENERGIE DER
LASERSTRAHLUNG 1,0 mW: 630650 nM.
Die Verwendung oder Einstellung von
Reglern bzw. die Ausführung von
anderen als in dieser
Bedienungsanleitung beschriebenen
Abläufen kann zu gefährlicher
Laserstrahlung führen.
IEC ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ ʸʹʥʠʮ ʸʶʥʮʤ CB Scheme
.ʤʩʰʹ ʤʸʥʣʤʮ ,CB Scheme ʯʥʢʸʠ ʬʹ 60950-1
ʭʩʨʰʨʴ
ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ ʯʩʩʲ ,ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʬʲ ʲʣʩʮʬ
www.hsmpats.com
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Это устройство прошло испытания
согласно следующим стандартам,
которым оно соответствует: МЭК
60825-1:2007 и 21 CFR 1040.10 и
1040.11, с учетом разрешений на
отступление от требований согласно
Уведомлению о лазерах № 50 от 24
июня 2007 г.
ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ СВЕТ, НЕ СМОТРИТЕ
НА ЛУЧ, ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ ПРОДУКТ
КЛАССА 2, 10 МвТ
МАКСИМАЛЬНОЙ МОЩНОСТИ:
650nM. 650нМ.
Внимание – использование
средств управления,
регулирования или изменения
производительности процедур,
отличающихся от указанных в
данном документе, может
привести к опасному воздействию
радиации.
Informationen zur
Umweltverträglichkeit von
Produkten
Unter www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental finden Sie
Informationen über RoHS/REACH/
WEEE.
Экологическая
информация о продукции
Информация о соответствии
требованиям RoHS / REACH /
WEEE приведена на сайте
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental.
‫ﺑﺮاءات اﻻﺧﱰاع‬
‫ ﻳُﺮﺟﻰ اﻟﺮﺟﻮع‬،‫ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮل ﻋﲆ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎت ﺗﺨﺺ ﺑﺮاءة اﻻﺧﱰاع‬
.www.hsmpats.com ‫إﱃ‬
Declaración de seguridad
del láser
Declaración de seguridad de
láser
Declaração de segurança de
laser
Si la siguiente etiqueta se encuentra
adherida al producto, indica que éste
contiene un láser:
Si la siguiente etiqueta está adherida
al producto, indica que éste contiene
un láser:
Se a seguinte etiquete estiver colada
no seu produto, indica que ele
contém um laser:
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Este dispositivo se ha probado de
acuerdo con las normativas
IEC60825-1:2007 y 21 CFR 1040.10
y 1040.11 y se ha certificado que las
cumple, excepto en lo referente a
desviaciones según el aviso sobre
láser n.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007.
RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR
FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO
LÁSER DE CLASE 2, POTENCIA
MÁXIMA 1 mw: 630-650 nm.
El uso de controles, ajustes o
procedimientos diferentes a los
descritos en la documentación del
usuario puede suponer la exposición
a radiaciones peligrosas.
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Este dispositivo ha sido evaluado
según las normas IEC60825-1:2007
y 21 CFR 1040.10 y 1040.11, y
cumple con ellas, excepto por las
diferencias en virtud del Aviso sobre
láser N.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007.
RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR
FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO
LÁSER DE LA CLASE 2, POTENCIA
MÁXIMA 1 mW:630-650 nm.
El uso de controles, ajustes o
procedimientos diferentes a los
indicados en la documentación para
el usuario puede provocar la
exposición a radiaciones peligrosas.
Este dispositivo foi testado de acordo
e em conformidade com as normas
IECC60825-1:2007 e 21 CFR
1040.10 e 1040.11, exceto por
divergências de acordo com o Laser
Notice nº50, datado de 24 de junho
de 2007.
LUZ DE LASER, NÃO OLHE
FIXAMENTE PARA O FEIXE,
PRODUTO A LASER CLASSE 2,
SAÍDA MÁXIMA DE 1,0 mW: 630650 nM.
A utilização de controles ou ajustes
ou a execução de procedimentos de
modo diferente do especificado na
documentação do usuário pode
resultar em exposição nociva à
radiação.
Información ambiental del
producto
Información ambiental de
producto
Informações ambientais
sobre produtos
Consulte www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental para obtener
información sobre RoHS/REACH/
WEEE.
Consulte la información RoHS/
REACH/WEEE en
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental.
Consulte a página
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental para obter
informações sobre as normas RoHS/
REACH/WEEE.
Заявление о безопасности
лазера
Если к изделию прикреплена
нижеуказанная этикетка, то это
означает, что в изделии имеется
лазер:
.‫ اﻹﺻﺪاراﻟﺜﺎﻧﻲ‬،CB IEC 60950-1 ‫ﻣﺨﻄﻂ‬
:‫إﱃ أن اﳌﻨﺘﺞ ﻳﺤﺘﻮي ﻋﲆ اﻟﻠﻴﺰر‬
‫ﻧﴩة اﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ اﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﺰر‬
‫ ﻓﺈﻧﻪ‬،‫إذا ﻛﺎن اﳌﻠﺼﻖ اﻟﺘﺎﱄ ﻣﺮﻓﻘًﺎ ﺑﺎﳌﻨﺘﺞ‬
LASER LIGHT. DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM. CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
1.0MW MAX OUTPUT: 650NM. IEC 60825-1 Ed 2 (2007). Complies
with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11 except for deviations
pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
،IEC60825-1:2007
‫ﺗﻢ اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬا اﻟﺠﻬﺎز وﻓﻘًﺎ‬
‫ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎء اﻻﻧﺤﺮاﻓﺎت‬1040.11‫ و‬،CFR 1040.10 21 ‫و‬
،‫ ﻳﻮﻧﻴﻮ‬24 ‫ ﺑﺘﺎرﻳﺦ‬،50 ‫اﻹﺷﻌﺎر اﻟﺨﺎص ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﺰر رﻗﻢ‬
.2007
‫ ﻣﻨﺘﺞ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﺰر‬،‫ ﻻ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﻖ ﰲ اﻟﺸﻌﺎع‬،‫ﺿﻮء اﻟﻠﻴﺰر‬
.1 ‫ﻣﻦ اﻟﻔﺌﺔ‬
‫ أو‬،‫ أو اﻟﺘﻌﺪﻳﻼت‬،‫ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ – ﻗﺪ ﻳﺆدي اﺳﺘﺨﺪام ﻋﻨﺎﴏ اﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ‬
‫اﻟﺘﻌﺮض‬
‫اﻟﻘﻴﺎم ﺑﺈﺟﺮاءات أﺧﺮى ﺗﻠﻚ اﳌﺤﺪدة ﻫﻨﺎ إﱃ‬
.‫إﱃ اﻹﺷﻌﺎﻋﺎت اﻟﺨﻄﺮة‬
ΞΗϧϣϠϟΔϳ΋ϳΑϟ΍ΕΎϔλ΍ϭϣϟ΍
ϰϟ·ωϭΟέϟ΍ϰΟέ˵ϳ
www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental
ΕΎϬϳΟϭΗϝϭΣΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ
.5R+65($&+:(((
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
ʩʸʶʥʮ ʬʹ ʩʺʡʩʡʱʤ ʲʣʩʮʤ ʺʥʣʥʠ ʭʩʨʸʴʬ
:ʺʡʥʺʫʡ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ
www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental for
the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information.
TÜV R Statement
Normes TÜV R
TÜV R listed: UL 60950-1, Second Edition and
CSA C22.2 No.60950-1-07, Second Edition.
Homologué TÜV R : UL 60950-1, seconde
édition et CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1-07,
seconde édition.
TÜV Rheinland
C
TÜV Rheinland
C
US
US
If the following label is attached to your product, the product
meets Korean agency approval:
이 기기는 가정용 (B 급 ) 전자파적합기기로서 주
로 가정에서 사용하는 것을 목적으로 하며 ,
모든 지역에서 사용할 수 있습니다 .
This product is EMC B grade equipment, intended
for residential use. This equipment can be used
in any area.
产品中有害物质的名称及含量
(Names and Content of Hazardous Substances in the Product)
部件名称 (Parts Name)
有害物质
(Hazardous Substances)
铅 (Pb)
汞 (Hg)
镉 (Cd)
六价铬 (Cr6+)
多溴联苯 (PBB)
多溴二苯醚 (PBDE)
成像式二维条码阅读器 (2D Imager)
x
o
o
o
o
o
印刷电路板 (PCB)
x
o
o
o
o
o
外壳 (Housing)
o
o
o
o
o
o
连线 (Cables)
o
o
o
o
o
o
本表格依据 SJ/T11364 的规定编制。(The table is created by SJ/T11364 requirement.)
o: 表示该有害物质在该部件所有均质材料中的含量均在 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求以下。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.)
x: 表示该有害物质至少在该部件的某一均质材料中的含量超出 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials for this part is above the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.)
This document was prepared and executed in the English
language. In the event this document is translated into another
language and a conflict arises between the English version and
a non-English version, the English version shall prevail, it being
recognized and acknowledged that the English language
version most clearly expresses the intent of the parties. Any
notice or communication given in connection with this document
must include a version in the English language.
Ce document a été préparé et exécuté dans la langue anglaise.
Dans l’éventualité où le document serait traduit dans une autre
langue et qu'un litige survenait entre la version en anglais et la
version autre qu'en anglais, la version en anglais prévaudra,
étant confirmé et reconnu que la version en anglais exprime de
façon plus précise l’intention des parties. Tout avis ou toute
communication relatif à ce document doit inclure une version en
anglais.
Ce document a été préparé et finalisé en anglais. Si ce
document est traduit dans une autre langue et si un conflit
survient entre la version en anglais et la version traduite, la
version en anglais prévaudra tant il est reconnu et établi qu’elle
exprime le plus clairement les intentions des parties. Tout avis
ou communication produit en relation avec ce document doit
comporter une version en anglais.
Questo documento è stato preparato e redatto in lingua inglese.
In caso di traduzione in altre lingue, nell’eventualità sorgano
conflitti fra la versione non inglese e quella inglese, prevarrà
quest’ultima in quanto viene riconosciuto e accettato che la
versione in lingua inglese esprime più chiaramente gli accordi
fra le parti. Qualsiasi notifica o comunicazione inviata in
rapporto a questo documento deve includere una versione in
lingua inglese.
Dieses Dokument wurde in englischer Sprache erstellt und
ausgefertigt. Wenn dieses Dokument in eine andere Sprache
übersetzt wird, und ein Konflikt zwischen der englischen und
nicht-englischen Fassung auftritt, hat die englische Fassung
Vorrang, da die Parteien anerkennen, dass die Fassung in
englischer Sprache ihren Absichten am deutlichsten Ausdruck
verleiht. Alle Hinweise oder Mitteilungen in Zusammenhang mit
diesem Dokument müssen auch in einer Fassung in englischer
Sprache erfolgen.
Originalmente, este documento se creó y redactó en inglés. En
caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja un conflicto entre
la versión en inglés y la versión en otro idioma, prevalecerá la
versión en inglés. Se reconoce y admite que, en la versión en
inglés, expresa la intención de las partes con más claridad.
Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con
este documento debe incluir una versión en inglés.
Este documento se preparó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que
se traduzca a otro idioma y surja algún conflicto entre la versión
en inglés y la del idioma extranjero, prevalecerá la versión en
inglés, dado que se reconoce y admite que la versión en inglés
expresa más claramente la intención de las partes. Cualquier
aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este
documento deberá incluir una versión en inglés.
Este documento foi preparado e feito em língua inglesa. Se este
documento for traduzido para outro idioma e surgirem conflitos
entre a versão em inglês e a versão no outro idioma, a versão
em inglês prevalecerá, sendo reconhecido e atestado que a
versão em língua inglesa expressa mais claramente a intenção
das partes. Qualquer comunicação ou aviso relacionado a este
documento deve conter a versão em inglês.
本文档以英文撰写。如果本文档的其他语言版本与英文版本存
在冲突,则以英文版本为准。各方一致认可和同意英文版本最
清楚地表达了各自的意图。任何与本文档相关的声明或沟通,
都应包括英文版本。
本文件的原稿是以英文撰寫。如果本文件翻譯為其他語言,而
英文版和非英文版之間產生衝突,應以英文版為準,並且各方
一致認同並確認英文版最能夠清楚地表達各方的意圖。凡是所
有與本文件有關之公告或通訊,都必須包含英文的版本。
本書は英語で作成され発行されています。本書を他の言語に
翻訳し、英語版と英語以外の版に矛盾が生じた場合は、関係
者の意図を最も明確に表すものが英語版であることを認識お
よび承諾し、英語版が優先するものとします。さらに、本書
に関連して与えられる告知や通知は、すべて英語版を含むも
のとします。
본 문서는 영어로 준비되어 작성된 것입니다. 본 문서를 다른 언
어로 번역했는데 영문본과 번역본 사이에 상충하는 부분이 발생
하는 경우에는 영문본이 우선하며, 영문본이 양쪽 당사자의 의
도를 가장 명확하게 표현하고 있음을 인식하고 확인합니다. 본
문서와 관련한 모든 고지 또는 전달 사항에는 영문본이 동봉되
어야 합니다.
Данный документ был подготовлен и выполнен на
английском языке. При переводе данного документа на
другой язык, в случае возникновения противоречий между
английской версией и версией на другом языке, английская
версия имеет преимущественную силу. Данным
признается, что версия документа на английском языке
наиболее четко выражает намерения сторон. Любые
уведомления или письма, направляемые в связи с данным
документом, должны включать в себя версию на
английском языке.
‫ إذا ﺗﺮﺟﻤﺔ ﻫﺬا‬.‫ﺗﻢ إﻋﺪاد ﻫﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ وﺗﻨﻔﻴﺬه ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ‬
‫اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ إﱃ ﻟﻐﺎت أﺧﺮى وﻛﺎن ﻫﻨﺎك اﺧﺘﻼف اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي وإﺻﺪار‬
‫ ﺣﻴﺚ إن اﻹﺻﺪار‬،‫ ُ ﺟﻰ اﻻﻟﺘﺰام ﺟﺎء ﰲ اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي‬،‫آﺧﺮ‬
‫ ﻳﺠﺐ أن‬.‫اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي ﻫﻮ اﻟﺬي ﻳﻌﱪ ﺑﻮﺿﻮح وﴏاﺣﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻴﺔ اﻷﻃﺮاف‬
‫ﺗﺸﻤﻞ أﻳﺔ إﺷﻌﺎرات أو اﺗﺼﺎﻻت ذات ﺻﻠﺔ ﺑﻬﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻋﲆ إﺻﺪار ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ‬
.‫اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ‬
For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and
click Resources > Warranty.
Pour obtenir des informations sur la garantie, consultez le site
www.honeywellaidc.com et cliquez sur Ressources >
Garantie.
Per informazioni sulla garanzia, andare a
www.honeywellaidc.com e fare clic su Resources > Warranty.
Die Garantiebestimmungen finden Sie unter
www.honeywellaidc.com. Klicken Sie dort auf Ressourcen >
Garantie.
Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite
www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía.
Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite
www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía.
Para obter informações sobre a garantia, vá para
www.honeywellaidc.com e clique em Resources (Recursos) >
Warranty (Garantia).
欲了解保修信息,请访 www.honeywellaidc.com,单击
Resources (资源)> Warranty (保修)。
如需檢視保固資訊,請瀏覽 www.honeywellaidc.com,然後按
一下 Resources > Warranty。
保証については、www.honeywellaidc.com にて、Resources >
Warranty とクリックしてください。
보증 정보를 보려면 www.honeywellaidc.com 으로 이동하여
Resources > Warranty 를 클릭하십시오 .
Подробную информацию о гарантии см. на сайте
www.honeywellaidc.com в разделе Resources > Warranty.
Informace o záruce naleznete na stránce
www.honeywellaidc.com po kliknutí na Resources > Warranty.
Ak chcete získať informácie o záruke, prejdite na stránku
www.honeywellaidc.com a kliknite na Resources (Zdroje) >
Warranty (Záruka).
Aby uzyskać informacje na temat gwarancji, wejdź na stronę
www.honeywellaidc.com i kliknij Zasoby > Gwarancja.
Garanti bilgileri için www.honeywellaidc.com adresine gidin ve
Kaynaklar > Garanti ögelerini tıklayın.
ʺʡʥʺʫʬʥʰʴʠʰʺʥʩʸʧʠʤʺʥʣʥʠʲʣʩʮʬ
ΓέΎϳίΑϝοϔΗˬϥΎϣοϟ΍ϥ΄ηΑΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ
.Resources > Warranty ʥʷʩʬʷʤʥwww.honeywellaidc.com
Ωέ΍ϭϣϟ΍< ϥΎϣοϟ΍ϕϭϓέϘϧ΍ϭwww.honeywellaidc.com
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
ʤʴʹʬ ʭʢʸʥʺʩ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʹ ʤʸʷʮʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʷʴʥʤʥ ʪʸʲʰ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮ
,ʺʮʢʸʥʺʮʤ ʤʱʸʢʤʥ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʥʲʮʹʮ ʯʩʡ ʤʸʩʺʱ ʤʬʢʺʺʥ ʺʸʧʠ
ʤʱʸʢʤ ʩʫ ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʬʲ ʭʫʱʥʮ .ʺʲʡʥʷʤ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʩʤʺ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ
ʤʲʣʥʤ ʬʫ .ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʺʰʥʥʫ ʺʠʸʺʥʩʡ ʸʥʸʡʤ ʯʴʥʠʡ ʺʠʨʡʮ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ
.ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʠʬʥʬʫʬ ʺʡʩʩʧ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʬ ʸʹʷʤʡ ʸʱʮʩʺʹ
RegSht-1910 Rev C
6/16
Rev E
FCC Part 15 Statement
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Caution: Any changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Honeywell may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment.
FCC Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed
and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,
the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
•
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
•
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
•
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
•
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
RF Exposure
The equipment complies with FCC RF exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. The equipment must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
Para su uso en México, la operación de este equipo está sujeta a las siguientes dos condiciones:
1. Es posible que este equipo o dispositivo no cause interferencia perjudicial.
2. Este equipo o dispositivo debe aceptar cualquier interferencia, incluyendo la que pueda causar su operación no deseada.
Canadian Compliance
Conformité à la règlementation canadienne
This ISM device complies with Canadian RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Cet appareil ISM est conforme à la norme CNR-210 du Canada.
Son fonctionnement est assujetti aux conditions suivantes :
1. Cet appareil ne doit pas causer de brouillage préjudiciable.
2. Cet appareil doit pouvoir accepter tout brouillage reçu, y compris le brouillage pouvant causer un fonctionnement indésirable.
Use only shielded data cables with
this system. This unit has been tested
with cables less than 3 meters.
Cables greater than 3 meters may not
meet class B performance.
Utiliser uniquement des câbles de
données blindés avec ce système.
L’appareil a été testé avec des câbles
de moins de 3 mètres. Les câbles de
longueur supérieure à 3 mètres
peuvent ne pas satisfaire à la
performance de la classe B.
Utilisez uniquement des câbles de
données blindés avec ce système. Ce
dispositif a été testé avec des câbles
de moins de 3 mètres. Il est possible
que les câbles de plus de 3 mètres ne
permettent pas d’atteindre des
performances de classe B.
Utilizzare solo cavi dati schermati con
questo sistema. Questa unità è stata
testata con cavi di lunghezza inferiore
a 3 metri. I cavi di lunghezza
superiore a 3 metri potrebbero non
essere conformi alle prestazioni di
classe B.
Für dieses System nur abgeschirmte
Datenkabel verwenden. Dieses
System wurde mit Kabeln unter 3
Metern Länge geprüft. Kabel mit einer
Länge von über 3 Metern erfüllen
möglicherweise nicht die Richtlinien
der Klasse B.
此系统仅能使用屏蔽数据电缆。此设
备是以短于 3 米的电缆进行的测试。
长度超过 3 米的电缆可能无法满足 B
级性能。
此系統只能使用包覆的資料傳輸線。
此裝置是使用不到 3 公尺長的電纜進
行測試。 超過 3 公尺長的電纜可能無
法達到 B 級裝置效能。
このシステムにはシールド付きデー
タケーブルのみを使用してください。
この装置は長さ 3 m 以下のケーブル
でテストされています。3 m 以上の
ケーブルはクラス B の性能を満たさ
ない場合があります。
이 시스템에는 차폐된 데이터 케이블
만 사용하십시오 . 본 장치는 3 미터
미만의 케이블로 테스트를 받았습니
다 . 3 미터를 초과하는 케이블을 사용
하면 Class B 성능을 만족시키지 못할
수 있습니다 .
Используйте с этой системой только
экранированные кабели передачи
данных. Это устройство прошло
испытания с использованием
кабелей длиной менее 3 метров.
Рабочие характеристики кабелей
длиной свыше 3 м могут не
соответствовать классу В.
The CE marking
indicates
compliance with the
following directives:
• 1995/5/EC
R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU
RoHS (Recast)
In addition, complies to 2014/35/EU
Low Voltage Directive, when shipped
with recommended power supply.
European contact:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Le marquage CE
indique la conformité
avec les directives
suivantes :
• 1995/5/CE
R & TTE
• 2011/65/UE –
RoHS (Refonte)
De plus, ce produit est conforme à la
Directive européenne 2014/35/EU
relative aux basses tensions lorsqu’il
est expédié avec le bloc
d’alimentation recommandé.
Personne-ressource en Europe :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Les Pays-Bas
Le marquage CE
indique la conformité
aux directives
suivantes :
• 1995/5/CE
R & TTE
• 2011/65/UE RoHS
(refonte)
De plus, indique la conformité à la
directive 2014/35/EU Basse tension,
lorsque le dispositif est livré avec
l’alimentation électrique
recommandée. Contact en Europe :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Pays-Bas
La marcatura CE
indica conformità
alle seguenti
direttive:
• Direttiva R&TTE
1995/5/CE
• Direttiva RoHS
2011/65/UE
(rifusione)
È inoltre conforme ai sensi della
Direttiva bassa tensione 2014/35/EU,
se spedito con l'alimentatore
consigliato. Contatto in Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Paesi Bassi
Die CEKennzeichnung
signalisiert die
Konformität mit
folgenden
Richtlinien:
• 1995/5/EG R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Recast)
Weiterhin entspricht dieses Produkt
der Niederspannungsrichtlinie 2014/
35/EU, wenn es mit dem
empfohlenen Netzteil geliefert wird.
Ansprechpartner Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Niederlande
CE 标记表示符合以
下指令:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(新版)
此外,在随附建议的电源时,设备还
符合 2014/35/EU 低电压指令的要
求。欧洲联系信息:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE 標記表示符合下
列指令:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(重訂)
此外,出廠時如附帶建議的電源,亦
符合 2014/35/EU 低電壓指令。歐洲
聯絡資訊:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE マークは、本装置
が次の指令に準拠し
ていることを示しま
す。
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
( 改正 )
また、推奨電源付きで出荷されてい
る場合は、2014/35/EU Low Voltage
Directive にも準拠しています。欧州
でのお問い合わせ :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE 마크는 다음 지침
을 준수함을 나타냅
니다 .
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Recast)
또한 , 권장 전원 공급장치와 함께 배
송된 경우에는 2014/35/EU Low
Voltage Directive( 저전압 지침 ) 를
준수합니다 . 유럽 연락처 :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Маркировка CE
означает
соответствие
требованиям
следующих
директив:
• 1995/5/EC
Директива о
радио- и
телекоммуникацион
ном оборудовании
• 2011/65/EU
Директива RoHS
(исправленная)
Кроме того, соответствует
требованиям директивы по
низковольтному оборудованию
2014/35/EU при поставке с
рекомендованным источником
питания. Контактное лицо в
Европе:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Class I
Catégorie I
Classe I
Klasse I
Utilice sólo cables de datos blindados
con este sistema. Esta unidad se ha
probado con cables de longitud
inferior a 3 metros. Cables superiores
a 3 metros quizá no satisfagan los
requisitos de rendimiento de la
clase B.
ʭʩʫʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʰʥʺʰ ʩʬʡʫʡ ʹʮʺʹʤʬ ʹʩ ,ʥʦ ʺʫʸʲʮʡ
ʺʥʧʴ ʬʹ ʪʸʥʠʡ ʭʩʬʡʫ ʭʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ .ʣʡʬʡ
3 ʬʲ ʤʬʥʲ ʭʫʸʥʠʹ ʭʩʬʡʫʹ ʯʫʺʩʩ .ʭʩʸʨʮ 3-ʮ
ʭʩʸʩʹʫʮ ʬʹ ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡʤ ʺʥʹʩʸʣʡ ʥʣʮʲʩ ʠʬ ʭʩʸʨʮ
.B ʤʢʸʣʮ
La marca CE indica
el cumplimiento de
las siguientes
normativas:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Refundida)
Asimismo, cumple la normativa de
bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU cuando se
envía con la fuente de alimentación
recomendada. Contacto europeo:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Países Bajos
Use únicamente cables protegidos
para datos con este sistema. Esta
unidad ha sido evaluada con cables
de menos de 3 metros. Es posible
que los cables de más de 3 metros no
cumplan con el desempeño de
clase B.
‫ ﺗﻢ‬.‫اﺳﺘﺨﺪم ﻓﻘﻂ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎت اﳌﺼﻔﺢ ﻣﻊ ﻫﺬا اﻟﻨﻈﺎم‬
.‫ أﻣﺘﺎر‬3 ‫اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬه اﻟﻮﺣﺪة ﺑﻮاﺳﻄﺔ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت ﻳﻘﻞ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ أﻣﺘﺎر ﻣﻊ‬3 ‫ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ اﻟﻜﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ‬
.B ‫أداء اﻟﻔﺌﺔ‬
La indicación CE
indica el
cumplimiento con
las siguientes
directivas:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Reformulada)
Además, cumple con la directiva de
bajo voltaje 2006/95/EC cuando se
envía con la fuente de poder
recomendada. Contacto europeo:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Países Bajos
A marca CE indica
conformidade com
as seguintes
diretivas:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Reformulação)
Além disso, o produto está em
conformidade com a Diretiva para
baixa tensão 2014/35/EU, quando
fornecido com a fonte de alimentação
recomendada. Contato na Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Holanda
CE
CE
: ‫بالمعايير التالية‬
ϭϵϵϱͬϱͬZΘdd v
2011/65/EU RoHS v
)‫(إعادة الصياغة‬
‫تلتزم بمعيار الجهد المنخفض‬
:
1995/5/EC R&TTE
2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast)
,
,
2014/35/EU
.
:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
2014/35/EU
.‫الطاقة الموصى به‬
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
第I類
I类
Clase I
Use somente cabos de dados
blindados com este sistema. Esta
unidade foi testada com cabos com
menos de 3 metros. Cabos com mais
de 3 metros não atendem o
desempenho de classe B.
Class I
1 ‫اﻟﻔﺌﺔ‬
CAUTION: Improper
battery replacement or
incompatible device usage
may result in risk of burns,
fire, explosion, or other
hazard. Dispose of lithium-ion
batteries according to local
regulations.
!
!
注意:电池更换不当或者用
于不兼容的设备可能导致燃
烧、起火、爆炸或其他危
险。请按照当地规定处置锂
电池。
LED Safety Statement
LEDs have been tested and classified
as “EXEMPT RISK GROUP” to the
standard: IEC 62471:2006.
ATTENTION : Un
remplacement inadéquat
de la batterie ou une
utilisation incompatible de
l'appareil peut présenter
des risques de brulures, d'incendie,
d'explosion ou d'autres dangers.
Jetez les piles en lithium-ion
conformément aux régulations
locales.
!
!
注意:不適當的電池更換或
者與不相容的裝置搭配使
用,可能導致燃燒、火災、
爆炸或其他危險。請依照當
地法規處置鋰電池。
Norme de sécurité sur les
DEL
Les DEL ont été testées et classées
en tant que « GROUPE DE RISQUE
EXEMPT » par rapport à la norme :
IEC 62471:2006.
MISE EN GARDE : Le
remplacement incorrect de
la pile ou l'usage d'un
appareil non compatible
peut représenter des
risques de brûlures, d'incendie,
d'explosion ou d'autres dangers.
Éliminez les piles lithium-ion usagées
conformément aux réglementations
locales.
Attenzione. La sostituzione
inadeguata delle batterie o
un uso incompatibile del
dispositivo possono
causare rischi di ustioni,
incendi, esplosioni o altri pericoli.
Smaltire le batterie agli ioni di litio in
conformità ai regolamenti locali.
VORSICHT. Ungeeignete
Ersatz-Akkus oder nicht
kompatible Gerätenutzung
kann zu Verbrennungen,
Feuer, Explosion oder
anderen Gefahren führen. Entsorgen
Sie die Lithium-Ionen-Batterien
gemäß den lokalen Richtlinien.
注意 : 誤った電池交換また
は互換性の無いデバイスの
使用により、やけど、発
火、爆発などの危険をお引
きおこす可能性がありま
す。リチウムイオン電池の廃棄につ
いては、地域の規則に従ってくださ
い。
주의 : 배터리를 부적절하게
교체하거나 호환되지 않는
장비를 사용하게 되면 , 화
상 , 화재 , 폭발 , 기타 위험
이 발생할 수 있습니다 . 지
역 규정에 따라 리튬 이온 배터리를 처
분하십시오 .
ВНИМАНИЕ: В случае неправильной замены
аккумулятора или использования несовместимого устройства существует опасность ожога, пожара, взрыва, а также других несчастных случаев. Утилизация литий‐ионных аккумуляторов должна производиться в соответствии с местными нормативами. Norme de sécurité DEL
Disposizione di sicurezza
LED
Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit
!
!
Les DEL ont été testées et classées «
GROUPE SANS RISQUE » selon la
norme : CEI 62471:2006.
!
!
I LED sono stati testati e classificati
come "GRUPPO ESENTE DA
RISCHI" rispetto allo standard: IEC
62471:2006.
!
!
Die LEDs wurden geprüft und gemäß
der Norm IEC 62471:2006 unter
„EXEMPT RISK GROUP“ eingestuft.
Заявление о безопасности
светодиода
PRECAUCIÓN: El
reemplazo inadecuado de
la batería o el uso de un
dispositivo incompatible
pueden dar como resultado
quemaduras, un incendio, explosión u
otros riesgos. Descarte todas las
baterías de litio según las
regulaciones locales.
!
ʤʰʩʠʹ ʤʬʬʥʱʡ ʤʬʬʥʱʤ ʺʴʬʧʤ :ʺʥʸʩʤʦ
ʬʲ .ʵʥʶʩʴ ʺʰʫʱʬ ʭʥʸʢʬ ʤʬʥʬʲ ʤʮʩʠʺʮ
ʤʧʮʥʮ ʩʣʩʡ ʲʶʡʺʤʬ ʤʬʬʥʱʤ ʺʫʬʹʤ
ʬʲ ʥʠ ʭʩʸʦʧʥʮʮ ʭʩʸʮʥʧʡ ʬʥʴʩʨʡ ʤʸʹʫʤ ʸʡʲʹ
ʯʩʠ .ʭʩʰʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʸʮʥʧ ʺʫʬʹʤʡ ʬʴʨʮʤ ʤʧʮʥʮ ʩʣʩ
ʤʴʹʠʡ ʤʺʥʠʪʩʬʹʤʬ ʥʠʤʬʬʥʱʤ ʺʠʳʥʸʹʬ
.ʤʬʩʢʸʤ
!
PRECAUCIÓN: El
reemplazo inadecuado de
la batería o el uso de un
dispositivo incompatible
puede presentar riesgo de
quemaduras, incendio, explosión, u
otro tipo de riesgos. Deseche las
baterías de iones de litio de acuerdo
a las normativas locales.
!
CUIDADO: a substituição
incorreta da bateria ou o
uso de um dispositivo
incompatível pode resultar
em riscos de queimaduras,
incêndio, explosão ou outros perigos.
Descarte as baterias de íon de lítio de
acordo com as regulamentações
locais.
!
‫ ﻗﺪ ﺗﻨﻔﺠﺮ اﻟﺒﻄﺎرﻳﺔ إذا ﺗﻢ اﺳﺘﺒﺪاﻟﻬﺎ ﺑﻨﻮع‬:‫ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻪ‬
‫ ﻳﺠﺐ اﻟﺘﺨﻠﺺ ﻣﻦ اﻟﺒﻄﺎرﻳﺔ ﰲ ﻣﻜﺎن‬.‫ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‬
‫ﻣﺆﻫﻞ ﻹﻋﺎدة اﻟﺘﺪوﻳﺮ أو ﺟﻬﺔ ﻣﺴﺆوﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ اﻟﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ‬
‫ ﻻ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺑﺤﺮق اﻟﺒﻄﺎرﻳﺔ أو ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺨﻠﺺ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻊ‬.‫ﻣﻊ اﳌﻮاد اﻟﺨﻄﺮة‬
.‫اﳌﺨﻠﻔﺎت اﻟﻌﺎدﻳﺔ اﻷﺧﺮى‬
!
Declaración de seguridad
del LED
Declaración de seguridad
del LED
Declaração de segurança do
LED
Los LED se han probado y clasificado
como “GRUPO EXENTO DE
RIESGOS” según la normativa: IEC
62471:2006.
Las LED han sido evaluadas y
clasificadas como “GRUPO LIBRE
DE RIESGOS” según la norma: IEC
62471:2006.
Os LEDs foram testados e
classificados como “GRUPO DE
RISCO ISENTO” conforme a norma:
IEC 62471:2006.
LED 安全声明
LED 安全聲明
LED の安全性について
LED 안전 고지 사항
LED 经测试属于 IEC 62471:2006 标
准的 “ 豁免风险组 ”(EXEMPT RISK
GROUP)。
LED 經測試被列為 IEC 62471:2006
標準的 「豁免風險組」 (EXEMPT
RISK GROUP)。
LED は IEC 62471:2006 安全規格に
対してテスト済みで、「EXEMPT
RISK GROUP ( リスクグループ除外
)」に分類されています。
LED 는 표준 IEC 62471:2006 에 대해
테스트되어 "EXEMPT RISK GROUP"
으로 분류되었습니다 .
CB Scheme
Plan OC (organismes de
certification)
Schéma OC
Schema CB
CB-Zertifizierung
Esquema CB
Esquema CB
Esquema CB
Certifié selon la norme CEI 60950-1
seconde édition (schéma OC).
Certificato in base allo Schema CB
IEC 60950-1, seconda edizione.
CB-zertifiziert gemäß IEC 60950,
Second Edition.
Se ha certificado que cumple el
esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda
edición.
Se ha certificado que cumple con el
esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda
edición.
Certificação CB Scheme IEC 609501, Segunda edição.
Certified to CB Scheme IEC 60950-1,
Second Edition.
Certifié CB CEI 60950-1, deuxième
édition.
Светодиоды прошли испытания и
отнесены к «БЕЗРИСКОВОЙ ГРУППЕ»
согласно стандарту МЭК 62471:2006.
LED ʺʥʸʥʰ - ʺʥʧʩʨʡ ʺʸʤʶʤ
"ʯʥʫʩʱ ʺʥʬʥʨʰʫ" ʥʢʥʥʱʥ ʥʷʣʡʰ LED-ʤ ʺʥʸʥʰ
IEC 62471:2006 :ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ
LED ‫ﺑﻴﺎن ﺳﻼﻣﺔ‬
ǀŸǞƵƆƵż)ƾƷƱƸƶƫůȶ LED ljƸŮƾƫžȤƾƃƄųȚƖ
:ȤƾƸƯƵƴŽƾ ȹƲźȶ(ǍƭƒȚǜžǑƴƈƄŽȚ
.IEC 62471:2006
CB 方案
CB Scheme
CB Scheme
CB Scheme
Схема CB
已通过 CB 方案 IEC 60950-1 第二版
的认证。
經過認證符合 CB Scheme IEC
60950-1 標準第二版。
CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second
Edition に認定されています。
CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second
Edition 인증을 받았습니다 .
Сертификация согласно схеме CB
МЭК 60950-1, издание второе.
Patents
Brevets
Brevets
Brevetti
Patente
Patentes
Patentes
Patentes
For patent information, refer to
www.hsmpats.com.
Veuillez consulter le site
www.hsmpats.com pour obtenir des
renseignements au sujet du brevet.
Pour plus d’informations sur les
brevets, visitez la page
www.hsmpats.com.
Per i dettagli sui brevetti, fare
riferimento al sito Web
www.hsmpats.com.
Patentinformationen sind unter
www.hsmpats.com erhältlich.
Para obtener información sobre las
patentes, visite www.hsmpats.com.
Para obtener información sobre
patentes, consulte
www.hsmpats.com.
Para obter informações sobre
patente, consulte www.hsmpats.com.
专利
專利
特許
특허
Патенты
有关专利信息,请参阅
www.hsmpats.com。
相關專利資訊請參閱
www.hsmpats.com 中的說明。
特許情報については、
www.hsmpats.com を参照してくだ
さい。
특허 정보는 www.hsmpats.com 를 참
조하십시오 .
Информация о патентах приведена
на веб-странице www.hsmpats.com.
Laser Safety Statement
Déclaration de sécurité
relative au laser
Déclaration de sécurité laser
Dichiarazione sulla
sicurezza del dispositivo
laser
Hinweis zur Lasersicherheit
If the following label is attached to
your product, it indicates the product
contains a
laser:
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
This device has been tested in
accordance with and complies with
IEC60825-1 ed2.0 and 21 CFR
1040.10 and 1040.11, except for
deviations pursuant to Laser Notice
No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
LASER LIGHT, DO NOT STARE
INTO BEAM, CLASS 2 LASER
PRODUCT, 1.0 mW MAX OUTPUT:
630-680nM.
Caution - use of controls or
adjustments or performance of
procedures other than those specified
herein may result in hazardous
radiation exposure.
Si l’étiquette suivante est apposée à
votre produit, cela signifie que le
produit contient un laser :
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Cet appareil a été testé et reconnu
conforme aux normes IEC60825-1
ed2.0 et 21 CFR 1040.10 et
1040.11sauf pour les dérogations en
accord avec l'avis de conformité sur
les lasers No. 50, en date du 24 juin
2007.
LUMIÈRE LASER, NE PAS
REGARDER DIRECTEMENT DANS
LE FAISCEAU, PRODUIT LASER DE
CLASSE 2, SORTIE MAX. DE 1,0
MW : 630-680 nm.
Mise en garde – l’utilisation de
contrôles ou d’ajustements ou de
performance de procédures autres
que ceux spécifiées dans la présente
peut provoquer une exposition
dangereuse au rayonnement.
Si l'étiquette suivante est attachée à
votre produit, elle indique que le
produit contient un laser
:
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Cet appareil a été testé et certifié
conforme aux normes CEI 60825-1
ed2.0, 21 CFR 1040.10 et 21 CFR
1040.11, à l'exception des déviations
selon le document Laser Notice n° 50
en date du 24 juin 2007.
ATTENTION, LUMIÈRE LASER : NE
PAS FIXER LE FAISCEAU,
PRODUIT LASER DE CLASSE 2 1
mW SORTIE MAX :630-680 nM.
L'utilisation de contrôles ou réglages
ou la réalisation de procédures autres
que ceux spécifiés dans la
documentation utilisateur peut
entraîner une exposition à des
rayonnements dangereux.
La presenza della seguente etichetta
sul prodotto indica che il prodotto
contiene un
laser:
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Questo dispositivo è stato testato in
base a ed è conforme agli standard
IEC60825-1 ed. 2.0 e 21, CFR
1040.10 e 1040.11, ad eccezione
delle deviazioni ai sensi del
documento Laser Notice No. 50,
datato 24 giugno 2007.
LUCE LASER, NON FISSARE IL
RAGGIO LASER, PRODOTTO DI
CLASSE 2, POTENZA DI USCITA
MAX 1.0 mW : 630-680nM.
Un utilizzo dei comandi, dei dispositivi
di regolazione o delle procedure non
conforme a quanto specificato nella
documentazione d'uso può
determinare un'esposizione
pericolosa alle radiazioni.
Wenn Ihr Produkt mit dem folgenden
Etikett gekennzeichnet ist, bedeutet
dies, dass das Produkt einen Laser
enthält:
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Dieses Gerät wurde geprüft und
erfüllt die Anforderungen von
IEC60825-1 ed2.0, 21 CFR 1040.10
und 1040.11, mit Ausnahme von
Abweichungen gemäß Laser Notice
Nr. 50, vom 24. Juni 2007.
LASERSTRAHLUNG, NICHT IN DEN
STRAHL BLICKEN,
LASERPRODUKT DER KLASSE 2,
MAXIMALE ENERGIE DER
LASERSTRAHLUNG 1,0 mW: 630680 nM.
Die Verwendung oder Einstellung von
Reglern bzw. die Ausführung von
anderen als in dieser
Bedienungsanleitung beschriebenen
Abläufen kann zu gefährlicher
Laserstrahlung führen.
CB Scheme
IEC ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ ʸʹʥʠʮ ʸʶʥʮʤ CB Scheme
.ʤʩʰʹ ʤʸʥʣʤʮ ,CB Scheme ʯʥʢʸʠ ʬʹ 60950-1
ʭʩʨʰʨʴ
ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ ʯʩʩʲ ,ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʬʲ ʲʣʩʮʬ
www.hsmpats.com
.‫ اﻹﺻﺪاراﻟﺜﺎﻧﻲ‬،CB IEC 60950-1 ‫ﻣﺨﻄﻂ‬
CB ‫ﻣﺨﻄﻂ‬
‫ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ‬
‫ﺑﺮاءات اﻻﺧﱰاع‬
‫ ﻳُﺮﺟﻰ اﻟﺮﺟﻮع‬،‫ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮل ﻋﲆ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎت ﺗﺨﺺ ﺑﺮاءة اﻻﺧﱰاع‬
.www.hsmpats.com ‫إﱃ‬
Declaración de seguridad
del láser
Declaración de seguridad de
láser
Declaração de segurança de
laser
Si la siguiente etiqueta se encuentra
adherida al producto, indica que éste
contiene un
láser:
Si la siguiente etiqueta está adherida
al producto, indica que éste contiene
un
láser:
Se a seguinte etiquete estiver colada
no seu produto, indica que ele contém
um
laser:
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Este dispositivo se ha probado de
acuerdo con las normativas
IEC60825-1 ed2.0 y 21 CFR 1040.10
y 1040.11 y se ha certificado que las
cumple, excepto en lo referente a
desviaciones según el aviso sobre
láser n.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007.
RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR
FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO
LÁSER DE CLASE 2, POTENCIA
MÁXIMA 1 mw: 630-680 nm.
El uso de controles, ajustes o
procedimientos diferentes a los
descritos en la documentación del
usuario puede suponer la exposición
a radiaciones peligrosas.
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Este dispositivo ha sido evaluado
según las normas IEC60825-1 ed2.0
y 21 CFR 1040.10 y 1040.11, y
cumple con ellas, excepto por las
diferencias en virtud del Aviso sobre
láser N.º 50 del 24 de junio de 2007.
RAYO LÁSER, NO MIRAR
FIJAMENTE EL HAZ, PRODUCTO
LÁSER DE LA CLASE 2, POTENCIA
MÁXIMA 1 mW:630-680 nm.
El uso de controles, ajustes o
procedimientos diferentes a los
indicados en la documentación para
el usuario puede provocar la
exposición a radiaciones peligrosas.
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
Este dispositivo foi testado de acordo
e em conformidade com as normas
IECC60825-1 ed2.0 e 21 CFR
1040.10 e 1040.11, exceto por
divergências de acordo com o Laser
Notice nº50, datado de 24 de junho
de 2007.
LUZ DE LASER, NÃO OLHE
FIXAMENTE PARA O FEIXE,
PRODUTO A LASER CLASSE 2,
SAÍDA MÁXIMA DE 1,0 mW: 630-680
nM.
A utilização de controles ou ajustes
ou a execução de procedimentos de
modo diferente do especificado na
documentação do usuário pode
resultar em exposição nociva à
radiação.
激光安全声明
鐳射安全聲明
レーザーの安全性について
레이저 안전 고지 사항
如果您的产品附有以下标签,说明产
品具有激光功能:
若產品上貼有下列之標籤,即表示該
產品具有雷射功能:
製品に次のラベルが添付されている
場合は、製品にレーザーが含まれて
いることを示しています。
제품에 다음과 같은 표시가 부착되어
있는 경우 제품에 레이저가 포함되어
있음을 의미합니다
.
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
此设备已经过测试,符合 IEC608251 ed2.0 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 和
1040.11 标准, 2007 年 6 月 24 日颁
布的第 50 号激光通告所规定的偏离
除外。
激光辐射,不可凝视光束, 2 类激光
产品,最大输出为 1.0 mW:630680nM。
此裝置已經過測試,符合 IEC608251 ed2.0 以及 21 CFR 1040.10 與
1040.11 標準,但 2007 年 6 月 24 日
發佈的第 50 號鐳射通告中所述的偏
差不在此限。
雷射光,請勿直視雷射光束,CLASS
2 雷射產品,1.0 mW 最大輸出功率:
630-680nM。
如果使用了用户文档范围之外的操作
步骤控制或调整或执行,可能会导致
危险的辐射暴露。
若使用的控制、調整或執行等程序並
非依照使用者文件中所指示,可能會
發生危險,導致輻射曝露。
Product Environmental
Information
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
この装置は、IEC60825-1:
1993+A1+A2 と、21 CFR 1040.10 お
よび 1040.11 に従ってテストされ、
Laser Notice No. 50 (2007 年 6 月
24 日 ) に従うことによる逸脱を除き
適合しています。
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
본 장치는 IEC60825-1 ed2.0 과 21
CFR 1040.10 및 1040.11 에 따라 테
스트되었으며 이를 준수하는 것으로
확인되었습니다 . 단 , 2007 년 6 월 24
일자 Laser Notice No. 50 에 의거한 편
차는 제외합니다 .
レーザー光はビームをのぞき込まな
いでください。クラス 2 レーザー製
品、1.0 mW 最大出力 : 630-680nM
레이저 광선 , 안구에 직접적인 광선
노출 금지 , CLASS 2 레이저 제품 ,
1.0mW 최대 출력 : 630-680nM
ユーザー マニュアルで指定されてい
ない制御や調整の使用または手順の
実行によって、有害な放射線照射が
発生する可能性があります。
사용자 설명서에 명시된 내용 이외의
절차를 통해 장치를 조작하거나 조정
하거나 작동하는 경우 인체에 심각한
위해를 끼치는 방사선에 노출될 수 있
습니다 .
Renseignements relatifs à
l’environnement à propos
des produits
Informations
environnementales sur les
produits
Reportez-vous à la page
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental pour obtenir des
renseignements concernant les
directives RoHS/REACH/WEEE.
Reportez-vous au site
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental pour obtenir les
informations sur les directives RoHS/
REACH/WEEE.
产品环境信息
產品環境資訊
製品の環境情報
제품 환경 정보
有关 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 信息,
请参阅 www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 。
請參閱 www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 以瞭解 RoHS /
REACH / WEEE 資訊。
RoHS / REACH / WEEE に関する情
報については、
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental を参照してください。
RoHS / REACH / WEEE 정보는
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 에서 참조하십시오 .
Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental for the RoHS / REACH
/ WEEE information.
Normes TÜV R
TÜV R listed: UL 60950-1, Second Edition and
CSA C22.2 No.60950-1-07, Second Edition.
Homologué TÜV R : UL 60950-1, seconde
édition et CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1-07,
seconde édition.
TÜV Rheinland
C
US
US
ʸʦʩʩʬ - ʺʥʧʩʨʡ ʺʸʤʶʤ
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
Это устройство прошло испытания
согласно следующим стандартам,
которым оно соответствует: МЭК
60825-1 ред. 2.0 и 21 CFR 1040.10 и
1040.11, с учетом разрешений на
отступление от требований согласно
Уведомлению о лазерах № 50 от 24
июня 2007 г.
ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ СВЕТ, НЕ СМОТРИТЕ
НА ЛУЧ, ЛАЗЕРНЫЙ ПРОДУКТ
КЛАССА 2, 10 МвТ
МАКСИМАЛЬНОЙ МОЩНОСТИ:
630-680нМ.
Внимание – использование
средств управления,
регулирования или изменения
производительности процедур,
отличающихся от указанных в
данном документе, может привести
к опасному воздействию радиации.
Unter www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental finden Sie
Informationen über RoHS/REACH/
WEEE.
Экологическая
информация о продукции
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
ʯʷʺ ʭʲ ʤʮʠʺʤʡʥ ʩʴ-ʬʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ
21 CFR 1040.10 ʯʫʥ IEC60825-1 ed2.0
Notice No. 50, -ʮ ʺʥʩʨʱ ʨʲʮʬ ,1040.11 -ʥ
.2007 ,ʩʰʥʩʡ 24
ʸʦʩʩʬ ʸʶʥʮ ,ʯʸʷʤ ʪʥʺʬ ʨʩʡʤʬ ʯʩʠ ,ʸʦʩʩʬ ʸʥʠ
mW: 1.0 ʬʹ ʺʩʡʸʮ ʤʷʥʴʺ ,CLASS 2 ʢʥʱʮ
.630-680nM
ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡ ʥʠ ʤʮʠʺʤ ʥʠ ʭʩʸʷʡʡ ʹʥʮʩʹʤ - ʺʥʸʩʤʦ
ʭʩʬʥʬʲ ʺʠʦʡ ʯʩʥʶʮʤ ʩʴ-ʬʲ ʭʰʩʠʹ ʭʩʫʩʬʤʺʤ ʬʹ
.ʤʰʩʸʷʬ ʺʰʫʥʱʮ ʤʴʩʹʧʬ ʭʥʸʢʬ
IEC60825- ǍƸƁƾƯƵƴŽƾ ȹƲźȶȥƾƷƐȚȚnjƀȤƾƃƄųȚƖ
ȔƾƶƅƄŴƾŮ 1040.11ȶȆCFR 1040.10 21 ȶȆ1:2007
Ȇ50ǛŻȤȤǎƸƴŽƾŮȨƾƒȚȤƾƯŵȁȚƿűǞƙȝƾźȚǍƇſǽȚ
.2007ȆǞƸſǞƁ 24NJƁȤƾƄŮ
ǃƄƶž .ȬƾƯƪŽȚǠźǘƁNjƇƄŽƾŮǛƲůǽ .ȤǎƸƴŽȚȔǞǤ
ȟȚǍųȂŽǟƫŻLjȚNjƑȚ .2ǀƂƱŽȚǜžȤǎƸƴŽƾŮǚƵƯƁ
.ǍŽǞžǞſƾſ 630-680 :ȝȚȶǠƴƴž 1.0
ȶȖȆǛƳƇƄŽȚǍǧƾƶŸȳȚNjƈƄŴȚȸȢƻƁNjŻ –ǍƁnjƎ
ȜȢNjƤȚǙƴůǍƸŹȷǍųȖȝȚȔȚǍűƼŮȳƾƸƲŽȚȶȖȆȝǾƁNjƯƄŽȚ
.ȜǍƭƒȚȝƾŸƾƯŵȁȚǟŽȘȩǍƯƄŽȚȲƾƵƄŲȚǟŽȘƾƶƀ
Información ambiental del
producto
Información ambiental de
producto
Informações ambientais
sobre produtos
Consulte www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental para obtener
información sobre RoHS/REACH/
WEEE.
Consulte la información RoHS/
REACH/WEEE en
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental.
Consulte a página
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental para obter
informações sobre as normas RoHS/
REACH/WEEE.
ʩʸʶʥʮ ʬʹ ʩʺʡʩʡʱʤ ʲʣʩʮʤ ʺʥʣʥʠ ʭʩʨʸʴʬ
:ʺʡʥʺʫʡ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ
www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental for
the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information.
ΞΗϧϣϠϟΔϳ΋ϳΑϟ΍ΕΎϔλ΍ϭϣϟ΍
ϰϟ·ωϭΟέϟ΍ϰΟέ˵ϳ
www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental
ΕΎϬϳΟϭΗϝϭΣΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ
.5R+65($&+:(((
Информация о соответствии
требованиям RoHS / REACH /
WEEE приведена на сайте
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental.
이 기기는 가정용 (B 급 ) 전자파적합기기로서 주
로 가정에서 사용하는 것을 목적으로 하며 ,
모든 지역에서 사용할 수 있습니다 .
LASER LIGHT- DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
᧨
᧨䷘侩 曂⺓䞱❐ RAYONNEMENT LASER NE PAS
曂⺓⏘᧨嵚▎䦃尥曂⺓⏘㧮
REGARDER DANS LE FAISCEAU. APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 2. MAX. 1mW:
630-680 nm IEC 60825-1:2007. Complies with 21 CFR 1040.10 and 1040.11
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated June 24, 2007.
If the following label is attached to your product, the product
meets Korean agency approval:
ȤǎƸƴŽƾŮǀǧƾƒȚǀžǾƉŽȚȜǍƪſ
ǃƄƶƓȚȴȖǟŽȘǍƸƪƁǝſƼźȆǃƄƶƓƾŮƾ ȹƲźǍžǠŽƾƄŽȚǘƫƴƓȚȴƾżȚȣȘ
:ȤǎƸƴŽȚǟƴŸȸǞƄƇƁ
ʸʶʥʮʬʺʴʸʥʶʮʤʠʡʤʺʩʥʥʺʤʭʠ
ʸʦʩʬʬʩʫʮʸʶʥʮʤʹʤʠʸʮʤʦʪʬʹ
Если к изделию прикреплена
нижеуказанная этикетка, то это
означает, что в изделии
имеется
Informationen zur
Umweltverträglichkeit von
Produkten
Consultare il sito web
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental per informazioni su
RoHS/REACH/RAEE.
TÜV R Statement
TÜV Rheinland
C
Informazioni ambientali
relative al prodotto
Заявление о безопасности
лазера
Este produto está homologado pela ANATEL, de acordo com os
procedimentos regulamentados pela Resolução No. 242/2000 e
atende aos requisitos técnicos aplicados.
Para maiores informações, consulte o site da ANATEL –
www.anatel.gov.br
This product is EMC B grade equipment,
intended for residential use. This equipment can
be used in any area.
Modelo: 1911i
1931-14-1571
(01)07898927490133
" Este equipamento opera em caráter secundário, isto é, não tem
direito a proteção contra interferência prejudicial, mesmo de estações
do mesmo tipo, e não pode causar interferência a sistemas operando
em caráter primário."
产品中有害物质的名称及含量
(Names and Content of Hazardous Substances in the Product)
有害物质
(Hazardous Substances)
部件名称 (Parts Name)
铅 (Pb)
汞 (Hg)
镉 (Cd)
六价铬 (Cr6+)
多溴联苯 (PBB)
多溴二苯醚 (PBDE)
成像式二维条码阅读器 (2D Imager)
x
o
o
o
o
o
印刷电路板 (PCB)
x
o
o
o
o
o
外壳 (Housing)
o
o
o
o
o
o
连线 (Cables)
o
o
o
o
o
o
本表格依据 SJ/T11364 的规定编制。(The table is created by SJ/T11364 requirement.)
o: 表示该有害物质在该部件所有均质材料中的含量均在 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求以下。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.)
x: 表示该有害物质至少在该部件的某一均质材料中的含量超出 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials for this part is above the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.)
This document was prepared and executed in the English
language. In the event this document is translated into another
language and a conflict arises between the English version and
a non-English version, the English version shall prevail, it being
recognized and acknowledged that the English language
version most clearly expresses the intent of the parties. Any
notice or communication given in connection with this document
must include a version in the English language.
Ce document a été préparé et exécuté dans la langue anglaise.
Dans l’éventualité où le document serait traduit dans une autre
langue et qu'un litige survenait entre la version en anglais et la
version autre qu'en anglais, la version en anglais prévaudra,
étant confirmé et reconnu que la version en anglais exprime de
façon plus précise l’intention des parties. Tout avis ou toute
communication relatif à ce document doit inclure une version en
anglais.
Ce document a été préparé et finalisé en anglais. Si ce
document est traduit dans une autre langue et si un conflit
survient entre la version en anglais et la version traduite, la
version en anglais prévaudra tant il est reconnu et établi qu’elle
exprime le plus clairement les intentions des parties. Tout avis
ou communication produit en relation avec ce document doit
comporter une version en anglais.
Questo documento è stato preparato e redatto in lingua inglese.
In caso di traduzione in altre lingue, nell’eventualità sorgano
conflitti fra la versione non inglese e quella inglese, prevarrà
quest’ultima in quanto viene riconosciuto e accettato che la
versione in lingua inglese esprime più chiaramente gli accordi
fra le parti. Qualsiasi notifica o comunicazione inviata in
rapporto a questo documento deve includere una versione in
lingua inglese.
Dieses Dokument wurde in englischer Sprache erstellt und
ausgefertigt. Wenn dieses Dokument in eine andere Sprache
übersetzt wird, und ein Konflikt zwischen der englischen und
nicht-englischen Fassung auftritt, hat die englische Fassung
Vorrang, da die Parteien anerkennen, dass die Fassung in
englischer Sprache ihren Absichten am deutlichsten Ausdruck
verleiht. Alle Hinweise oder Mitteilungen in Zusammenhang mit
diesem Dokument müssen auch in einer Fassung in englischer
Sprache erfolgen.
Originalmente, este documento se creó y redactó en inglés. En
caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja un conflicto entre
la versión en inglés y la versión en otro idioma, prevalecerá la
versión en inglés. Se reconoce y admite que, en la versión en
inglés, expresa la intención de las partes con más claridad.
Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con
este documento debe incluir una versión en inglés.
Este documento se preparó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que
se traduzca a otro idioma y surja algún conflicto entre la versión
en inglés y la del idioma extranjero, prevalecerá la versión en
inglés, dado que se reconoce y admite que la versión en inglés
expresa más claramente la intención de las partes. Cualquier
aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este
documento deberá incluir una versión en inglés.
Este documento foi preparado e feito em língua inglesa. Se este
documento for traduzido para outro idioma e surgirem conflitos
entre a versão em inglês e a versão no outro idioma, a versão
em inglês prevalecerá, sendo reconhecido e atestado que a
versão em língua inglesa expressa mais claramente a intenção
das partes. Qualquer comunicação ou aviso relacionado a este
documento deve conter a versão em inglês.
本文档以英文撰写。如果本文档的其他语言版本与英文版本存
在冲突,则以英文版本为准。各方一致认可和同意英文版本最
清楚地表达了各自的意图。任何与本文档相关的声明或沟通,
都应包括英文版本。
本文件的原稿是以英文撰寫。如果本文件翻譯為其他語言,而
英文版和非英文版之間產生衝突,應以英文版為準,並且各方
一致認同並確認英文版最能夠清楚地表達各方的意圖。凡是所
有與本文件有關之公告或通訊,都必須包含英文的版本。
本書は英語で作成され発行されています。本書を他の言語に
翻訳し、英語版と英語以外の版に矛盾が生じた場合は、関係
者の意図を最も明確に表すものが英語版であることを認識お
よび承諾し、英語版が優先するものとします。さらに、本書
に関連して与えられる告知や通知は、すべて英語版を含むも
のとします。
본 문서는 영어로 준비되어 작성된 것입니다. 본 문서를 다른 언
어로 번역했는데 영문본과 번역본 사이에 상충하는 부분이 발생
하는 경우에는 영문본이 우선하며, 영문본이 양쪽 당사자의 의
도를 가장 명확하게 표현하고 있음을 인식하고 확인합니다. 본
문서와 관련한 모든 고지 또는 전달 사항에는 영문본이 동봉되
어야 합니다.
Данный документ был подготовлен и выполнен на
английском языке. При переводе данного документа на
другой язык, в случае возникновения противоречий между
английской версией и версией на другом языке, английская
версия имеет преимущественную силу. Данным
признается, что версия документа на английском языке
наиболее четко выражает намерения сторон. Любые
уведомления или письма, направляемые в связи с данным
документом, должны включать в себя версию на
английском языке.
For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and
click Resources > Warranty.
Pour obtenir des informations sur la garantie, consultez le site
www.honeywellaidc.com et cliquez sur Ressources >
Garantie.
Per informazioni sulla garanzia, andare a
www.honeywellaidc.com e fare clic su Resources > Warranty.
Die Garantiebestimmungen finden Sie unter
www.honeywellaidc.com. Klicken Sie dort auf Ressourcen >
Garantie.
Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite
www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía.
Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite
www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía.
Para obter informações sobre a garantia, vá para
www.honeywellaidc.com e clique em Resources (Recursos) >
Warranty (Garantia).
欲了解保修信息,请访 www.honeywellaidc.com,单击
Resources (资源)> Warranty (保修)。
如需檢視保固資訊,請瀏覽 www.honeywellaidc.com,然後按
一下 Resources > Warranty。
保証については、www.honeywellaidc.com にて、Resources >
Warranty とクリックしてください。
보증 정보를 보려면 www.honeywellaidc.com 으로 이동하여
Resources > Warranty 를 클릭하십시오 .
Подробную информацию о гарантии см. на сайте
www.honeywellaidc.com в разделе Resources > Warranty.
Informace o záruce naleznete na stránce
www.honeywellaidc.com po kliknutí na Resources > Warranty.
Ak chcete získať informácie o záruke, prejdite na stránku
www.honeywellaidc.com a kliknite na Resources (Zdroje) >
Warranty (Záruka).
Aby uzyskać informacje na temat gwarancji, wejdź na stronę
www.honeywellaidc.com i kliknij Zasoby > Gwarancja.
Garanti bilgileri için www.honeywellaidc.com adresine gidin ve
Kaynaklar > Garanti ögelerini tıklayın.
ʺʡʥʺʫʬʥʰʴʠʰʺʥʩʸʧʠʤʺʥʣʥʠʲʣʩʮʬ
ΓέΎϳίΑϝοϔΗˬϥΎϣοϟ΍ϥ΄ηΑΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ
.Resources > Warranty ʥʷʩʬʷʤʥwww.honeywellaidc.com
Ωέ΍ϭϣϟ΍< ϥΎϣοϟ΍ϕϭϓέϘϧ΍ϭwww.honeywellaidc.com
ʤʴʹʬ ʭʢʸʥʺʩ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʹ ʤʸʷʮʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʷʴʥʤʥ ʪʸʲʰ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮ
,ʺʮʢʸʥʺʮʤ ʤʱʸʢʤʥ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʥʲʮʹʮ ʯʩʡ ʤʸʩʺʱ ʤʬʢʺʺʥ ʺʸʧʠ
ʤʱʸʢʤ ʩʫ ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʬʲ ʭʫʱʥʮ .ʺʲʡʥʷʤ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʩʤʺ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ
ʤʲʣʥʤ ʬʫ .ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʺʰʥʥʫ ʺʠʸʺʥʩʡ ʸʥʸʡʤ ʯʴʥʠʡ ʺʠʨʡʮ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ
.ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʠʬʥʬʫʬ ʺʡʩʩʧ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʬ ʸʹʷʤʡ ʸʱʮʩʺʹ
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
‫ إذا ﺗﺮﺟﻤﺔ ﻫﺬا‬.‫ﺗﻢ إﻋﺪاد ﻫﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ وﺗﻨﻔﻴﺬه ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ‬
‫اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ إﱃ ﻟﻐﺎت أﺧﺮى وﻛﺎن ﻫﻨﺎك اﺧﺘﻼف اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي وإﺻﺪار‬
‫ ﺣﻴﺚ إن اﻹﺻﺪار‬،‫ ُ ﺟﻰ اﻻﻟﺘﺰام ﺟﺎء ﰲ اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي‬،‫آﺧﺮ‬
‫ ﻳﺠﺐ أن‬.‫اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي ﻫﻮ اﻟﺬي ﻳﻌﱪ ﺑﻮﺿﻮح وﴏاﺣﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻴﺔ اﻷﻃﺮاف‬
‫ﺗﺸﻤﻞ أﻳﺔ إﺷﻌﺎرات أو اﺗﺼﺎﻻت ذات ﺻﻠﺔ ﺑﻬﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻋﲆ إﺻﺪار ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ‬
.‫اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ‬
RegSht-1911 Rev E
6/16
Rev B
FCC Part 15 Statement
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Caution: Any changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by Honeywell may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment.
FCC Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed
and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,
the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
•
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
•
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
•
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
•
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
RF Exposure
The equipment complies with FCC RF exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. The equipment must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.
Para su uso en México, la operación de este equipo está sujeta a las siguientes dos condiciones:
1. Es posible que este equipo o dispositivo no cause interferencia perjudicial.
2. Este equipo o dispositivo debe aceptar cualquier interferencia, incluyendo la que pueda causar su operación no deseada.
Canadian Compliance
Conformité à la règlementation canadienne
This ISM device complies with Canadian RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Cet appareil ISM est conforme à la norme CNR-210 du Canada.
Son fonctionnement est assujetti aux conditions suivantes :
1. Cet appareil ne doit pas causer de brouillage préjudiciable.
2. Cet appareil doit pouvoir accepter tout brouillage reçu, y compris le brouillage pouvant causer un fonctionnement indésirable.
Use only shielded data cables with
this system. This unit has been tested
with cables less than 3 meters.
Cables greater than 3 meters may not
meet class B performance.
Utiliser uniquement des câbles de
données blindés avec ce système.
L’appareil a été testé avec des
câbles de moins de 3 mètres. Les
câbles de longueur supérieure à 3
mètres peuvent ne pas satisfaire à la
performance de la classe B.
Utilisez uniquement des câbles de
données blindés avec ce système. Ce
dispositif a été testé avec des câbles
de moins de 3 mètres. Il est possible
que les câbles de plus de 3 mètres ne
permettent pas d’atteindre des
performances de classe B.
Utilizzare solo cavi dati schermati con
questo sistema. Questa unità è stata
testata con cavi di lunghezza
inferiore a 3 metri. I cavi di lunghezza
superiore a 3 metri potrebbero non
essere conformi alle prestazioni di
classe B.
Für dieses System nur abgeschirmte
Datenkabel verwenden. Dieses
System wurde mit Kabeln unter 3
Metern Länge geprüft. Kabel mit einer
Länge von über 3 Metern erfüllen
möglicherweise nicht die Richtlinien
der Klasse B.
此系统仅能使用屏蔽数据电缆。 此设
备是以短于 3 米的电缆进行的测试。
长度超过 3 米的电缆可能无法满足 B
级性能。
此系統只能使用包覆的資料傳輸線。
此裝置是使用不到 3 公尺長的電纜進
行測試。 超過 3 公尺長的電纜可能無
法達到 B 級裝置效能。
このシステムにはシールド付きデー
タケーブルのみを使用してください。
この装置は長さ 3 m 以下のケーブル
でテストされています。3 m 以上の
ケーブルはクラス B の性能を満たさ
ない場合があります。
이 시스템에는 차폐된 데이터 케이블
만 사용하십시오 . 본 장치는 3 미터
미만의 케이블로 테스트를 받았습니
다 . 3 미터를 초과하는 케이블을 사용
하면 Class B 성능을 만족시키지 못할
수 있습니다 .
Используйте с этой системой только
экранированные кабели передачи
данных. Это устройство прошло
испытания с использованием
кабелей длиной менее 3 метров.
Рабочие характеристики кабелей
длиной свыше 3 м могут не
соответствовать классу В.
The CE marking
indicates
compliance with the
following directives:
• 1995/5/EC
R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU
RoHS (Recast)
In addition, complies to 2014/35/EU
Low Voltage Directive, when shipped
with recommended power supply.
European contact:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Le marquage CE
indique la conformité
avec les directives
suivantes :
• 1995/5/CE
R & TTE
• 2011/65/UE –
RoHS (Refonte)
De plus, ce produit est conforme à la
Directive européenne 2014/35/EU
relative aux basses tensions lorsqu’il
est expédié avec le bloc
d’alimentation recommandé.
Personne-ressource en Europe :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Les Pays-Bas
Le marquage CE
indique la conformité
aux directives
suivantes :
• 1995/5/CE
R & TTE
• 2011/65/UE RoHS
(refonte)
De plus, indique la conformité à la
directive 2014/35/EU Basse tension,
lorsque le dispositif est livré avec
l’alimentation électrique
recommandée. Contact en Europe :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Pays-Bas
La marcatura CE
indica conformità
alle seguenti
direttive:
• Direttiva R&TTE
1995/5/CE
• Direttiva RoHS
2011/65/UE
(rifusione)
È inoltre conforme ai sensi della
Direttiva bassa tensione 2014/35/EU,
se spedito con l'alimentatore
consigliato. Contatto in Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Paesi Bassi
Die CEKennzeichnung
signalisiert die
Konformität mit
folgenden
Richtlinien:
• 1995/5/EG R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Recast)
Weiterhin entspricht dieses Produkt
der Niederspannungsrichtlinie 2014/
35/EU, wenn es mit dem
empfohlenen Netzteil geliefert wird.
Ansprechpartner Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Niederlande
CE 标记表示符合以
下指令:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(新版)
此外,在随附建议的电源时,设备还
符合 2014/35/EU 低电压指令的要
求。欧洲联系信息:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE 標記表示符合下
列指令:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(重訂)
此外,出廠時如附帶建議的電源,亦
符合 2014/35/EU 低電壓指令。歐洲
聯絡資訊:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE マークは、本装置
が次の指令に準拠し
ていることを示しま
す。
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
( 改正 )
また、推奨電源付きで出荷されてい
る場合は、2014/35/EU Low Voltage
Directive にも準拠しています。欧州
でのお問い合わせ :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
CE 마크는 다음 지침
을 준수함을 나타냅
니다 .
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Recast)
또한 , 권장 전원 공급장치와 함께 배
송된 경우에는 2014/35/EU Low
Voltage Directive( 저전압 지침 ) 를
준수합니다 . 유럽 연락처 :
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Маркировка CE
означает
соответствие
требованиям
следующих
директив:
• 1995/5/EC
Директива о
радио- и
телекоммуникацио
нном оборудовании
• 2011/65/EU
Директива RoHS
(исправленная)
Кроме того, соответствует
требованиям директивы по
низковольтному оборудованию
2014/35/EU при поставке с
рекомендованным источником
питания. Контактное лицо в
Европе:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Class I
Catégorie I
Classe I
Klasse I
Utilice sólo cables de datos blindados
con este sistema. Esta unidad se ha
probado con cables de longitud
inferior a 3 metros. Cables superiores
a 3 metros quizá no satisfagan los
requisitos de rendimiento de la
clase B.
ʭʩʫʫʥʱʮ ʭʩʰʥʺʰ ʩʬʡʫʡ ʹʮʺʹʤʬ ʹʩ ,ʥʦ ʺʫʸʲʮʡ
ʺʥʧʴ ʬʹ ʪʸʥʠʡ ʭʩʬʡʫ ʭʲ ʷʣʡʰ ʤʦ ʸʩʹʫʮ .ʣʡʬʡ
3 ʬʲ ʤʬʥʲ ʭʫʸʥʠʹ ʭʩʬʡʫʹ ʯʫʺʩʩ .ʭʩʸʨʮ 3-ʮ
ʭʩʸʩʹʫʮ ʬʹ ʭʩʲʥʶʩʡʤ ʺʥʹʩʸʣʡ ʥʣʮʲʩ ʠʬ ʭʩʸʨʮ
.B ʤʢʸʣʮ
La marca CE indica
el cumplimiento de
las siguientes
normativas:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Refundida)
Asimismo, cumple la
normativa de bajo voltaje 2014/35/EU
cuando se envía con la fuente de
alimentación recomendada. Contacto
europeo:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Países Bajos
CE
:
1995/5/EC R&TTE
2011/65/EU RoHS (Recast)
,
,
2014/35/EU
.
:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
Use únicamente cables protegidos
para datos con este sistema. Esta
unidad ha sido evaluada con cables
de menos de 3 metros. Es posible
que los cables de más de 3 metros no
cumplan con el desempeño de
clase B.
‫ ﺗﻢ‬.‫اﺳﺘﺨﺪم ﻓﻘﻂ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎت اﳌﺼﻔﺢ ﻣﻊ ﻫﺬا اﻟﻨﻈﺎم‬
.‫ أﻣﺘﺎر‬3 ‫اﺧﺘﺒﺎر ﻫﺬه اﻟﻮﺣﺪة ﺑﻮاﺳﻄﺔ ﻛﺎﺑﻼت ﻳﻘﻞ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ أﻣﺘﺎر ﻣﻊ‬3 ‫ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ اﻟﻜﺎﺑﻼت اﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻃﻮﻟﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ‬
.B ‫أداء اﻟﻔﺌﺔ‬
La indicación CE
indica el
cumplimiento con
las siguientes
directivas:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Reformulada)
Además, cumple con la directiva de
bajo voltaje 2014/35/EC cuando se
envía con la fuente de poder
recomendada. Contacto europeo:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Países Bajos
A marca CE indica
conformidade com
as seguintes
diretivas:
• 1995/5/EC R&TTE
• 2011/65/EU RoHS
(Reformulação)
Além disso, o
produto está em conformidade com a
Diretiva para baixa tensão 2014/35/
EU, quando fornecido com a fonte de
alimentação recomendada. Contato
na Europa:
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
Holanda
CE
: ‫بالمعايير التالية‬
ϭϵϵϱͬϱͬZΘdd v
2011/65/EU RoHS v
)‫(إعادة الصياغة‬
‫تلتزم بمعيار الجهد المنخفض‬
2014/35/EU
.‫الطاقة الموصى به‬
Hand Held Products Europe B.V.
Lagelandseweg 70
6545CG Nijmegen
The Netherlands
第I類
I类
Clase I
Use somente cabos de dados
blindados com este sistema. Esta
unidade foi testada com cabos com
menos de 3 metros. Cabos com mais
de 3 metros não atendem o
desempenho de classe B.
Class I
1 ‫اﻟﻔﺌﺔ‬
CB Scheme
Certified to CB Scheme IEC 60950-1,
Second Edition.
Plan OC (organismes de
certification)
Certifié CB CEI 60950-1, deuxième
édition.
Schéma OC
Schema CB
CB-Zertifizierung
Esquema CB
Esquema CB
Esquema CB
Certifié selon la norme CEI 60950-1
seconde édition (schéma OC).
Certificato in base allo Schema CB
IEC 60950-1, seconda edizione.
CB-zertifiziert gemäß IEC 60950,
Second Edition.
Se ha certificado que cumple el
esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda
edición.
Se ha certificado que cumple con el
esquema CB IEC 60950-1, segunda
edición.
Certificação CB Scheme IEC 609501, Segunda edição.
CB 方案
CB Scheme
CB Scheme
CB Scheme
Схема CB
已通过 CB 方案 IEC 60950-1 第二版
的认证。
經過認證符合 CB Scheme IEC
60950-1 標準第二版。
CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second
Edition に認定されています。
CB Scheme IEC 60950-1, Second
Edition 인증을 받았습니다 .
Сертификация согласно схеме CB
МЭК 60950-1, издание второе.
Patents
Brevets
Brevets
Brevetti
Patente
Patentes
Patentes
Patentes
For patent information, refer to
www.hsmpats.com.
Veuillez consulter le site
www.hsmpats.com pour obtenir des
renseignements au sujet du brevet.
Pour plus d’informations sur les
brevets, visitez la page
www.hsmpats.com.
Per i dettagli sui brevetti, fare
riferimento al sito Web
www.hsmpats.com.
Patentinformationen sind unter
www.hsmpats.com erhältlich.
Para obtener información sobre las
patentes, visite www.hsmpats.com.
Para obtener información sobre
patentes, consulte
www.hsmpats.com.
Para obter informações sobre
patente, consulte www.hsmpats.com.
专利
專利
特許
특허
Патенты
有关专利信息,请参阅
www.hsmpats.com。
相關專利資訊請參閱
www.hsmpats.com 中的說明。
特許情報については、
www.hsmpats.com を参照してくだ
さい。
특허 정보는 www.hsmpats.com 를 참
조하십시오 .
Информация о патентах приведена
на веб-странице www.hsmpats.com.
Product Environmental
Information
Renseignements relatifs à
l’environnement à propos
des produits
Informations
environnementales sur les
produits
Informazioni ambientali
relative al prodotto
Informationen zur
Umweltverträglichkeit von
Produkten
Reportez-vous à la page
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental pour obtenir des
renseignements concernant les
directives RoHS/REACH/WEEE.
Reportez-vous au site
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental pour obtenir les
informations sur les directives RoHS/
REACH/WEEE.
产品环境信息
產品環境資訊
製品の環境情報
제품 환경 정보
有关 RoHS / REACH / WEEE 信息,
请参阅 www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 。
請參閱 www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 以瞭解 RoHS /
REACH / WEEE 資訊。
RoHS / REACH / WEEE に関する情
報については、
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental を参照してください。
RoHS / REACH / WEEE 정보는
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental 에서 참조하십시오 .
Refer to www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental for the RoHS / REACH
/ WEEE information.
TÜV R Statement
Normes TÜV R
TÜV R listed: UL 60950-1, Second Edition and
CSA C22.2 No.60950-1-07, Second Edition.
Homologué TÜV R : UL 60950-1, seconde
édition et CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1-07,
seconde édition.
TÜV Rheinland
C
Consultare il sito web
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental per informazioni su
RoHS/REACH/RAEE.
TÜV Rheinland
C
US
US
CB Scheme
IEC ʯʷʺʬ ʭʠʺʤʡ ʸʹʥʠʮ ʸʶʥʮʤ CB Scheme
.ʤʩʰʹ ʤʸʥʣʤʮ ,CB Scheme ʯʥʢʸʠ ʬʹ 60950-1
ʭʩʨʰʨʴ
Unter www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental finden Sie
Informationen über RoHS/REACH/
WEEE.
Экологическая
информация о продукции
Информация о соответствии
требованиям RoHS / REACH /
WEEE приведена на сайте
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental.
If the following label is attached to your product, the product
meets Korean agency approval:
이 기기는 가정용 (B 급 ) 전자파적합기기로서 주
로 가정에서 사용하는 것을 목적으로 하며 ,
모든 지역에서 사용할 수 있습니다 .
This product is EMC B grade equipment,
intended for residential use. This equipment can
be used in any area.
ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ ʯʩʩʲ ,ʭʩʨʰʨʴ ʬʲ ʲʣʩʮʬ
www.hsmpats.com
.‫ اﻹﺻﺪاراﻟﺜﺎﻧﻲ‬،CB IEC 60950-1 ‫ﻣﺨﻄﻂ‬
CB ‫ﻣﺨﻄﻂ‬
‫ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ‬
‫ﺑﺮاءات اﻻﺧﱰاع‬
‫ ﻳُﺮﺟﻰ اﻟﺮﺟﻮع‬،‫ﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮل ﻋﲆ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎت ﺗﺨﺺ ﺑﺮاءة اﻻﺧﱰاع‬
.www.hsmpats.com ‫إﱃ‬
Información ambiental del
producto
Información ambiental de
producto
Informações ambientais
sobre produtos
Consulte www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental para obtener
información sobre RoHS/REACH/
WEEE.
Consulte la información RoHS/
REACH/WEEE en
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental.
Consulte a página
www.honeywellaidc.com/
environmental para obter
informações sobre as normas RoHS/
REACH/WEEE.
ʩʸʶʥʮ ʬʹ ʩʺʡʩʡʱʤ ʲʣʩʮʤ ʺʥʣʥʠ ʭʩʨʸʴʬ
:ʺʡʥʺʫʡ ʨʰʸʨʰʩʠʤ ʸʺʠʡ
www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental for
the RoHS / REACH / WEEE information.
ΞΗϧϣϠϟΔϳ΋ϳΑϟ΍ΕΎϔλ΍ϭϣϟ΍
ϰϟ·ωϭΟέϟ΍ϰΟέ˵ϳ
www.honeywellaidc.com/environmental
ΕΎϬϳΟϭΗϝϭΣΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ
.5R+65($&+:(((
依據標準 : 低功率射頻電機技術規範 :
LP0002 NCC standard: Low power
frequency electric machineries technical
standard: LP0002
根據交通部低功率管理辦法規定:
第十二條
經型式認證合格之低功率射頻電機,非經許
可,公司、商號或使用者均不得擅自
變更頻率、加大功率或變更原設計之特性及功能。
第十四條
低功率射頻電機之使用不得影響飛航安全及干擾合法通信;經
發現有干擾現象
時,應立即停用,並改善至無干擾時方得繼續使用。
前項合法通信,指依電信規定作業之無線電信。低功率射頻電
機須忍受合法通信
或工業、科學及醫療用電波輻射性電機設備之干擾。
Este produto está homologado pela ANATEL, de acordo com os
procedimentos regulamentados pela Resolução No. 242/2000 e
atende aos requisitos técnicos aplicados.
Para maiores informações, consulte o site da ANATEL –
www.anatel.gov.br
CIDF15000182
Modelo: CCB02
1937-14-1571
(01)07898927490140
" Este equipamento opera em caráter secundário, isto é, não tem
direito a proteção contra interferência prejudicial, mesmo de estações
do mesmo tipo, e não pode causar interferência a sistemas operando
em caráter primário."
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
产品中有害物质的名称及含量
(Names and Content of Hazardous Substances in the Product)
部件名称 (Parts Name)
有害物质
(Hazardous Substances)
铅 (Pb)
汞 (Hg)
镉 (Cd)
六价铬 (Cr6+)
多溴联苯 (PBB)
多溴二苯醚 (PBDE)
印刷电路板 (PCB)
x
o
o
o
o
o
外壳 (Housing)
o
o
o
o
o
o
连线 (Cables)
o
o
o
o
o
o
本表格依据 SJ/T11364 的规定编制。 (The table is created by SJ/T11364 requirement.)
o: 表示该有害物质在该部件所有均质材料中的含量均在 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求以下。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.)
x: 表示该有害物质至少在该部件的某一均质材料中的含量超出 GB/T26572 标准规定的限量要求。 (Indicates that this hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials for this part is above the limit requirement in China’s GB/T26572.)
This document was prepared and executed in the English
language. In the event this document is translated into another
language and a conflict arises between the English version and
a non-English version, the English version shall prevail, it being
recognized and acknowledged that the English language
version most clearly expresses the intent of the parties. Any
notice or communication given in connection with this document
must include a version in the English language.
Ce document a été préparé et exécuté dans la langue anglaise.
Dans l’éventualité où le document serait traduit dans une autre
langue et qu'un litige survenait entre la version en anglais et la
version autre qu'en anglais, la version en anglais prévaudra,
étant confirmé et reconnu que la version en anglais exprime de
façon plus précise l’intention des parties. Tout avis ou toute
communication relatif à ce document doit inclure une version en
anglais.
Ce document a été préparé et finalisé en anglais. Si ce
document est traduit dans une autre langue et si un conflit
survient entre la version en anglais et la version traduite, la
version en anglais prévaudra tant il est reconnu et établi qu’elle
exprime le plus clairement les intentions des parties. Tout avis
ou communication produit en relation avec ce document doit
comporter une version en anglais.
Questo documento è stato preparato e redatto in lingua inglese.
In caso di traduzione in altre lingue, nell’eventualità sorgano
conflitti fra la versione non inglese e quella inglese, prevarrà
quest’ultima in quanto viene riconosciuto e accettato che la
versione in lingua inglese esprime più chiaramente gli accordi
fra le parti. Qualsiasi notifica o comunicazione inviata in
rapporto a questo documento deve includere una versione in
lingua inglese.
Dieses Dokument wurde in englischer Sprache erstellt und
ausgefertigt. Wenn dieses Dokument in eine andere Sprache
übersetzt wird, und ein Konflikt zwischen der englischen und
nicht-englischen Fassung auftritt, hat die englische Fassung
Vorrang, da die Parteien anerkennen, dass die Fassung in
englischer Sprache ihren Absichten am deutlichsten Ausdruck
verleiht. Alle Hinweise oder Mitteilungen in Zusammenhang mit
diesem Dokument müssen auch in einer Fassung in englischer
Sprache erfolgen.
Originalmente, este documento se creó y redactó en inglés. En
caso de que se traduzca a otro idioma y surja un conflicto entre
la versión en inglés y la versión en otro idioma, prevalecerá la
versión en inglés. Se reconoce y admite que, en la versión en
inglés, expresa la intención de las partes con más claridad.
Cualquier aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con
este documento debe incluir una versión en inglés.
Este documento se preparó y redactó en inglés. En caso de que
se traduzca a otro idioma y surja algún conflicto entre la versión
en inglés y la del idioma extranjero, prevalecerá la versión en
inglés, dado que se reconoce y admite que la versión en inglés
expresa más claramente la intención de las partes. Cualquier
aviso o comunicación proporcionada en relación con este
documento deberá incluir una versión en inglés.
Este documento foi preparado e feito em língua inglesa. Se este
documento for traduzido para outro idioma e surgirem conflitos
entre a versão em inglês e a versão no outro idioma, a versão
em inglês prevalecerá, sendo reconhecido e atestado que a
versão em língua inglesa expressa mais claramente a intenção
das partes. Qualquer comunicação ou aviso relacionado a este
documento deve conter a versão em inglês.
本文档以英文撰写。如果本文档的其他语言版本与英文版本存
在冲突,则以英文版本为准。各方一致认可和同意英文版本最
清楚地表达了各自的意图。任何与本文档相关的声明或沟通,
都应包括英文版本。
本文件的原稿是以英文撰寫。如果本文件翻譯為其他語言,而
英文版和非英文版之間產生衝突,應以英文版為準,並且各方
一致認同並確認英文版最能夠清楚地表達各方的意圖。凡是所
有與本文件有關之公告或通訊,都必須包含英文的版本。
本書は英語で作成され発行されています。本書を他の言語に
翻訳し、英語版と英語以外の版に矛盾が生じた場合は、関係
者の意図を最も明確に表すものが英語版であることを認識お
よび承諾し、英語版が優先するものとします。さらに、本書
に関連して与えられる告知や通知は、すべて英語版を含むも
のとします。
본 문서는 영어로 준비되어 작성된 것입니다. 본 문서를 다른 언
어로 번역했는데 영문본과 번역본 사이에 상충하는 부분이 발생
하는 경우에는 영문본이 우선하며, 영문본이 양쪽 당사자의 의
도를 가장 명확하게 표현하고 있음을 인식하고 확인합니다. 본
문서와 관련한 모든 고지 또는 전달 사항에는 영문본이 동봉되
어야 합니다.
Данный документ был подготовлен и выполнен на
английском языке. При переводе данного документа на
другой язык, в случае возникновения противоречий между
английской версией и версией на другом языке, английская
версия имеет преимущественную силу. Данным
признается, что версия документа на английском языке
наиболее четко выражает намерения сторон. Любые
уведомления или письма, направляемые в связи с данным
документом, должны включать в себя версию на
английском языке.
For warranty information, go to www.honeywellaidc.com and
click Resources > Warranty.
Pour obtenir des informations sur la garantie, consultez le site
www.honeywellaidc.com et cliquez sur Ressources >
Garantie.
Per informazioni sulla garanzia, andare a
www.honeywellaidc.com e fare clic su Resources > Warranty.
Die Garantiebestimmungen finden Sie unter
www.honeywellaidc.com. Klicken Sie dort auf Ressourcen >
Garantie.
Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite
www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía.
Para obtener información sobre la garantía, visite
www.honeywellaidc.com y haga clic en Recursos > Garantía.
Para obter informações sobre a garantia, vá para
www.honeywellaidc.com e clique em Resources (Recursos) >
Warranty (Garantia).
欲了解保修信息,请访 www.honeywellaidc.com,单击
Resources (资源)> Warranty (保修)。
如需檢視保固資訊,請瀏覽 www.honeywellaidc.com,然後按
一下 Resources > Warranty。
保証については、www.honeywellaidc.com にて、Resources >
Warranty とクリックしてください。
보증 정보를 보려면 www.honeywellaidc.com 으로 이동하여
Resources > Warranty 를 클릭하십시오 .
Подробную информацию о гарантии см. на сайте
www.honeywellaidc.com в разделе Resources > Warranty.
Informace o záruce naleznete na stránce
www.honeywellaidc.com po kliknutí na Resources > Warranty.
Ak chcete získať informácie o záruke, prejdite na stránku
www.honeywellaidc.com a kliknite na Resources (Zdroje) >
Warranty (Záruka).
Aby uzyskać informacje na temat gwarancji, wejdź na stronę
www.honeywellaidc.com i kliknij Zasoby > Gwarancja.
Garanti bilgileri için www.honeywellaidc.com adresine gidin ve
Kaynaklar > Garanti ögelerini tıklayın.
ʺʡʥʺʫʬʥʰʴʠʰʺʥʩʸʧʠʤʺʥʣʥʠʲʣʩʮʬ
ΓέΎϳίΑϝοϔΗˬϥΎϣοϟ΍ϥ΄ηΑΕΎϣϭϠόϣϰϠϋϝϭλΣϠϟ
.Resources > Warranty ʥʷʩʬʷʤʥwww.honeywellaidc.com
Ωέ΍ϭϣϟ΍< ϥΎϣοϟ΍ϕϭϓέϘϧ΍ϭwww.honeywellaidc.com
ʤʴʹʬ ʭʢʸʥʺʩ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʹ ʤʸʷʮʡ .ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʷʴʥʤʥ ʪʸʲʰ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮ
,ʺʮʢʸʥʺʮʤ ʤʱʸʢʤʥ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʥʲʮʹʮ ʯʩʡ ʤʸʩʺʱ ʤʬʢʺʺʥ ʺʸʧʠ
ʤʱʸʢʤ ʩʫ ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʬʲ ʭʫʱʥʮ .ʺʲʡʥʷʤ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʤʩʤʺ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ
ʤʲʣʥʤ ʬʫ .ʭʩʣʣʶʤ ʺʰʥʥʫ ʺʠʸʺʥʩʡ ʸʥʸʡʤ ʯʴʥʠʡ ʺʠʨʡʮ ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ
.ʺʩʬʢʰʠʤ ʤʴʹʡ ʤʱʸʢʤ ʺʠʬʥʬʫʬ ʺʡʩʩʧ ʤʦ ʪʮʱʮʬ ʸʹʷʤʡ ʸʱʮʩʺʹ
‫ إذا ﺗﺮﺟﻤﺔ ﻫﺬا‬.‫ﺗﻢ إﻋﺪاد ﻫﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ وﺗﻨﻔﻴﺬه ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ‬
‫اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ إﱃ ﻟﻐﺎت أﺧﺮى وﻛﺎن ﻫﻨﺎك اﺧﺘﻼف اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي وإﺻﺪار‬
‫ ﺣﻴﺚ إن اﻹﺻﺪار‬،‫ ُ ﺟﻰ اﻻﻟﺘﺰام ﺟﺎء ﰲ اﻹﺻﺪار اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي‬،‫آﺧﺮ‬
‫ ﻳﺠﺐ أن‬.‫اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰي ﻫﻮ اﻟﺬي ﻳﻌﱪ ﺑﻮﺿﻮح وﴏاﺣﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻴﺔ اﻷﻃﺮاف‬
‫ﺗﺸﻤﻞ أﻳﺔ إﺷﻌﺎرات أو اﺗﺼﺎﻻت ذات ﺻﻠﺔ ﺑﻬﺬا اﳌﺴﺘﻨﺪ ﻋﲆ إﺻﺪار ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻐﺔ‬
.‫اﻹﻧﺠﻠﻴﺰﻳﺔ‬
Manufacturer Contact Information:
Honeywell International Inc.
Honeywell Sensing & Productivity Solutions
9680 Old Bailes Road
Fort Mill, SC 29707 USA
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com
CCB02-MULT-RS Rev B
6/16
Honeywell
9680 Old Bailes Road
Fort Mill, SC 29707
www.honeywellaidc.com
™
Xenon-UG Rev R
2/17
8021395/2017-04-28 • Subject to change without notice • SICK AG • Waldkirch • Germany • www.sick.com

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement

Languages